Ironmaking and Steelmaking Theory and Practice
Ironmaking and Steelmaking Theory and Practice
Ironmaking and Steelmaking Theory and Practice
and
STEELMAKING
THEORY
AND
PRACTICE
Ahindra Ghosh
Amit Chatterjee
IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING
IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING
Theory and Practice
AHINDRA GHOSH
Formerly Professor
Materials and Metallurgical Engineering
Indian Institute of Technology Kanpur
AMIT CHATTERJEE
Formerly Chief Technology Officer
Currently Adviser to the Managing Director
Tata Steel Limited, Jamshedpur
New Delhi-110001
2008
IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Ahindra Ghosh and Amit Chatterjee
2008 by PHI Learning Private Limited, New Delhi. All rights reserved. No part of this book may be
reproduced in any form, by mimeograph or any other means, without permission in writing from the
publisher.
ISBN-978-81-203-3289-8
The export rights of this book are vested solely with the publisher.
Published by Asoke K. Ghosh, PHI Learning Private Limited, M-97, Connaught Circus,
New Delhi-110001 and Printed by Rajkamal Electric Press, B-35/9, G.T. Karnal Road Industrial Area,
Delhi-110033.
To
Jamsetji Nusserwanji Tata
(3rd March 183919th May 1904)
Doyen of the Indian Iron and Steel Industry
Contents
Preface xix
Part A GENERAL
1. Introduction 123
1.1 Early History of Iron (Steel) 3
1.1.1 Meteoric Iron and Wrought Iron 3
1.1.2 Cast Iron 4
1.1.3 Evolution of Ironmaking in Europe 4
1.1.4 Early History of Steelmaking before the Advent of Modern Processes 6
1.1.5 Iron and Steel Heritage of India 7
1.2 Evolution of Ironmaking Technology Since 1880 8
1.2.1 The Developing Blast Furnace 8
1.2.2 Alternative Ironmaking Processes 11
1.3 Steelmaking Since Henry Bessemer 13
1.3.1 Bessemer Process 13
1.3.2 Open Hearth Process 15
1.3.3 Electric Furnace Steelmaking 15
1.3.4 Basic Oxygen Steelmaking 16
1.3.5 Secondary Steelmaking and Continuous Casting of Steel 17
1.4 Present Status of the World Steel Industry 18
1.4.1 Classification 18
1.4.2 World Production of Steel 19
1.5 Steelmaking in India 19
1.6 Environmental Pollution and Control 20
1.6.1 Steps Taken by the Steel Industry 20
1.6.2 Forms of Pollution 22
1.7 Concluding Remarks 23
References 23
2. Overview of Blast Furnace Ironmaking 2438
2.1 Introduction 24
2.1.1 Improvements Made in Blast Furnace Technology 25
2.2 Blast Furnace Reactions and Process in a Nutshell 25
vii
viii Contents
Part D STEELMAKING
19. Basic Open Hearth and Electric Arc Furnace Steelmaking 341361
19.1 Basic Open Hearth Steelmaking 341
19.1.1 The Open Hearth Furnace 342
19.1.2 Steelmaking in Basic Open Hearth Furnaces 344
19.1.3 Transfer of Oxygen and Heat in Open Hearth Furnaces 345
19.1.4 Concluding Remarks 346
19.2 Electric Arc Furnace Steelmaking 346
19.2.1 General 346
19.2.2 The Furnace and the Auxiliaries 347
19.2.3 Conventional EAF Steelmaking Practice 349
19.2.4 Modern Developments in EAF Steelmaking 351
19.3 Performance Assessment of EAF Steelmaking 359
19.3.1 Key Process Performance Indices 359
19.3.2 Operating Costs 360
19.3.3 Steel Quality Control in EAF 360
References 361
20. Secondary Steelmaking 362396
20.1 Introduction 362
20.2 Inert Gas Purging (IGP) 364
20.3 Deoxidation of Liquid Steel 367
20.3.1 Thermodynamics of Deoxidation of Molten Steel 367
20.3.2 Kinetics of Deoxidation of Molten Steel 370
20.3.3 The Ladle Furnace (LF) 372
20.3.4 Problem of Slag Carryover 373
20.3.5 The CAS-OB Process 374
20.4 Degassing and Decarburisation of Liquid Steel 375
20.4.1 Thermodynamics of Degassing Reactions 375
20.4.2 Kinetics of Desorption and Absorption of Nitrogen by Liquid Steel 376
20.4.3 Vacuum Degassing Processes 377
20.4.4 Manufacture of Ultra-Low Carbon (ULC) Steel by RH-OB Process 380
20.5 Desulphurisation in Secondary Steelmaking 383
20.5.1 Thermodynamic Aspects 383
20.5.2 Kinetic Aspects 385
20.5.3 Injection Metallurgy (IM) 388
20.6 Clean Steel Technology 389
20.6.1 Introduction 389
20.6.2 Cleanliness Control during Deoxidation 389
20.6.3 Cleanliness Control during Teeming 390
20.6.4 Tundish Metallurgy for Clean Steel 391
20.7 Miscellaneous Topics 391
20.7.1 Inclusion Modification 391
20.7.2 Temperature Changes during Secondary Steelmaking 393
20.7.3 Refractories for Secondary Steelmaking 395
References 396
xvi Contents
Part F MISCELLANEOUS
Traditionally, Metallurgical Engineering has been subdivided into two broad categories, namely,
Ferrous Metallurgy and Non-Ferrous Metallurgy. Ferrous metallurgy includes the metallurgy of
iron and steel, while non-ferrous metallurgy deals with all other metals like aluminium, copper,
zinc, etc. Since steel is by far the most important engineering material known to mankind,
ferrous metallurgy has been the dominant branch of metallurgical engineering, in terms of scale
of production, size of the industry, manpower employed, and so on.
Since the 1940s, advances in sophisticated high-technology areas such as nuclear
engineering, aerospace science, aviation and solid-state electronics, have necessitated the
development of a variety of special materialsboth metallic and non-metallic. A fundamental
understanding of metals as well as that of atomic and solid-state physics has provided the
scientific foundation for the growth of these materials. As a result, the scope of metallurgical
engineering has, over the years, become more broad-based in order to encompass Materials
Science and Engineering.
A plethora of literature is now available in the exciting field of materials science. This is
not always the case with ferrous metallurgy, perhaps because it is traditional and perceived to
be out-of-sync with modern developments. Yet, steel continues to be the most widely used
engineering material. All Metallurgical Engineering Departments in engineering colleges,
particularly in countries like India, where iron and steel production is expected to increase
substantially in the next decade or two, have and will continue to have, substantial teaching
programmes in the area of iron and steel. The paucity of up-to-date textbooks for undergraduate
and postgraduate students in this field is a real problem area. It is also worth noting that
ironmaking and steelmaking technologies have made tremendous advances in the last forty years
or so, making the need for the up-to-date textbooks even greater.
It is worth pointing out that contrary to popular perception associated with the attribute of
being traditional, the last five decades have witnessed revolutionary advances in the fundamental
understanding of the theories of ironmaking and steelmaking. This has resulted in major changes
in the associated metallurgical processes. The insight gained is primarily based on the sciences
of thermodynamics and physical chemistry, as well as on a more comprehensive understanding
of the role of both fluid flow and heat and mass transfer in the dynamics of these processes.
As a result, the design, development, control and operation of modern ironmaking and
xix
xx Preface
steelmaking processes are today based on scientific fundamentals, to a much greater degree than
what it was earlier. Consequently, even well-established processes (for example, blast furnace
ironmaking) have undergone revolutionary changes with the passage of time to such an extent
that the old processes have become new.
This book aims at providing current information in the broad field of ironmaking and
steelmaking. The historical facts and general aspects of iron and steel are presented in Chapter
1 of this book. The following twenty-three chapters deal with both the science and technology
of ironmaking and steelmaking in a balanced manner, covering both theory and practice. The
book has been designed as a textbook for the basic undergraduate course(s) on the subject. It
can also partly serve as a textbook in elective and postgraduate courses.
The two authors, with totally different backgrounds covering the entire spectrum of the
theory and practice of iron and steel, hope that the book they have written will fulfil a long-felt
need of this type of treatment of the subject of ironmaking and steelmaking.
Ahindra Ghosh taught iron and steel metallurgy and allied subjects, besides being engaged
in other academic and professional activities, while he was at the Indian Institute of Technology
Kanpur for thirty-eight years. His visits, interactions and association with professionals in several
steel plants, especially at Tata Steel, have considerably enhanced his knowledge of the subject.
He wishes to gratefully acknowledge all of them.
Amit Chatterjee expresses his gratitude to his late father, Dr. A.B. Chatterjee, for introducing
him to the romance of iron and steel, which has inspired him throughout his career spanning
four decades. He gratefully acknowledges the assistance of his Secretary, Mr. K.H. Kartha, in
typing the manuscript. He also wishes to thank profusely, Mr. Bikash Nandy, Executive
Assistant in his office, since without his painstaking efforts, this book would not have seen the
light of day. He is also grateful to Tata Steel for providing him with all the opportunities to learn
the nitty-gritty of iron and steel production during his thirty-five years association with the Steel
Company.
Both the authors wish to sincerely thank their wives and other members of their family for
their continuous help and encouragement, without which work of this nature could not have been
undertaken.
Ahindra Ghosh
Amit Chatterjee
Part A
General
Introduction
Overview of Blast Furnace Ironmaking
Overview of Modern Steelmaking
General Physicochemical Fundamentals
1
Introduction
The earths crust contains about 5% iron. However, it is present as a compound, mostly as iron
oxide. Iron is extracted as metallic Fe from the oxide by reduction with a reducing agent. The
principal agent that is used is naturally occurring carbon in the form of coke, coal or charcoal.
For economic extraction of iron, relatively rich deposits of iron ore, with Fe contents above
5560%, are generally used. The most abundant iron oxide mineral is haematite (i.e. Fe2O3)
followed by magnetite (i.e. Fe3O4). Iron ores also contain oxide minerals of some other elements
such as aluminium, silicon, manganese and phosphorus. These minerals are physically mixed
with earthy materials such as sand, rock and clay. Some of these substances are harmful for the
properties of the finished products. These are treated as impurities that ought to be removed
during extraction. Iron has the ability to form alloys with many elements. Such alloying is done
intentionally to produce various grades of iron alloys having the properties required for various
applications.
Broadly speaking, iron products can be classified into three categories, viz. wrought iron,
cast iron and steel. Today, steel is the most important product of iron, followed by cast iron,
while wrought iron is used in very small quantities for ornamental purposes.
small percentages of nickel were made from metallic iron present in the elemental state in
meteorites. The first definite evidence of ironmaking by the reduction of oxide dates back to
about 1500 BC.
The melting point of pure iron is 1536C, but when iron absorbs carbon, the melting point
is lowered significantly. The lowest melting composition (i.e. the eutectic) containing 4.26%
carbon melts at 1153C. The primitive furnaces that were used to extract iron were small in size
and were shaped like a deep bowl, about 11.5 m high with diameters ranging from 0.4 to
0.8 m. The lining consisted mainly of dried clay, and charcoal was used as the reducing agent.
Oxygen was supplied by blowing air through pipes kept in the mouth, and later on, by bellows.
The air supplied resulted in the partial combustion of carbon along with the generation of carbon
monoxide and heat, which raised the furnace temperature. The actual reduction was carried out
by CO:
Fe-oxide(s) + CO(g) = Fe(s) + CO2 (g) (1.1)
(This equation is not balanced. It only shows the reaction qualitatively.)
In the small furnaces that were used, it was difficult to attain temperatures higher than
1100C or so, in the zone of maximum temperature. Under these conditions, metallic iron could
not absorb much carbon. Therefore, melting did not take place and hot iron that was obtained
remained in the solid state mixed with a low-melting slag containing very high percentages of
FeO. Upon repeated heating followed by forging into various shapes using a hammer, most of
the slag got squeezed out to leave solid iron (sponge) that was almost pure (with low
concentrations of carbon, etc.). This type of product became known as wrought iron (wrought
meaning worked, i.e. forged).
water wheels were employed to blow air, resulting in higher production rates and better charcoal
utilisation. It was possible to produce about 100 kg of metal in batches, every 12 hours.
The demand for more iron led to the development of the Stukofen in Germany. The Stukofen
had a height of 3 4.5 m and its shape was similar to that of a modern blast furnace. It had water-
driven bellows and a superior furnace lining made of stone and clay. It is rightly considered the
forerunner of the modern blast furnace. The hot iron bloom (in the form of a solid) used to be
withdrawn from the bottom, and only small amounts of liquid iron was produced, as a
by-product. Individual Stukofens could produce 100150 tonnes of iron per annum. The next
important step in ironmaking furnace design was the Flussofen (flow oven), which was
developed in the Rhine Valley in Germany in the 14th century, essentially to cast cannons for
warfare.
The charcoal blast furnaces developed in the European continent then spread to Great
Britain, where the next evolution of ironmaking technology occurred. Several improvements led
to larger and more efficient furnaces. The major developments that took place till about 1880
are summarised below.
the entire gas exiting from the furnace top used to be burnt for pre-heating the air blast. In 1845,
Bunsen and Playfair pointed out that the bulk of the calorific value of the gas was being wasted
in this approach and suggested that the gas be transported through a pipeline for utilisation, not
only for pre-heating of air, but also for using elsewhere in the iron works.
This immediately called for an arrangement to charge iron ore, coke, etc. from the top of
the furnace without any leakage of gas into the atmosphere. The cup-and-bell system was
invented around 1850, which later led to the development of the double-bell charging device.
This became a standard feature of all blast furnaces till about 19701980.
Another problem faced during the early days was that the gas contained a lot of dust
particles, which used to choke the pipelines, stoves, etc. In order to reduce the dust content, the
gas began to be passed through a large chamber where some dust settled owing to the decrease
in velocity. However, this arrangement was not very satisfactory modern blast furnaces are
provided with far more elaborate gas cleaning arrangements.
Huntsman in the UK in 1740. The crucible process dominated steelmaking in Europe and North
America till Henry Bessemer of the UK developed the famous Bessemer Process, which
heralded the advent of steel production on a mass scale.
1200C Charcoal
Iron ore
Sponge iron
Bellows
Wrought
iron
1200C
Blow cooling
Charcoal Crucible
Wootz
Casting
650C850C Forging
Wootz
Heat treating
Quenching
Hardened
blade
Figure 1.1 Typical manufacturing procedure for a Damascus sword from Indian wootz.
1950s, when a running blast furnace in Japan was rapidly chilled by blowing cold
nitrogen through its tuyeres. Then the furnace was sectioned and samples were collected
from various zones for chemical and physical examination.
The developments up to 1950 led to the following changes:
More powerful blowing engines
Higher blast temperatures
Bigger furnaces
Better charging equipment
Improved raw material storage
Screening of raw materials to eliminate fines
More efficient cleaning of blast furnace gas
Use of better refractories and improved design of the furnace lining
More versatile facilities for handling iron
Accurate and quick measurement of the composition and temperature of inputs and
outputs.
Some of these features have become standard in blast furnaces today. Considerable
improvements have, of course, been made in the interim period; some specific examples are cited
below.
1. The double-bell raw material charging system used at the furnace top came into existence
around 1880. Earlier, raw materials were hauled to the top using vertical hoists, which
were replaced by skip hoists in 1883. The advent of automatic skip charging, however,
introduced a serious problem of charge distribution. This was solved in 1890 by the
installation of Mckee rotating tops. Figure 1.2 shows a blast furnace of the early 1900s
in which these features were incorporated. Most of these features exist even today,
except that most modern furnaces now have bell-less top charging.
Figure 1.2 Two-bell top with rotating distributor for a blast furnace around the year 1900.
10 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
2. The blast furnace gas cleaning system as it exists today consists of a dust catcher, a wet
scrubber and an electrostatic precipitator. The last facility was incorporated following the
invention of electrostatic precipitators by Lodge and Cottrell in 1919.
3. The life of the lining has been improved significantly by the introduction of water
cooling of the lining, including the carbon hearth.
4. Earlier molten iron tapped from blast furnaces used to be cast on sand beds. The pig
casting machine was invented by Uehling in 1896. Around the same time, the
introduction of hot metal mixers allowed the transfer of liquid iron by ladles over longer
distances as well as storage in the steel melting shops.
The impact of all these developments on blast furnace ironmaking may be gauged from
Table 1.1, based on the best operating practices over the years.
Table 1.1 Historical developments of blast furnace ironmaking
* Working height is from tuyere to stock level; ** t means tonne, i.e. a metric ton = 1000 kg.
before shutdown for repair) and hot metal silicon level, in these 3040 years. It is generally
agreed that the furnaces have reached their near-peak performance, and further significant
improvements are not expected.
Table 1.2 Comparison of performance indices of blast furnaces of 1960 with those of 19902000
for the best operating practices
Parameters Year
1960 19902000
Working height, m 25 25
Inner hearth diameter, m 9 15
Working volume, m3 2000 5000
Production of iron, tpd 2000 13000
Productivity, thm/day/m3 1 2.6
Fuel rate, kg/thm 800 450500
Campaign life, years 46 above 10
Silicon in hot metal, weight % 1 0.2
hm denotes hot metal, which is the terminology used popularly for liquid iron produced
in ironmaking.
Sponge iron
Iron produced as a solid by the reduction of iron oxide is popularly known as sponge iron. The
ancient ironmakers were in effect making sponge iron, since molten metal temperatures could
not be attained. Sponge iron made was used to manufacture wrought iron products directly; even
today, sponge iron is a feed for electric furnaces. Therefore, in technical literature, sponge iron
is also referred to as Direct Reduced Iron (DRI). DRI is often compacted to reduce its
porosity this product is called Hot Briquetted Iron (HBI). Chapter 13 contains a detailed
presentation; the following is a very brief overview.
It may be noted from Table 1.3 that although the first attempt made to produce DRI was
in the form of the Hoganas process as early as 1910, direct reduction did not become widespread
until the 1950s. The renewed interest after 1950 stemmed from the following reasons.
Once electric arc furnace steelmaking started growing, metallic feed in the form of steel
scrap became scarce. DRI was used to supplement scrap as auxiliary feed material in
EAFs.
Blast furnace-based steel plants require relatively large capital investment and depend on
metallurgical coking coal, which is not available everywhere. On the other hand, the DRI
manufacturing units are small in size, the total capital investment is limited, and the
reductant can be non-coking coal or gaseous reductants like natural gas. Consequently,
the alternative processes are especially attractive for the developing countries.
Tonnage-wise, the gas-based Midrex and HYL processes have always had the largest share
of production. The total world production of sponge iron in 1995 and 2005 was 30.8 and
56.1 Mt respectively; the process-wise break-up for both these years is given below.
Process Production, Mt
1995 2005
Midrex 19.9 35.0
HYL 8.2 11.1
Rotary kiln processes 2.2 8.2
Fluidised bed processes 0.5 1.5
Rotary hearth processes 0 0.2
A novel process which has considerable potential, especially for small and medium scale
production units, is ironmaking through the composite pellet route. A composite pellet is a
mixture of iron ore/oxide fines and carbonaceous reductant (coal/coke/char) fines. These
materials are mixed together and made into pellets at room temperature using a binder. The
Inmetco process and the Fastmet process (see Table 1.3) are both based on composite pellets
reduced in rotary hearth furnaces. Midrex Corp., USA and Kobe Steel, Japan have jointly built
a plant in Japan (ITmk3 process) recently, for the production of iron nuggets starting with
composite pellets, and other efforts are also underway.
Introduction 13
The Bessemer process uses a cylindrical vessel (converter) as shown in Figure 1.3. The
converter was originally lined with siliceous refractories that could withstand attack from acidic
oxides. The entire vessel could be turned from the vertical to a horizontal position, as it was
mounted on trunions. Liquid iron (i.e. hot metal) from blast furnaces would first be poured into
the converter keeping it in the horizontal position. Blowing of air through the bottom tuyeres
would then be started keeping the converter vertical. Oxygen in the air blown would react with
Si, C and Mn present in hot metal to form oxides like SiO2, MnO, etc. These oxides along with
some FeO would form an acidic slag. Carbon would be oxidised into CO and CO2, which would
escape into the atmosphere directly from the mouth of the converter.
Nose
Converter shell
Refractory lining
Bath
Tuyeres
Bottom
Air Wind box
Since the oxidation reactions are exothermic, the liquid bath temperature would rise
automatically, without the need for using any extraneous fuel. This gave economic advantages,
and since the process was very fast (refining took hardly 20 minutes), it became ideally suitable
for the mass production of steel at a relatively low cost. Once refining was completed, the liquid
metal and slag were tapped out separately and the liquid steel cast as ingots. The ingots would
be subsequently hot forged/rolled into various shapes.
A major limitation of the process, however, was that it could not remove sulphur and
phosphorus present in hot metal. These harmful impurities often caused fractures during hot
working of the products (known as hot shortness). The oxygen content of Bessemer steel was
also inordinately high. In 1864, Mushet found that deoxidation of liquid steel using
ferromanganese after tapping into a ladle, lowered the oxygen level. This also increased the Mn
content of steel, which contributed towards preventing hot shortness arising from high levels of
sulphur. As far as phosphorus was concerned, in the original Bessemer process, hot metal made
only from low phosphorus Swedish iron ores was refined. In spite of these shortcomings, the
acid Bessemer process was predominant up to around 1910.
The phosphorus issue was tackled following the invention of the Thomas process by Sidney
G. Thomas in England in 1879. The basic Bessemer process or the Thomas process involved the
use of a basic oxide (burnt dolomite or magnesite) lining in the vessel. Basic oxides (e.g. CaO)
as flux were added during the blow to form a basic slag of high CaO content. This type of basic
Introduction 15
slag was capable of removing phosphorus in the form of calcium phosphate. This allowed
production of steel with acceptable levels of phosphorus even from hot metal containing
medium-to-high phosphorus.
However, both acid Bessemer and basic Bessemer (Thomas) steel suffered from the
presence of high levels of nitrogen, which got dissolved in the bath following the injection of
air from the converter bottom. With the invention of the Open Hearth process of steelmaking,
where low nitrogen steel could be produced, the Bessemer process started losing importance.
Virtually all the Bessemer converters were closed by 1950, and even those that remained were
later abandoned. The process is now non-existent; however, it is of historical interest since it
heralded the bulk production of liquid steel.
making even better quality of steel than that made by open hearth furnaces, owing to precise
process control and the ability to make tailor-made slags during the extended refining period.
As a result, special and alloy steels are almost exclusively produced by this process. The basic
electric arc furnace (EAF) is a major producer of steel at present, and will be discussed further
in detail in Chapter 19.
Another type of electric melting furnace is the coreless induction furnace, which was first
patented by Ferranti in Italy in 1877. The first large installation of an induction furnace was in
the USA in 1914. The process is capable of making high-quality special and alloy steels. High
frequency induction furnaces are also widely employed in laboratories for making small, trial
heats for experimental purposes. The capacity of individual furnaces ranges from a few
kilograms to 2025 tonnes. Induction furnaces have recently become extremely popular in India
for the production of pencil (small) ingots for subsequent processing into small shapes in
re-rolling mills.
BOS along with the EAF accounts for over 98% of world steel production today, as shown
in Figure 1.4 (Fruehan 1999).
70
BOS
60
BOS
50 EAF
Percentage of total
BOH
40
EAF
30
20
BOH
10
0
1970 1975 1980 1985 1990 1995
Figure 1.4 Percentage share of world crude steel production by various processes from
1970 to 1995.
Secondary steelmaking, ingot and continuous casting as well as hot metal pre-treatment are
presented in detail in later chapters.
1.4.1 Classification
Steel plants may be classified into two broad categories.
Integrated Steel Plants (ISPs) follow the Blast FurnaceBOF route of steelmaking. They
are relatively large in size with individual module capacities ranging from 1 to 5 Mt of
steel per year. A typical 3 Mtpa ISP would cover an area of 48 square km, i.e. a fairly
large area, since a series of processes is involved.
Mini Steel Plants (MSPs) use EAFs for steelmaking, and many of them have captive DRI
producing units. MSPs are smaller in size with module capacities generally between
0.5 Mt and 1 Mt per year, and in some cases up to 2 Mt per year. A typical 1 Mtpa MSP
would cover an area up to 2 square km to house EAFs and DRI producing facilities.
Downstream process stages, such as secondary steelmaking, continuous casting and rolling
are common facilities in both ISPs and MSPs.
As mentioned earlier (Section 1.1.4), steels may be broadly classified into:
1. Plain carbon steels account for about 90% of the worlds steel production, and are
produced in integrated steel plants and some in mini steel plants. Besides carbon, these
steels contain some amount of manganese and, in some cases, some other alloying
elements in relatively low concentrations. Plain carbon steels may be further classified
into low carbon (00.2% C), medium carbon (0.20.6% C) and high carbon
(0.61.5% C) steel.
2. Alloy steels are those steels where alloying elements like Ni, Cr, Mo, Co, etc. are
deliberately added in larger amounts. Alloy steels account for about 10% of global steel
production, and are almost always made in MSPs. Alloy steels may be classified into:
Low alloy steels up to 5% alloying elements
Medium alloy steels 510% alloying elements
High alloy steels above 10% alloying elements.
Steel products made from plain carbon or alloy steel may be classified according to the
shape of the final product as:
Long products bars, rounds, rails, channels, angles, etc.
Flat products plates, sheets, galvanised/coated sheets, etc.
These products are manufactured by rolling and account for virtually the entire amount of bulk
steel products. In addition, small quantities of special steel products (wheels, axles, gun barrels,
etc.) are manufactured by forging, and some others by direct casting (engine blocks, small
components, etc.).
Introduction 19
900
World crude steel
Actual curve
800
Tendency
700
End of
East-West
Steel production, Mt
Figure 1.5 Worlds crude steel production per year in the 20th century.
Mysore Iron and Steel Works at Bhadravati in 1918 (later renamed as Visvesvaraya Iron
and Steel Ltd.).
Along with these ISPs, some electric furnace-based small-scale steelmakers, notably Guest
Keen and Williams, Mukand Iron and Steel Co., J. K. Iron and Steel Co., etc. were also installed.
The total crude steel production in India (in 1950) soon after independence was about 1 Mt/year.
After 1950, in the second Five-Year Plan, the Government of India decided to go in for large-
scale industrialisation for which steel was required. Hindustan Steel Ltd. was established in the
public sector and under its overall control, three integrated steel plants, each of around 1 Mt/year
capacity, were set up at Durgapur, Rourkela and Bhilai with British, German and Russian
collaboration respectively. Later the name of HSL was changed to the Steel Authority of India
Ltd. (SAIL). SAIL now has four more steel plants under its control, viz. Bokaro Steel Ltd.,
Visvesvaraya Iron and Steel, Alloy Steel Plant (Durgapur), and very recently, Indian Iron and
Steel, besides a few other auxiliary units. Another major public sector steel plant, Rashtriya Ispat
Nigam Ltd. (RINL) was installed at Visakhapatnam.
Many more steel plants with capacities higher than 1 Mt/year as well as a multitude of
smaller plants have been commissioned in the private sector throughout India. The existing
plants have been modernised to incorporate the latest developments like: BOFs, secondary
steelmaking, continuous casting, etc. and, in many cases, the plants have been expanded
substantially.
The major steel plants in India at present are listed in Appendix 1 at the end of the book.
The total crude steel production in India was 38.2 Mt in 2005, and 44 Mt in the year 2006. There
is general consensus that the Indian steel industry is now on a substantial growth path. Several
steelmakers, both from India and overseas, have announced ambitious plans for large capacity
new plants, along with plans for expansion of the existing units. The National Steel Policy
announced recently by the Government of India envisages production of 110120 Mt/year of
crude steel by the year 2020 (figure recently revised to 180 Mt).
A recent landmark event has been the acquisition of Corus Steel (UK and the Netherlands)
by Tata Steel. There have been some smaller acquisitions of overseas plants too.
Though the industry has responded to these issues, particularly in recent times, much more will
need to be accomplished to meet the ever-increasing pressures of sustainability issues of
tomorrow.
The production of steel in an ISP involves a series of processes, each with different input
materials and emissions of various residual materials and wastes. Figure 1.6 shows the overall
energy/material balance of the major components in a modern, efficient ISP (UNEP and IISI,
1997). In contrast, the energy and material balance of a typical EAF-based MSP showing the
major inputs and outputs is presented in Figure 1.7 (UNEP and IISI, 1997).
28 kg CO 2.3 t CO2
2.2 kg SO2 0.3 kg VOC
1500 kg iron ore 2.3 kg NO2 1.1 kg particulate
610 kg coking coal 65 g other (metals, H2S)
60 kg mineral coal
150 kg lump ore 1 tonne of crude steel
200 kg flux
175 kg scrap
5 m3 water
455 kg slag
3 m3 waste water (ss, oil, NH3) 56 kg dust/sludges
[1.6 kg suspended solids 16 kg millscale
150 g oil 4 kg refractory
110 g ammoniacal nitrogen 0.8 kg oil
8 g (phenols, meths, cyanides)] 54 kg other
Input energy breakdown: 19.2 GJ coal; 5.2 GJ steam; 3.5 GJ electrical (364 kWh); 0.3 GJ oxygen;
0.04 GJ natural gas
Output energy breakdown: 5.2 GJ steam; 3.4 GJ electrical (359 kWh); 0.9 GJ coal tar;
0.3 GJ benzene
Figure 1.6 Energy/materials balance per tonne of steel for an efficient, modern integrated steel
plant.
2.5 kg CO 120 kg CO2
60 g SO2 165 g particulate
0.5 kg NO2
1130 kg scrap/DRI/hot/cold iron
10 kg alloying elements 1 tonne of crude steel
40 kg flux
146 kg slag
19 kg furnace dust
2 m3 wastewater (ss, oil, NH3) 16 kg millscale
2.5 kg sludge
17 kg refractories
0.8 kg oil
3 kg other
Input energy breakdown: 5.5 GJ electrical (572 kWh); 1.3 GJ natural gas (40 m3); 450 MJ coal/coke (15 kg);
205 MJ oxygen (30 m3); 120 MJ electrode consumption (3.5 kg)
Figure 1.7 Energy/materials balance per tonne of steel for an EAF plant.
It can be seen that large quantities of CO, CO2, SO2, NOx as well as suspended solids, waste
water, and other liquid effluents are generated during steel production. The quantities involved
are relatively lower in the case of EAF-based plants, but potential pollutants are nevertheless
present. Governments all over the world under pressure from society at large are actively
22 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
monitoring the extent of gaseous, solid and liquid discharges, and stricter regulations are being
formulated. As a consequence, steel plants are having to invent and adopt many measures to
control pollution of air, water and soil. The day is not very far when no new process will be
given licence, unless it is environment-friendly.
A beginning has already been made as far as carbon dioxide is concerned, and steel plants
all over the world are being given CO2 credits based on the extent of CO2 generated vis--vis
an agreed benchmark. Although CO2 has no direct adverse impact on the ecosystem, it is
increasingly being viewed as an air pollutant because of its importance as a greenhouse gas,
i.e. a gas contributes to global warming. The steel industry is a significant generator of CO2
(2.5 t/tonne of liquid steel all over the world, and as much as 3.5 t/tonne in India) owing to the
unavoidable use of carbon as the reducing agent in the production of hot metal from iron oxide,
and partly from the use of carbon as an energy source. All-out attempts have been made to
consume less and less energy in ironmaking and steelmaking the reduction in energy
consumption in the German steel industry is shown as an example in Figure 1.8 (UNEP and IISI,
1997). There is no doubt that the steel industry is a major user of energy in Japan steel
accounts for 10% of total energy consumption, and in Germany for 6%. About 95% of the
energy input into an ISP comes from coal, 34% from gaseous fuels and 12% from liquid fuels.
Energy consumption in GJ/t
30
28
crude steel
26
24
22
20
1960 1970 1980 1989
Gaseous and volatile compounds: Carbon monoxide, which is a major constituent of blast
furnace, and BOF gas are highly toxic. They can prove fatal if their concentration in air exceeds
1000 ppm. Coke oven and by-products effluents, such as ammonia, phenol, benzol,
hydrocarbons, etc. can also be potential health hazards.
Noise pollution: Excessive noise can cause hearing impairment, stress, etc. and noise
levels above 75 dB are considered harmful. Blast furnaces, oxygen plants, powerhouses, etc. are
areas where noise levels can be high in a steel plant.
Solid wastes: Huge quantities of wastes are generated during ironmaking and steelmaking.
Sinter fines, coal dust, coke breeze, bag house dust, gas cleaning plant sludge, millscale, blast
furnace and BOF slag, etc. are the common solid wastes generated in a steel plant amounting
to almost 1.5 t per tonne of crude steel made. Therefore, waste management is an important
activity in any steel plant. This not only includes safe disposal so as not to affect soil and
groundwater in the long run, but also includes converting the wastes into some useful
commodity. Use of blast furnace slag for cement making, recirculation of BOF slag in sinter
plants, use of sludge in making tiles, etc. are good examples.
REFERENCES
Biswas A.K., Minerals and Materials in Ancient India, Vol. 1, D.K. Printworld, New Delhi
(1996), p. 392.
Fruehan R.J., Making, Shaping and Treating of Steel, AISE, 11th ed., Vol. 2 (1999), p. 11.
Sarma S.K., S.N. Rao and B.N. Singh, Perspectives and Planning for Steel Industry, RINL,
Visakhapatnam (2001).
Steel Industry and the Environment, Technical Report no. 38, UNEP and IISI (1997).
2
Overview of Blast
Furnace Ironmaking
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Lump iron ore (at least above 10 mm in size) in the form of haematite (Fe2O3) or magnetite
(Fe3O4) or iron oxide in the form of pellets or sinter prepared from iron ore fines (below 8 mm)
are the source of iron units in blast furnaces. To meet the thermal as well as the chemical energy
requirements and to support the burden during melting of the iron bearing burden, coke along
with coal (as an injectant) and oxygen, primarily as air, are fed to blast furnaces. Within the
furnace the solid inputs melt after reduction of the oxide. In order to separate the gangue in the
feed materials from liquid iron, flux in the form of limestone/lime/dolomite is added, either
independently or through sinter.
Chapter 1, Section 1.1 briefly presented the evolution of blast furnace ironmaking in Europe
in the Middle Ages till the end of the nineteenth century. Section 1.2 briefly presented the
evolution of blast furnace ironmaking since 1880. This evolution has been divided into the
following periods.
(i) The period from 1880 to 1950, when most of the developments were in the nature of
engineering, including improved furnace design.
(ii) From 1950s, advances in blast furnace (BF) ironmaking have been remarkable. It is
largely because of much better understanding of the underlying sciences and inner
working of the furnace. These developments brought about major improvements not only
in design and engineering, but also in the metallurgy of the process.
Chapter 1 also itemised the important developments. Chapters 512 contain detailed
presentations of various aspects of the science and technology of BF ironmaking. However, in
order to understand them properly, a general knowledge of the BF ironmaking process is the
essential prerequisite. This is the objective of the present chapter. The purpose is to provide a
broad exposure to readers so that they have a working knowledge. Here, the descriptions will
be brief. Traditional features and modern developments will be put together without distinction
for the sake of conciseness and clarity. Some data will also be included to give an overall idea.
However, such data should be viewed as approximate only.
24
Overview of Blast Furnace Ironmaking 25
Top gas (CO + CO2 + N2 mostly) 1. Iron bearing burden (iron ore + sinter
(some H2 + H2O) + Flue dust + pellet)
2. Coke
3. Additional flux (as required)
Stockline
Moisture removal
300C 3Fe2O3 + CO = 2Fe3O4 + CO2
Fe3O4 + CO = 3FeO + CO2
700C C + CO2 = 2CO
CaCO3 = CaO + CO2
FeO + CO = Fe + CO2
1000C C + CO2 = 2CO
FeO + C = Fe + CO
1200C SiO2 + 2C = Si + 2CO
MnO + C = Mn + CO
1900C
P2O5 + 5C = 2P + 5CO
S + (O) + C = (S) + CO
1500C 2C + O2 = 2CO
H2O + C = H2 + CO
Pre-heated air enriched O2 Slag
Moisture + Pulverised coal Hot metal
The major reactions are also given in Figure 2.1. These may be classified into the following
categories:
Removal of moisture from the raw materials
Reduction of iron oxides by CO
Gasification of carbon by CO2
Dissociation of CaCO3 (where raw limestone is also added)
Reduction of FeO by carbon
Reduction of some other oxides of ore by carbon
Combustion of coke and coal in front of tuyeres.
The outputs from the furnace are:
Molten iron (i.e. hot metal)
Molten slag
Gas at a temperature of around 200C, containing CO, CO2, N2, moisture and some dust
particles.
The hot metal is tapped through the tap hole several times a day into either open ladles or
torpedo ladles and transferred to the steelmaking shop for further refining. The ladles are lined
with refractory. Excess molten iron is cast into pigs in a pig casting machine for further use as
feedstock in foundries or in steelmaking shops. The molten slag is tapped from time to time
through the slag notch (i.e. separate tap hole) into the slag ladle, and is used as feedstock for
the manufacture of slag cement, etc. The top gas is known as blast furnace gas. It has a
Overview of Blast Furnace Ironmaking 27
considerable fuel value, since it contains carbon monoxide. However, as stated in Chapter 1, the
dust has to be removed first in a gas cleaning unit. The gas is stored and then mostly utilised
in the blast furnace shop itself for pre-heating of air and running turbines to drive air blowers.
Chapter 5 will present details of reactions and their physicochemical aspects. Chapter 6 has
coverage of thermal-chemical features of the process, Chapter 7 presents various internal zones,
gas flow, etc.
Top ring
Top Offtake
cone
Armour
Throat
Throat Stockline level
Height of working volume
diameter
Height of inner volume
Height of total volume
Stack
Shell
Belly Tuyere
Bosh Bustle pipe
Tuyere stock
Furnace pad or
foundation
The details of the top arrangement will be presented later. Pre-heated air enters the tuyeres
through the refractory lined bustle pipe, which is like a horizontal circular ring around the
furnace. Iron notch is the tap hole for molten iron. It is kept sealed by refractory clay. For
tapping, the clay seal is opened by a remote-controlled mechanical device. After tapping, the iron
notch is again sealed by clay using the same device. Cinder notch is the hole for tapping molten
slag. It is above the iron notch, since the slag has a lower density compared to iron and floats
above the molten iron in the hearth. The furnace is built on a massive reinforced-concrete
foundation.
Distributor
Small bell
Gas uptake
Big bell
Throat Armour
Brick lining
Shaft or
stack Stack cooling plate
Steel shell
Bosh cooling
Bosh angle
Belly bosh Bustle main
Figure 2.3 Cross section of a blast furnace showing the different zones.
Shaft or stack
This zone extends from the stockline down to the mantle level. It is the zone in which the burden
is completely solid. The charge gets heated from 200C at the stockline level to nearly
11001200C by the time it descends to the bottom of the stack. In order to ensure free fall of
the charge material, as it expands progressively with the progressive rise in temperature, the
cross section of the furnace is uniformly increased to almost double the size from the stockline
to the mantle level. Since much of the iron oxide reduction occurs in the stack, the success of
the blast furnace process depends on the efficiency with which the countercurrent gassolid
interaction is brought about in the stack. It is this requirement that has led to the use of
agglomerates like sinter and pellets as well as closer sizing (1020 mm) of lump ore, including
screening of fines immediately prior to charging.
Bosh
The charge materials begin to soften and fuse as they come down into the bottom of the stack.
The next lower zone is called the bosh in which melting of the burden, except that of coke, takes
place. The gangue and flux combine to form the slag. The furnace walls in this region are either
parallel to some extent and then taper down, or entirely tapered down in order to reduce the
sectional area by about 2025% in harmony with the resultant decrease in the apparent volume
of the charge. The burden permeability in this region is mainly maintained by the presence of
solid coke. This, therefore, dictates that only coke of adequate strength and size should be used
for efficient operation. Any untoward degradation of coke leads to decreased permeability in the
bosh region and adversely affects the operation of the blast furnace.
Hearth
Although most of the coke burns at the tuyere level, a small fraction descends even into the
hearth (to form the deadman, which either sits on the hearth or floats just above it), where it
dissolves in the metal to its near saturation. The entire charge is molten and tends to stratify into
slag and metal layers in the hearth from where these are tapped separately. The cross section of
the furnace below the tuyeres decreases since the liquids are dense without pores and voids, thus
leading to decrease in volume. The walls of the hearth are parallel and the hearth is the smallest
cross section of the furnace.
30 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Bosh plate
9
C
Plan of tuyere plane, showing
Tuyere Centre line of tuyeres
the extent of penetration of
combustion zone Plan of tuyere and bosh plate
Plane no. 5
Bosh plate
20 1610
6 40 82 40 6 A 30 A
A B A
A
A Centre line of tuyeres
Zone of 10 30
14.6
combustion
A Tuyere B
Section 1.2.1). It is only the coke which remains solid down to the tuyere level and bears the
weight of the overlying burden in the furnace. More working height requires stronger coke.
Therefore, the coke strength sets the limit to the working height (and, therefore, working
volume).
From the earlier coke rates of around 1000 kg/thm in 1950 without any coal injection, it is
possible to operate blast furnaces today with as little as 350 kg/thm of coke with coal injection
of 125175 kg/thm. Efforts towards enhancing the blast furnace performance have been
primarily directed at (a) raw materials to improve the furnace permeability and increase wind
acceptance for efficient coke burning, (b) changing the operating practices and work culture, and
(c) increasing the hot blast temperature to reduce the fuel rate and economise the production.
The decade of 1970 introduced the concept of auxiliary fuel and steam injection. With the
use of improved sensors and probes, the understanding of the process has improved and the day
is not far away when the ideal situation of 250 kg coke and 250 kg coal per tonne of hot metal
will emerge (Table 2.2; Chatterjee et al. 2001). This would be close to the theoretical minimum
amount of coke required for blast furnace ironmaking.
32 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Table 2.2 Progressive reduction in blast furnace coke consumption over the years
60% Al2O3 (known as high duty fire-clay) are employed for the lower stack, belly and bosh.
There have been attempts to use silicon carbide bricks in the bosh region as inner refractory
lining. Carbon is the popular refractory in the hearth. It has a much higher thermal conductivity
compared to that of fire-clay (3 W/m/K for amorphous carbon and 40 W/m/K for graphite). This
helps to keep the lining cooler owing to the higher rate of heat transfer.
However, for a longer lining life, it is necessary to carry out extensive water cooling of the
refractory. This not only keeps the refractory temperature lower, but also allows the formation
of a protective layer of frozen metal and slag on the inner wall of the refractory lining. The
design of the cooler depends on the size of the furnace and its location in the furnace. Box
coolers are either cast iron boxes with steel pipes inside for the stack region, or copper boxes
with copper tubes for the belly and bosh regions. These coolers are inserted into the refractory
brick work at various locations. Modern trend is to go for copper, even for the stack region
(shown schematically in Figure 2.3).
Stave coolers are now popular for the bosh and hearth. Staves are large cast iron water
jackets that cover almost the entire outer surface of these regions of the furnace. External water
sprays are also employed as an alternative to stave coolers. The bottom carbon lining of the
hearth is cooled either by forced air circulation or by passage of water through the pipes, which
are embedded in the lining.
A major problem concerning cooling by water flow in pipes inserted into the lining, is the
deposition of insoluble salts such as calcium carbonate on inner linings of the pipes. This offers
resistance to heat transfer. Rise in local temperature leads to the formation of steam in extreme
cases and consequent choking of channels. In order to avoid this, only demineralised and cooled
water should be circulated in a closed loop.
Skip bucket
Skip
Small bell
Gas uptake
Large bell
(a) Small bell and large bell both closed; skip (b) Large bell remains closed while small bell
bucket tipped to dump charge in hopper opens to admit charge to large bell hopper.
above small bell. Gas flowing from top of
furnace through uptakes located in dome (top
cone).
Receiving hopper
Revolving hopper
Gas seal
Top cone
(c) Small bell closed to prevent escape of gas (d) Both bells closed, ready to repeat charging cycle.
to atmosphere and large bell open to admit Note that the rod supporting the large bell passes
charge to the furnace. through a hollow rod supporting the small bell,
permitting independent operation of bells.
Chapter 10 has discussed the importance of uniform gas flow for smooth operation, as well
as efficient productivity of a blast furnace. Efforts towards this goal are three-fold, viz.
Screening of solid charges before charging into the furnace to eliminate fines below a
certain size
Agglomeration of fines by sintering, pelletising
Proper top charging device to make burden size distribution as uniform as possible on
horizontal section.
Overview of Blast Furnace Ironmaking 35
In order to improve the uniformity of charge distribution in horizontal section of the furnace,
a revolving chute is an added feature. Material is introduced onto the small bell through two
openings, each equipped with a seal valve, making sealing more effective. The revolving chute
distributes the materials evenly on the small bell, and this assists in realising a more uniform
distribution. Figure 2.6 shows two types of stockline profiles obtained by this device. It may be
noted that there is some segregation of small and large particles. This is due to their different
trajectories when they fall into the furnace upon opening of the big bell.
2 2 2 2
Ore Coke
1 1
1 1 Ore Coke
V profile M profile
Figure 2.6 Typical burden profiles showing ore and coke layers, qualitative size segregation in ore
layer (1 large and 2 small particles); iron ore includes sinter and pellets.
There have been subsequent modifications for improvement of charge distribution of the
bell-type charging, as follows.
Bell-type with movable throat armour
Four-bell charging device.
With the advent of the movable throat armour systems in which a movable deflector is
introduced into the stream of material falling from the big bell, a much wider cross section of
the stockline can be controlled. Separate charging of iron-bearing materials and coke at different
deflector settings as well as the proper distribution of fines has improved furnace performance
and reduced the coke rate.
However, the most modern device is the so-called Bell-less Top charging equipment,
invented by Paul Wurth in Luxembourg in 1972. All modern furnaces are now having this
system. Figure 2.7 shows this system. This new system comprises a combination of a hopper and
gate. The material is fed on to a rotating chute at variable angles, through a system of seal valves
and flow control gates. Mathematical models and instrumentation systems are available to
predict the stockline profile and to measure the effect of change in the distribution pattern. All
modern furnaces incorporate a high top pressure operation, where the exit gas pressure is above
1.52 atm gauge. This leads to more leakage as well as rapid erosion of bells. Bell-less top
performs much better. In addition to this, the control of charge distribution is much superior.
The distribution monitoring system includes the following:
Heat flux monitoring equipment to measure the heat flow in different zones (both above
and under the burden)
Profile meters for the measurement of surface profiles
Thermocouples in the throat, stack and bosh regions to measure temperature
36 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Hopper positioning CL
mechanism Receiving hopper
Equalising valve
Relief valve
Figure 2.7 Bell-less top with pressurised hoppers and a rotating distributing chute.
Stack pressure monitoring and pressure drop measurement along the furnace height
Special instruments such as infrared probes to monitor the burden surface temperature,
devices in the stack region to measure individual layer thicknesses and local descent rate,
and tuyere probes to sample materials at the tuyeres level
Mathematical models for charge distribution control, overall heat and mass balance and
interpretation of probe data.
The advantages accruing from improved distribution control can be summarised as follows:
Increased productivity, decreased coke rate, improved furnace life
Reduced refractory erosion
Improved wind acceptance and reduced hanging as well as slips
Improved efficiency of gas utilisation and its indirect reduction
Lower silicon content in hot metal and consistency in the hot metal quality
Reduced tuyere losses and minimisation of scaffold formation
Lower dust emission owing to uniform distribution of fines.
All these advantages have improved the overall efficiency, thereby making the process more
competitive.
Overview of Blast Furnace Ironmaking 37
Bleeder
Uptake
Downcomer
p
Ski
Bells
Stove
Ore bridge Dust catcher
Bustle pipe
Blast furnace
ine
Grab
Incl
bucket
Scrubber
Turbo
blowers
Pillars
Hoist Foundation Slag side Chimney
Skip pit house Metal
Manhole
Refractory checkers
Segment insulating wall
(b)
Breast wall
Combustion chamber
Well wall
Burner
To chimney
Figure 2.9 Modern hot blast stoves: (a) vertical section, (b) horizontal section showing details of
column support for checker work.
The stove operates in a cyclic manner. During the heating cycle, the blast furnace gas is
burnt with air in the combustion chamber. The hot flue gas delivers heat to the bricks and heats
them up. This requires 2 4 hours. Then the combustion is stopped and air at room temperature
is blown through the stove in the reverse direction. The air, blown by turbo-blowers, gets heated
through contact with hot checker bricks and then flows into the blast furnace through tuyeres.
This is the cooling cycle of the stove, which lasts 12 hours. Since cooling is faster than heating,
a minimum of three stoves is requiredone on cooling and two on heating.
A new blast furnace top charging technique has been recently developed by Siemens VAI
and is known as SIMETAL Gimble top. Its design consists of special mechatronic packages that
help to generate any burden profile that is desired by directing the charge material on the stock
line. The worlds first Gimble top has been installed in the C blast furnace of Tata Steel.
REFERENCES
Chatterjee, Amit, in Steel Times International, Nov./Dec., 2006.
Chatterjee, Amit, Ramesh Singh, and Banshidar Pandey, Metallics for SteelmakingProduction
and Use, Allied Publishers, 2001.
3
Overview of Modern
Steelmaking
3.1 INTRODUCTION
In Chapter 1, Section 1.1.4, the early history of steelmaking was presented in brief. It was
mentioned there that plain carbon steels constitute about 90% of the worlds steel, and these
steels have a long history. Alloy steels are of more recent origin. In Chapter 1, Section 1.3, the
evolution of modern steelmaking starting from Henry Bessemers invention of converter/
pneumatic steelmaking, which heralded the advent of the use of steel in large quantities as an
important engineering material, was also discussed in brief.
The original Bessemer process, i.e. acid Bessemer was invented in 1856, while the basic
Bessemer, i.e. the Thomas process was patented in 1879. The open hearth process of
steelmaking began in 1868, and soon replaced the Bessemer process. The open hearth process
dominated the global production of plain carbon steels for about one hundred years. Electric arc
furnaces (EAF) and electric induction furnaces are also about a hundred years old. The LD
process was invented in Linz and Donawitz (two towns in Austria) in 19521953 and now
dominates the worlds steel production.
The present chapter contains an outline of the modern steelmaking and casting practices. A
detailed description will follow in Chapters 15 to 23.
hearth furnaces. The new process was quicker, i.e. steel of the required carbon content could be
made in less than 60 minutes instead of 68 hours required in open hearth furnaces. Also no
external heat was necessary, because the heat generated by the oxidation of carbon and the other
impurities in hot metal (mainly silicon and phosphorus) made the BOF process autothermal, i.e.
self-sufficient in thermal energy. BOF steelmaking (the terminology to be used to denote LD
steelmaking from now on in this book) continued to have a greater share in the years that
followed, but a real breakthrough in the maturity of this process came in the late 1970s and early
1980s with the introduction of mixed blowinga combination of all the advantages of top-
blowing along with thermodynamic equilibrium at the slag-metal interface brought about by
limited gas injection from the converter bottom.
An important feature of BOF steelmaking is its high productivity, which necessitates a
continuous supply of molten iron from blast furnaces since the BOF process cycle cannot be
interrupted and the converter kept idle for long intervals. This imposes some restrictions on the
overall flexibility of the process. In contrast, the EAF route where electrical energy is used for
meeting the thermal requirements and gaseous/solid oxygen sources (like iron ore) fulfil the
requirements of oxidising the impurities in hot metal, can be started/stopped as required to match
variants like steel demand, availability of input materials, etc. EAFs can be economical in heat
sizes ranging from 30 t to 200 t while BOFs are normally between 100 t and 300 t.
The EAFs originally depended on the availability of scrap and were restricted to the
production of long products owing to the heat cycle time and the heat size. However, when
increased accent on production efficiencies resulted in lower generation of scrap, EAFs were
confronted with the problem of scrap availabilityboth in terms of quantity and quality. At this
stage, EAFs resorted to the use of hot metal, DRI and other substitutes for scrap. This not only
made EAF steelmaking less dependent on the vagaries of scrap supply, but also made EAFs
capable of meeting the stringent demands of final steel composition with respect to the
concentration of harmful elements like copper, chromium, nickel, tin, etc. As a result, EAFs can
now be used for the production of even flat products, thereby leading to further growth in EAF-
based steel production.
It is estimated that by 2010, the EAF route and the BOF route will have virtually equal
shares in global production of steel. Figure 1.4 in Chapter 1 has shown the worlds share of BOF,
EAF and BOH (basic open hearth) steelmaking processes from 1970 to 1995, clearly
highlighting the steady growth of BOF and EAF steelmaking and decline of the BOH process
in that period. It is estimated that by 2010, the contribution of open hearth furnacesthe
dominant method of making steel till the early seventieswill come down to zero.
adjusted to match the melt weight. Inclusive of the charging and discharging of steel and slag,
sampling for temperature and bath analysis, the typical tap-to-tap times range between 40 and
60 minutes. Top-blown oxygen steelmaking is thus characterised by high productivity.
Therefore, it is not surprising that this system was adopted for bulk steelmaking almost as soon
as it was developed.
The impingement of the oxygen jets at supersonic speed on the molten iron bath, results in
metal droplets being ejected from the bath by impact, thereby increasing the metal surface area
and the rate of oxidation of the impurities in molten iron. Right at the beginning of each heat,
scrap is charged into the converter along with hot metal to act as a coolant for the heat generated
by the oxidation reactions. More often than not, iron ore is also added during the blow so that
the oxidation of silicon, phosphorus, manganese and carbon, which are all exothermic reactions,
do not result in inordinate increase in bath temperature. Low carbon steels (around 0.030.04%
carbon) are normally tapped from such converters at 16201660C. Lime and sometimes other
slag forming agents, are added during the blow to form a slag capable of holding the impurities
in the form of complex oxides.
A schematic diagram of a top-blown oxygen vessel is presented in Figure 3.1.
Oxygen lance
Bath level
Basic refractory
lining
Bath level
Hydrocarbon
Oxygen
closer to equilibrium, encourage early formation of a fluid slag, reduce the oxygen content of
the steel tapped, and decrease the height requirements of the converter building since no top
lance equipment needs to be provided. Therefore, it became possible to retrofit bottom-blown
converters in the existing open hearth shops from the late 1970s with less capital cost in
comparison to BOFs.
Ar or N2
This modification enables the production of ultra-low carbon steels like in bottom-blown
processes, along with flexibility in gas-slag-metal interaction like in top-blown converters, where
Overview of Modern Steelmaking 43
the lance heightdistance between the lance tip and the top of the bathcan be altered to match
the blowing conditions required for carbon or phosphorus removal (the former is a gas-metal
reaction while the latter is a slag-metal reaction).
(a) Alternating current (AC) furnance (b) Direct current (DC) furnance
The main advantage of EAFs lies in their ability to accept scrap, DRI, and molten hot metal
in various proportions since whatever external energy is required, can always be provided by
controlling the electrical power supplied. Furnace efficiency can be improved by the combined
injection of carbon and oxygen through water-cooled supersonic lances at rates as high as
45 Nm3/t. While earlier, 600700 kWh of electrical power was used per tonne of liquid steel,
modern-day furnaces with injection facilities, ultra-high power transformers, hot metal in the
charge, etc. consume 300400 kWh per tonne.
In fact, EAF designs today are being challenged by the ever increasing thermal loads,
created by electric power inputs as high as 1 MW/t, and increasing rates of oxygen injection into
the furnace. The aim is to reach heat cycle times of around 40 minutes, thereby producing more
than 40 heats per day (like BOFs) in furnaces ranging in size of up to 300 t, though furnaces
ranging from 30 t to 150200 t are more commonly used. The AC electric arc furnace is the
44 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
ideal melting unit for the production of all steel grades, from standard carbon grades up to high-
alloyed special and stainless steel grades. In areas where the power grid is either weak or
unstable, DC EAFs are preferred. The unique design of the anode in such furnaces promotes
smooth and uniform transfer of the current through the melt.
EAFs can be of normal power or UHP (ultra high power) with one or two electrodes, single
or twin-shell, as well as with and without a top shaft furnace (used for pre-heating the scrap
before charging). However, a feature of all electric furnaces is that a considerable amount of
noise is emitted; typical noise levels are between 125 and 139 dB(A). Moreover, their operation
(particularly initial arcing) causes flickering in the grid.
in primary steelmaking (as done in a ladle furnace), or during the vacuum treatment itself. While
electrical energy is normally used to provide the heat, in some cases, particularly in systems
operating under vacuum, chemical heating is also resorted to by blowing oxygen along with the
addition of aluminium. Blowing of oxygen in vacuum is the technique used to produce ultra low
carbon (ULC) steels (less than 0.03% and even as low as 0.001% carbon).
Steelmaking furnace
Ladle
Tundish
Mould
Secondary cooling
Withdrawl section
Bending roll
Cutting stand
The original continuous casting machines were of the vertical type and required very tall
buildings for housing the equipment. They were later replaced by vertical mould machines with
bending rolls, or by curved mould machines.
4
General Physicochemical
Fundamentals
4.1 INTRODUCTION
Ironmaking and steelmaking involve a variety of chemical reactions as well as other
physicochemical processes such as viscous flow, interfacial phenomena, mass transfer, etc. at
high temperatures. Therefore, physical chemistry constitutes the most important scientific
fundamental for understanding the metallurgical aspects of ironmaking and steelmaking. Again,
amongst the physicochemical fundamentals, chemical thermodynamics, consisting of reaction
free energies and enthalpies, chemical equilibria, has found the most widespread application.
Such applications have been possible following research efforts by metallurgists, physical
chemists and others over a period of several decades. Studies have been undertaken on
thermodynamics, kinetics and other physicochemical phenomena for ironmaking and
steelmaking reactions and systems at high temperatures. The laws of thermodynamics were well-
established by the beginning of the 20th century. However, they could be applied to ironmaking
and steelmaking only after the required data, such as reaction free energies and enthalpies,
activity-versus-composition relations, etc. were determined through experimental measurements.
Special correlations were also proposed.
Chapters 5, 15, and 20 shall deal with details of physical chemistry for blast furnace
ironmaking, primary steelmaking, and secondary steelmaking respectively. Some other chapters
will also contain these topics partly, and hence would not be covered here. The purpose of this
chapter is to present the basic physicochemical fundamentals, which would constitute the basis
for subsequent chapters. The basic objective of this chapter is to make the text self-contained for
the convenience of readers. This background needs to be kept in mind before proceeding further.
(a) Mechanical equilibrium, i.e. uniformity of pressure throughout the system in the
absence of other force fields.
(b) Thermal equilibrium, i.e. uniformity of temperature throughout the system.
(c) Chemical equilibrium, i.e. uniformity of chemical potentials of all components
(e.g. elements and compounds) throughout the system.
Chemical potential will be discussed again; at this stage, the relation between chemical
equilibrium and Gibbs free energy (G) will be taken up.
Activity
fi
By definition, ai = (4.1)
fi0
where
ai = activity of component i (element or compound) in a solution at temperature T
fi = fugacity of component i in the solution at temperature T
fi0 = fugacity of component i in its standard state (i.e. pure element or compound i at T and
under 1 standard atmosphere, i.e. 760 mm mercury pressure).
fi0
Hence, by definition at standard state, ai = =1
fi0
In an ideal gas, fi = pi and fi0 = p0i . Since pi0 = 1 atmosphere by definition of standard state,
in an ideal gas,
ai = pi (4.2)
where pi is the partial pressure component i (in atm.) in an ideal gas mixture.
It may be noted here that ai, by definition of Eq. (4.1), is dimensionless, although in
Eq. (4.2) it is numerically equal to pi in atm. unit.
Gi is for component i. The average of any property (including free energy) per mole of the
solution is known as integral molar property.
Hence, G = integral molar free energy of the solution at temperature T
k
= XiGi (4.4)
i =1
Equation (4.18) represents the formation of an oxide from elements, for which DG0 is the
standard free energy of formation (DG0f ) of oxide per mole O2.
For equilibrium calculations, the values of DG0f as function of temperature are required. A
precise functional form is
DG0f = A + BT + CT ln T (4.21)
where, A, B and C are empirical constants, and T is the temperature in kelvin. However, for
practical applications, the following simpler equation is often employed, viz.
DG0f = A + BT (4.22)
Figure 4.1 presents DG0f for formation of oxides of importance in iron and steelmaking as
a function of temperature. The unit of DG0f is joules (J) per mole. Table 4.1 compiles the values
of A and B for these oxides. In Figure 4.1, the elements and oxides are at their respective
standard states (i.e. pure). For such a situation, the activities of both M and MXOY are 1, by
convention.
0
200 O4
Fe 3 CO 2
=2 =2 O
NiO + O 2
+ O 2
= 2N 2
=2 FeO CO2N 2 + O 2
+ O 2 6 2
2Ni M
= 2FeO
O C + O2 = CO2
2Fe +
2
400
2C + M
O =
DGf0 = RT ln pO2, kJ/mol
2 2CO
M
M
r O3
600 /3)C 2
= (2 MnO M
+ O2 =2
)Cr + O2
(4/3 2Mn
iO 2
=S
O2
800 Si + O2
O2 = Ti
Ti +
l O3
/3)A 2
= (2 B B
+ O2
)Al
1000 (4/3 M
O
Mg
=2
O2
g+ CaO
2M =2
+ O2
2Ca
1200
0 400 800 1200 1600
Temperature, C
Figure 4.1 Standard free energy of formation of some oxides as function of temperature.
54 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
On the basis of Eq. (4.17), the equilibrium relations for reaction (4.18) would be
( aM O ) 2/Y
DG 0f (18) = RT ln K18 = - RT ln
x y
( aM )2X/Y aO
2 eq
1
= - RT ln
1 pO2 eq
1
= - RT ln = RT ln [ pO2]eq (4.23)
pO2 eq
EXAMPLE 4.1
pH2O pCO2
Calculate the ratio in a H2 H2O gas mixture and the ratio in a CO CO2 gas
pH2 pCO
mixture at equilibrium with pO2 = 106 atmosphere at 1600C. Also calculate the chemical
potential of oxygen.
1
Solution: H2(g) + O2(g) = H2O(g) (for H2 H2O gas mixture) (Ex. 4.1)
2
From the data in Table 4.1, DGf 0 at 1873 K (i.e. 1600C) of the above reaction is 142,625 J/mol.
Now,
p 1
DGf0 = RT ln K = RT ln H 2O
pH2 ( pO2 )1/2
eq
Putting the values,
pH2O
= 9.50
pH2
Also,
mO2 = RT ln pO2 = 215.1 kJ/mol
For CO CO2 gas mixture:
1
CO(g) + O2(g) = CO2(g) (Ex.4.2)
2
General Physicochemical Fundamentals 55
Table 4.1 Standard free energy of formation (J mol1) of some compounds as a function of
temperature (at the indicated temperature range)
DGf0 = A + BT
Combining free energies of formation of CO and CO2 from Table 4.1, DG 0 for the above reaction
p 1
at 1873 K is 119,805 J/mol. Noting that K is CO2 ,
pCO ( pO2 )1/2
eq
pCO2
= 2.194
pCO
56 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
EXAMPLE 4.2
pH2O
Predict whether solid FeO can be reduced to metallic iron by these gas mixtures at and
pH2
pCO2
ratios calculated in Example 4.1, at a temperature of 1000C.
pCO
Solution: FeO(s) + H2(g) = Fe(s) + H2O(g); DG0 = DGf0(H2O) DGf0(FeO) (Ex.4.3)
0
From data in Table 4.1, DG for reaction at 1000C is
pH O
DG0 = 3734 J/mol = RT ln 2
pH2 eq
pH O pH O
This gives, 2 = 0.70. Since this value is lower than 2 (i.e. 9.50 as
pH2 eq pH 2 actual
calculated in Example 4.1), reduction is not possible. A similar calculation gives
pCO2 pCO2
p = 0.466, which is lower than the p . Hence, reduction is not possible.
CO eq CO actual
4.3.1 Introduction
In the equations given earlier, activity is an abstract thermodynamic parameter, and is of no
practical significance. What is important is to know the compositions of various phasesmetal,
slag, gas, etc. which would co-exist at chemical equilibrium. This requires knowledge of activity
as a function of composition in various phases of importance in ironmaking and steelmaking at
high temperatures.
Roughly speaking, activity is a measure of free concentration. In ideal gases, molecules are
free, and hence activity of a species i (i.e. ai) = pi, as already noted in the earlier section.
Pyro-metallurgical processing is quite fast and gets completed in a reasonably short period
of time (of the order of hours/minutes). Solid reactants and reagents in these processes are
compounds (either pure or mixture). Solid products are also either almost pure metals or
compounds, since with solid-state diffusion being very slow, there is almost no opportunity
for solid solution formation. Hence, all participating solids are assumed to be pure and
by convention, are at their respective standard states, and hence, their activities are to be taken
as 1.
Therefore, the main concern is with activity-versus-composition relations in liquid slags and
liquid alloys. From a thermodynamic viewpoint, molten slags are solutions of oxides. Liquid
alloys are metallic solutions.
General Physicochemical Fundamentals 57
where, Wi and Mi are the weight percent and molecular mass respectively of component i.
Most real solutions do not obey Raoults law. They exhibit either positive or negative
deviations from it. For a binary solution, this is illustrated in Figure 4.2 (Ward 1963) for some
FeB liquid binary alloys at 1600C (i.e. 1873 K). In this figure, B is Cu, Mn or Si. The FeMn
solution obeys Raoults law, the FeCu exhibits strong positive deviation and the FeSi strong
negative deviation from Raoults law. In binary liquid oxides, FeOMnO behaves ideally,
whereas most binary silicates (i.e. CaOSiO2, FeOSiO2, MgOSiO2, MnOSiO2, etc.) exhibit
strong negative deviations from Raoults law.
1.0
0.8
aCu
0.6
aB
aMn
0.4
aSi
0.2
0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
Fe Xa B
Figure 4.2 Raoultian activities of copper, manganese and silicon in solution in molten iron at
1600C.
58 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Departures from Raoults law are quantified using a thermodynamic parameter, known as
the activity coefficient, which is defined as
a
gi = i (4.27)
Xi
where, gi is the activity coefficient of component i in a solution.
Over the past several decades, various attempts have been made to propose analytical
correlations between activity and composition for non-ideal solutions. None of them, however,
can be taken as valid for all types of solutions, since they invariably contain some simplifying
assumptions. The simplest of all of these solution models is the regular solution model. For a
binary solution with components A and B, it predicts
RT ln gA = a XB2; RT ln g B = a XA2 (4.28)
where, a is a constant at constant temperature. It may be noted further that a varies inversely
with T, and that XA + XB = 1.
SiO2
aSiO2
SiO2
0.90
0.70
0.80 2SiO2.6AlO1-5
0.70
(SiC)
0.60
0.50
O
X SiO
Ca
X
0.40
2
0.30
0.20
0.10 AlO1-5
2CaO.SiO2
0.025 0.05
0.01 CaO.12AlO1-5
2CaO.2AlO1-5 SiO2
0.003
3 CaO.4AlO1-5
3CaO.SiO2 10
CaO 10
4 CaO.2AlO1-5
CaO AlO1-5
AlO1-5
Figure 4.3 Iso-activity lines of SiO2 in CaOSiO2Al2O3 ternary at 1823 K; the liquid at various
locations on the liquidus is saturated with compounds as shown.
Solutes in dilute binary solutions obey Henrys law, which is stated as follows:
ai = g i0 Xi (4.29)
0
where, g i is a constant, known as the Henrys law constant. Deviation from Henrys law occurs
when the solute concentration increases.
Therefore, activities of dissolved elements in liquid steel are expressed with reference to
Henrys law, and not Raoults law. Since it is the intention to find values directly in weight
percent, the composition scale is weight percent. With these modifications, i is in solution with
Fe as solvent in the binary Fei solution. If:
60 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
1. Henrys law is obeyed by the solute in the binary Fei solution, then
hi = Wi (4.30)
2. Henrys law is not obeyed by the solute i, then
hi = fiWi (4.31)
where, hi is activity, Wi is weight percent and fi is activity coefficient in the so-called one weight
percent standard state. This is because, at 1 wt. %, hi = l, if Henrys law is obeyed.
Again, it can be shown that fi is related to Raoultian activity coefficient g as
g
fi = 0i (4.32)
gi
Let us consider the case of oxidation of Si to SiO2 (i.e. Eq. (4.19)). There, the standard state of
Si was taken as pure silicon (solid below 1710C). The equilibrium relation at temperature T
would be:
( aSiO2 )
DG 0f (19) = RT ln K19 = - RT ln (4.33)
[ aSi ] pO2 eq
where (aSiO2) denotes activity of SiO2 in oxide solution, and [aSi] activity of Si in metallic phase
(say, in liquid iron).
Now, if the activity of Si in liquid iron has to be expressed in 1 weight % standard state,
then Eq. (4.19) would be modified as
[Si]1 wt. % std. state + O2(g) = SiO2 (4.34)
with the equilibrium relation as
(aSiO )
DG0f (34) = RT ln K34 = - RT ln 2
(4.35)
[ hSi ] pO2 eq
DG0f (34) is not the same as DG 0f (19). They are related in the following way:
m
DG0f (34) = DG0f (19) [GSi ] at 1 wt. % std. state of Si in iron (4.36)
Therefore, for equilibrium calculations involving solution in liquid iron in 1 wt. % standard state,
the values of partial molar free energies of mixing (Gim ) of solutes in liquid iron are required
as well. Some of these are tabulated in Table 4.2 (Engh 1992).
Table 4.2 Free energy of mixing of some elements at 1 wt. % standard state in liquid iron (Gim )
as function of temperature ( Gim = C + DT )
where, the values of e are constants. ei j is called interaction coefficient describing the influence
of solute j on the activity coefficient of solute i. It is defined as
d (log fi )
ei j = (4.38)
d W j W 0
j
It can be derived further that
d (log f j ) Mj Mi - M j
eji = = eij + 0.434 10 -2 (4.39)
d Wi Wi 0 Mi Mi
where, M is the molecular mass. Equation (4.39) allows the estimation of eji from e ij. Table 4.3
presents some values of interaction coefficients in liquid iron at 1600C (1873 K) (Sigworth
et al. 1974; Steelmaking Data Sourcebook 1988).
62 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Table 4.3 Interaction coefficients (ei j ) of some common elements in liquid iron at or near 1600C
(1873 K)
j
i Al B C Cr Mn Mo N Si
Al 0.043 . 0.091 . . . 0.015 0.056
C 0.043 0.24 0.243 0.023 0.012 0.008 0.11 0.08
Cr . . 0.114 0.0003 0.004 0.002 0.182 0.004
H 0.013 0.058 0.06 0.0024 0.002 0.003 . 0.027
Mn . 0.024 0.054 0.004 0 0.005 0.091 0.033
Mo . . 0.14 0 0.005 0.0121 0 0.048
N 0.1 0.094 0.130 0.046 0.020 0.011 0 0.048
Ni . . 0.032 0 0.008 . 0.015 0
O 1.17 0.31 0.421 0.055 0.021 0.005 0.14 0.066
P 0.037 0.015 0.13 0.018 0.032 0.001 0.13 0.099
S 0.041 0.134 0.111 0.010 0.026 0.003 0.01 0.075
Si 0.058 0.20 0.18 0.0003 0.015 2.36 0.092 0.103
Ti . . . 0.055 0.043 . 2.06 2.1
V . . 0.14 0.012 0.006 . 0.4 0.042
All the preceding discussions and equations along with the required thermodynamic data
constitute the basis for equilibrium calculations. Their applications will be illustrated in the later
chapters and through the worked-out examples.
EXAMPLE 4.3
Determine the activity of SiO2 in the CaOSiO2AlO1.5 system at 1823 K at XCaO = 0.5, and
XSiO2 = 0.4. Consider the equilibrium of this slag with an FeSi liquid alloy and a gas mixture
of CO + CO2 at this temperature. Calculate the (pCO2/pCO) ratio in gas at equilibrium.
Given: In the alloy, XSi = 0.02; gSi = 1.6 103.
EXAMPLE 4.4
(i) What is the value of hSi (i.e. activity of Si in 1 wt. % standard state) at the alloy
composition in Example 4.3?
m
(ii) Calculate GSi at 1 wt. % std. state for Si in liquid iron.
0
Given: Henrys Law constant for Si in liquid iron (i.e. g Si ) = 1.3 103
Solution: On the basis of Eq. (4.26), and noting that atomic masses of Si and Fe are 28 and
56 respectively, wt. % Si (WSi) at the above alloy composition = 1.01%
g Si 1.6 10 -3
hSi = fSi WSi; From Eq. (4.32), fSi = 0
= = 1.23
g Si 1.3 10 -3
Hence, hSi = 1.01 1.23 = 1.24
m 0
(ii) On the basis of Eq. (4.3), GSi = RT ln [g Si ( XSi )1wt. % ]
On the basis of Eq. (4.26), XSi = 0.0198 at 1 wt. % Si. Calculations yield
m
GSi = 160.1 kJ/mol Si
EXAMPLE 4.5
An FeMn solid solution having 0.001 mole fraction of Mn, is at equilibrium with an FeOMnO
solid solution and an oxygen containing atmosphere at 1000 K. Calculate the composition of the
oxide solution. Both metallic and oxide solutions are ideal.
1
Given: Mn(s) + O2(g) = MnO(s); DGf0 = 384700 + 72.8 T J/mol
2
Solution: [Fe] + (MnO) = [Mn] + (FeO); DG50 = DG0f (FeO) - DG 0f (MnO) (Ex.4.5)
From data on DGf0for formation of FeO in Table 4.1, and that for MnO given above, at
1000 K, DG50 = 114850 J/mol, giving K5 = 106.
Noting that aFeO = XFeO, aMnO = XMnO, XFeO + XMnO = 1, calculations yield XFeO = 103, and
XMnO = 0.999.
EXAMPLE 4.6
Calculate the chemical potential of nitrogen gas at equilibrium with liquid steel at 1600C. The
steel contains 0.01% N, 0.5% C, 0.5% Mn.
581
Given: [N]ppm std state in iron = KN p1/2
N 2 , where log KN = - + 2.937
T
(Note: 1 wt. % = 104 ppm)
Solution: At equilibrium, mN2(gas) = mN2(steel) = RT ln pN2
log pN2 = 2 [log hN log KN], where hN is in ppm.
64 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
0.008
1400C
1 1
Viscosity, kg . m . s
0.007
1500C
1450C
1550C
1600C
0.006
0.005
The surface tension of liquid iron (sFe) varies with temperature in the following way:
sFe = 2367 0.34T (4.42)
where T is in C, unit of s is dynes cm1, i.e. N m1 103. This gives a value of 1823 at
1600C. Solutes generally lower s. Most solutes do not have much effect on surface tension of
liquid iron, except sulphur, oxygen, tellurium and selenium. In other words, these elements are
surface active. For example, at 15501600C, the presence of 0.2% S or 0.1% oxygen in iron
lowers the surface tension to about 1100.
66 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
To CaO
2200 2572 10
2130 20
2065 20 Ca2SiO4 + L 3800
1800 2 liquids
Ca3SiO 5
1000
CaO + bbCa2SiO4 *b CaSiO 3 + Tridymite
1400
800
*g Ca2SiO4 + Ca3SiO7
Ca4SiO 3
675 1000
*b CaSiO3 + Quartz
600
CaO + *g Ca2SiO4
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100
w/o SiO2
Oxygen
Silicon
[CaO]
Before CaO
addition
Calcium
++
Figure 4.6 Illustration of network breaking following the addition of CaO to SiO2.
In solid pure SiO2 these tetrahedra are linked together by a three-dimensional crystalline
network.
Upon melting of pure SiO2, short-range order remains, but long-range order is destroyed.
Oxides are ionic in both solid and liquid states.
68 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Molten slags are polymeric ionic melts. The cations (Ca2+, Na+, Mg2+, Mn2+, Fe2+, etc.)
are free and mobile, whereas anions (SiO44, AlO45, PO43, etc.) are complex and less
mobile.
Therefore, basic oxides (CaO, etc.) are also called network breakers. They break the
SiO2 network, as illustrated in Figure 4.6. Based on this classification, the acidic oxides
(SiO2, etc.) are network formers.
Al2O3, Fe2O3, Cr2O3 behave as basic oxides at high concentrations and acidic oxides at
low concentrations. Hence, they are amphoteric oxides in nature.
With the addition of more and more metal oxide (MO) to SiO2, there is progressive
breakdown of the silica network. Hence, the complex anions become smaller and smaller in size
(Table 4.4).
Table 4.4 Dominant discrete silicate ions at some compositions
Pure silica
500 Li
Na
K
400 Mg
Eh, kJ/mol
Ca
Sr
300 Ba
200
100
20 40 60 80
Mole percent metal oxide
Figure 4.7 Variation of activation energy for viscous flow with increasing metal oxide content in
liquid binary silicates.
The above conclusions can be extended to more complex slag melts. The only difference
would be that (AlO4)5, (PO4)3, (FeO4)5 anions would also be present in addition to (SiO4)4
above 66.7 mole % MO.
As stated in Section 4.4.1, the density and the viscosity of liquid steel do not vary much with
composition and temperature. The overall variation in density of molten ironmaking and
steelmaking slags is also not very appreciable (approximately 2.52.8 gcm3). However, this is
not the case with viscosity, which varies by orders of magnitude, depending on composition and
temperature of the slag melt. This is illustrated in Figure 4.8 by the iso-viscosity lines for CaO
SiO2 Al2O3 slags at 1500C (Machin and Lee, 1948), where the overall variation is from 2.5
to 2000 poise (i.e. 0.25 to 200 kg m1 s1).
The surface tension of liquid oxides and slags varies in the range of 200 600 m N m1.
For slagmetal reactions, the slagmetal interfacial tension is a more relevant parameter than the
surface tension and hence, many measurements have been made (not discussed further).
SiO3
0 90
10 80
20 70
.%
2000
SiO
wt
1000
30 800 60
O,
2
,w
Ca
400
t. %
200
40 100 50
80
50
50 40 40
30
60 5 15 30
CaO 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 Al2O3
Al2O3, wt. %
Figure 4.8 Iso-viscosity lines for CaOSiO2Al2O3 slag at 1500C; values in poise
(i.e. 0.1 kg m1 s1).
The modified V-ratios incorporating other basic and acidic oxides are also in use, depending on
actual practice. Another index that is often referred to is known as excess base (B), where
B = MO 2SiO2 4P2O5 2Al2O3 Fe2O3 (4.47)
It assumes the formation of compounds like 2MO SiO2, 4MO P2O5, etc. Free concentration of
MO, which is assumed to participate in reactions, is therefore, obtained by deducting those
tied-up as compounds.
In terms of weight percent,
B = wt. % CaO 1.86 wt. % SiO2 1.19 wt. % P2O5 (4.48)
Since a basic oxide tends to dissociate into cation and oxygen ions, the concentration of free O2
increases with increasing basicity (Eq. (4.44)). Therefore, from a thermodynamic point of view,
the activity of oxygen ions (a O2) may be taken as an appropriate measure of the basicity of slag.
However, there is no method available for experimental determination of a2 O.
A breakthrough came with the development of the concept of optical basicity (L) in the field
of glass chemistry by Duffy and Ingram in 197576, which was subsequently applied to
metallurgical slags. Experimental measurements of L in transparent media such as glass and
aqueous solutions were carried out by employing Pb2+ as the probe ion. In an oxide medium,
electron donation by oxygen brings about a reduction in the 6s 6p energy gap, and this, in turn,
produces a shift in the frequency (n) in the UV spectral band.
n free - n sample
L= (4.49)
n free - n CaO
General Physicochemical Fundamentals 71
where nfree, nCaO and nsample are frequencies at peak for free Pb2+, Pb2+ in CaO, and Pb2+ in
sample respectively. Therefore, L = 1 for pure CaO by definition. Hence, L is an expression for
lime character, even though there may not be any CaO in the sample.
Slags are opaque. Hence, L is estimated for slags and there are controversies regarding the
values for some oxides as well as correlations with reaction such as desulphurisation. In view
of this problem, the concept of optical basicity has not been universally accepted in industrial
applications.
Along with basicity, another concept that is important is that of slag capacity. This has
evolved over a period of time, and has become quite widely used. Richardson and Fincham in
1954 first defined sulphide capacity (CS) as the potential capacity of a slag melt to hold sulphur
as sulphide. Mathematically,
CS = (wt. % S2 in slag) ( pO2/pS2)1/2 (4.50)
where pO2/pS2 are partial pressures of O2 and S2 in the gas at equilibrium with the slag. Noting
that the reaction is:
1 1
S2(g) + (O2) = O2(g) + (S2) (4.51)
2 2
it can be shown that
K 51 aO2 -
CS = (4.52)
fS2 -
where K51 is the equilibrium constant for the reaction in Eq. (4.51) and fS2 is the activity
coefficient of S2 in the slag in an appropriate scale.
CS is a function of slag composition and temperature only. Therefore, its values can be
tabulated or presented graphically for use by all. This is an important advantage. Subsequently,
several other capacity terms have been proposed and reported in literature. For example, if the
slagmetal phosphorus reaction is written as
1 5 3
P2 (g) + O 2 (g) + (O2 - )slag = (PO34- )slag (4.53)
2 4 2
then the phosphate capacity of a slag may be defined as
(wt. % PO 34- )
CP = (4.54)
( pP2 )1/2 ( pO2 )5/ 4
EXAMPLE 4.7
A slag of CaO, SiO2 and Al2O3, having mole fraction of alumina as 0.1, has Si2O76, AlO45
anions. Calculate the slag composition.
Solution: Take 1 gmol of slag. Therefore, the mole fraction X is same as the number of
moles n. Hence,
nCaO + nSiO2 + nAl2O3 = 1 (Ex. 4.6)
From oxygen balance,
nO = nCaO + 2nSiO2 + 3nAl2O3 (Ex. 4.7)
Again, since anions are Si2O76, AlO45,
7
nO = nSiO2 + 8 nAl2 O3 (Ex. 4.8)
2
Noting that nAl2O3 = 0.1, and solving the above equations, the mole fractions of CaO, SiO2 are
0.74 and 0.16 respectively.
EXAMPLE 4.8
Calculate the activation energy for viscosity for a liquid slag, whose viscosities are 10 and
2 kgm1s1 at 1500 and 1600C respectively.
Eh
Solution: From Eq. (4.43), ln h = ln h0 + (Ex. 4.9)
RT
Substituting the values for the given temperatures in the above equation, and combining them,
gives
2 Eh 1 1
ln h (at 1873 K) ln h (at 1773 K) = ln = ln 0.2 = -
10 R 1873 1773
Calculations give, Eh = 4.45 105 J/mol = 445 kJ/mol
General Physicochemical Fundamentals 73
EXAMPLE 4.9
(a) A liquid slag has 50 wt. % CaO, 10 wt. % MgO, 25 wt. % SiO2, and 15 wt. % Al2O3.
Calculate its sulphide capacity at 1900 K with the help of the following equation:
9894
log CS = 3.44 ( X CaO + 0.1 X MgO - 0.8 X Al2O3 - XSiO2 ) - + 2.05 (Ex. 4.10)
T
(b) Consider equilibrium of the above slag with a gas mixture consisting of 75% H2,
15% H2O, and 10% H2S (of course volume % as per convention for gases), at
1900 K and 1 atmosphere total pressure. Calculate wt. % S in slag at equilibrium.
Solution: (a) Conversion of wt. % into mole fraction with the help of Eq. (4.26), and noting
the atomic masses of Ca, Mg, Si, Al and O as 40, 24, 28, 27 and 16 respectively, gives
XCaO = 0.523, XMgO = 0.146, XSiO2 = 0.244 , XAl2O3 = 0.087
Substituting the values of these in Eq. (Ex. 4.10), at 1900 K, log CS = 2.384, i.e.
CS = 4.1 103.
1/2
pO
2
(b) From Eq. (4.50), CS = (wt. % S in slag) 2
pS2
1
From Example 4.1, H2(g) + O2(g) = H2O(g)
2
From data in Table 4.1, DGf0 at 1900 K of the above reaction is 141,050 J/mol.
pH O 1
DGf0 = RT ln K = RT ln 2
pH 2 1/2
( pO 2 )
eq
Substituting values, and solving,
pO2 = 7.0 1010 atmosphere
1
For the reaction: H2(g) + S2(g) = H2S(g)
2
DG0f = 246,000 + 54.8 T J/mol
pH S 1
DGf0 = RT ln K = RT ln 2
pH 2 1/2
( pS2 )
eq
Substituting values and solving,
pS2 = 2.81 1010 atmosphere and wt. % S in slag = 1.65 103
are some other reactions and processes which do not attain equilibrium. The subject of Kinetics
is to be taken help of both for process improvement as well as for a better understanding. This
aspect is covered in brief in the subsequent paragraphs.
Reactions in ironmaking and steelmaking are heterogeneous in nature, i.e. they involve more
than one phase, like slag and metal, gas and solid, etc. The chemical reactions between such
phases occur at the phase boundaries (i.e. at interfaces). The rate of reactions, therefore, would
be proportional to the interfacial areas. At the same time, for these heterogeneous reactions to
proceed, it is necessary to transport the reactants to the interface and the products of reaction
away from the interface. This is achieved by the process of mass transfer. Mass transfer may
be further subdivided into the following categories:
1. Mass transfer in the bulk phase away from the interface. This step is sufficiently rapid
only in fluids, and that too, when the flow is turbulent in nature. The terminology mixing
is commonly used in this connection.
2. Mass transfer at or near the interface, which depends on the concentration at the
interface, temperature, total area available, etc.
As a result, all heterogeneous reactions take place through a series of kinetic steps, which may
be classified into:
Interfacial chemical reaction
Mixing in the bulk fluid
Mass transfer at/near the interface.
As already stated in Section 4.3.1, solids may be assumed to be pure in pyro-metallurgical
processes since solid-state diffusion is extremely slow and can be neglected. However, a large
variety of porous solids (e.g. iron ore, sinter, coke, lime, etc.) involved in these processes react
fast owing to easy diffusion of gases through these materials, and in some cases, even liquids
flowing through their pores.
Often new phases form as a result of these reactions, for example, the formation of carbon
monoxide bubbles during decarburisation and deoxidation products following the addition of
deoxidants. Theoretically, the formation of such products requires nucleation and growth.
However, it has been established that nucleation is not required in industrial processing and only
growth is involved.
4.5.3 Diffusion
Diffusion (i.e. molecular diffusion) is governed by the Ficks first law of diffusion as follows:
dni
dC
Molar flux = dt = - Di i (4.59)
A dx
dmi
d C*
Mass flux = dt = - Di i (4.60)
A dx
for diffusion of species i along the x-direction. Ci is the concentration of i in moles/volume, Ci*
is the concentration of i in mass/volume and Di is the diffusion coefficient (i.e. diffusivity) of i
having the unit of cm2 s1 or m2 s-1. Values of D (in m2 s1) at ironmaking and steelmaking
temperatures are of the order of 102 to 103 for gases, 5 108 to 5 109 for liquid steel, and
5 1010 to 5 1011 for liquid slags.
As stated in Section 4.5.1, ironmaking and steelmaking are concerned with molecular
diffusion only inside the pores of a porous solid. Extensive studies have been carried out on this
subject, both in chemical and metallurgical engineering. It is agreed that diffusion of gases or
liquids through pores can be mathematically treated by the usual diffusion equations. Only
special consideration is required for estimation of the value of D. For this purpose the equation:
e
Di (in pores) = Di (in bulk gas/liquid) (4.61)
t
can be used, where e is volume fraction of pores in the solid and t is the tortuosity factor. The
value of the tortuosity factor may be taken to be approximately 2, for estimation purposes (this
is a source of uncertainty). Although the above equation can be employed for diffusion of liquids
76 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
through a porous solid, further uncertainty is involved when it comes to the wettability of the
liquid. If the liquid does not wet the solid, it cannot penetrate into the pores properly, and the
role of wettability is thus obvious.
(CiS - Ci0 )
= Di = km, i (CiS - Ci0 ) (4.64)
d C , eff.
where, dC, eff is the effective concentration boundary layer thickness
General Physicochemical Fundamentals 77
CiS
(Fluid)
(Solid)
Ci
Concentration profile
C 0i
dC, eff
x = 0 x
Figure 4.9 Concentration boundary layer in fluid adjacent to a solid surface during mass transfer.
Di
and km, i = mass transfer coefficient for i =
d C , eff
The more intense the stirring (agitation), the lower is dC, eff, and the higher is km, i. Therefore,
mass transfer increases with increasing fluid convection and agitation. Experimental data have
been correlated through dimensionless numbers using empirical equations of the type
Sh = B Rem Scn for forced convection (4.65)
and Sh = B GrmmScn for free convection (4.66)
where Sh, Re, Sc, Gr stand for the Sherwood, Reynolds, Schmidt and Grassoff numbers
respectively.
km , i L
Sh =
Di
where L is a characteristic dimension of the system.
layer would behave like a rigid solid. In this situation, Higbies theory may be applied to mass
transfer on the slag side (not the metal side) of the interface. For a gasliquid interface under
laminar flow, it is applicable to the liquid phase.
Higbies theory predicts that
1/2
D
k m, i = 2 i (4.67)
p te
where, te is the time of exposure of a fluid element at the interface.
Danckwerts surface renewal theory is applicable when the flow is turbulent at the interface.
It predicts
km,i = (DiS)1/2 (4.68)
where S is known as the surface renewal factor, and varies from 20 per second for very mild
turbulence, to about 300 per second under strongly turbulent conditions. Sometimes, te can be
estimated theoretically, but in most cases S has to be determined experimentally or by making
an educated guess.
EXAMPLE 4.10
A bubble of nitrogen gas of diameter, d = 0.5 mm, at a pressure of 1.5 atm, is rising through
a stagnant melt of steel of composition and temperature as in Example 4.6. Assuming mass
transfer in the melt to be rate controlling, and Higbies theory to be applicable, calculate the rate
of transfer of nitrogen from gas to melt.
Solution: Rate of N transfer = rN = Akm, i (CiS Ci0), where i stands for atomic N.
A = bubble surface area = pd 2 = 78.5 106 m2
km,N is given by Higbies Eq. (4.67); Diffusivity of N in liquid steel at 1600C = 3.8 109 m2/s.
Exposure time, te = d/vt, where vt is the rising velocity of the bubble (according to Stokes law,
Eq. (20.9)).
General Physicochemical Fundamentals 79
Noting that, g = 9.81 m/s2, rl = 6.73 103 kg/m3, rg @ 0, and hl = 5 103 N m2 s1,
vt = 18.34 m/s, thus giving te = 2.73 10 4 s, and km,N = 3.28 107 m/s.
Assume the bulk concentration of N (CN0) = 0; the surface concentration (CNS) is at
equilibrium with the N2 gas. With reference to Example 4.6, wt. % N at equilibrium may be
calculated as follows:
[hN]ppm = KN pN1/2
2
; at nitrogen pressure of 1.5 atmosphere, therefore, [hN]ppm = 560.3.
Again, log [hN]ppm = 4 + log WN + log fN.
On the basis of data in Example 4.6, WN = 0.0494 wt. %.
CNS = mass of N per m3 of melt = wt. fraction N in melt density of liquid iron
= 0.0494 102 6.73 103 = 3.325 kgN/m3.
Therefore, the rate of N transfer = 3.28 107 3.325 = 1.09 106 kg/s.
EXAMPLE 4.11
Consider the following slagmetal reaction at 1600C.
[Si] + 2(MnO) = (SiO2) + 2[Mn] (Ex. 4.11)
Compare the maximum rates of transfer of Si and Mn in liquid iron at the slagmetal interface.
Assume validity of Danckwerts surface renewal theory (Eq. (4.68)).
Given: DSi (in liquid iron) = 2.5 109 m2/s; DMn (in liquid iron) = 4.0 109 m2/s at 1600C.
The composition relation in iron, at equilibrium with the slag, is: [WSi]/[WMn]2 = 0.23.
Liquid iron contains 0.3 mole % Si and 0.5 mole % Mn.
Solution: Rate of transfer of Si = Akm, Si [CSi0 CSiS ];
Rate of transfer of Mn = Akm,Mn [C SMn C Mn
0
]
1/2
Ak m, Si ( DSi S)1/2 D
= = Si = 0.79
Akm,Mn ( DMn S)1/2 DMn
At maximum rate for Si, the concentration of Mn in liquid iron is uniform at 0.5 mole %. Si
concentration at the slagmetal interface is given by the chemical equilibrium relation as:
0.23 [mole% Mn]2 = 0.23 0.52 = 0.0575
Since C is proportional to mole %, the maximum rate of Si transfer = km, Si [0.3 0.0575] B,
where B is the constant of proportionality.
In a similar way, the maximum rate of transfer of Mn = km,Mn [(0.3/0.23)1/2 0.5] B.
From the above, the ratio of the rates of Si and Mn transfer = 0.298.
REFERENCES
Barfield R.N. and J.A. Kitchener, JISI (1955), Vol. 180, p. 324.
Engh, T.A., Principles of Metal Refining, Oxford University Press, UK (1992).
Machin, J.S. and T.B. Lee, J. American Ceramic Soc. (1948), Vol. 31, p. 200.
80 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Chapter 2 presented chemical reactions in various zones of a blast furnace along with the
approximate temperature levels (Figure 2.1). It also contained a brief description of the process
as well as the internal structure of various regions (Figures 2.1, 2.2 and 2.3). The following
regions were identified:
The upper region, i.e. Stack or Shaft
The middle portion of the furnace, i.e. Belly and Bosh
The lower region, i.e. Hearth.
The lower region again can be subdivided into various zonesCohesive zone, Deadman zone
and Combustion zone (or Tuyere zone/Raceway).
Reactions take place in all these regions, and their control has a major influence on the
quality of hot metal produced. An understanding of the reactions is therefore important.
p2 X2
Therefore, ln K5 = ln CO = ln CO PT
pCO2 eq. X CO2 eq.
DG50 20532
= - =- + 20.98 (5.7)
RT T
where PT = pCO + pCO2 1 atmosphere, and XCO, XCO2 are mole fractions of CO and CO2
respectively. For ideal gases, X is the same as its volume fraction (refer Chapter 4).
2
XCO
Since, XCO + XCO2 = 1, K5 = (5.8)
1 - XCO
On the basis of Eqs. (5.7) and (5.8), volume fractions (or volume percent) of CO and CO2
for CCOCO2 equilibrium at any temperature can be calculated. Figure 5.1 presents such
calculated volume fraction of CO in COCO2 mixture as a function of temperature. In the above
equations, T is in kelvin but for convenience of users the unit of temperature in
Figure 5.1 is given in C. Reaction (5.5) is the famous Boudouard Reaction. In blast furnace
ironmaking the forward reaction is known as the Solution Loss Reaction. In general, it is referred
to as the Gasification Reaction.
1.0
PT = 1 atm (Liquid
Fe)
PT = 5 atm
3Fe + 2CO Fe3C(s) + CO2 Fe
2Fe + 2CO Fe3C(s) + CO2
0.8 2Fe + 2CO Fe2C(s) + CO2
A
3Fe + 2CO Fe3C(s) + CO2
2CO C(gr) + CO2 FexO + CO xFe + CO2
pCO/(pCO + pCO2)
0.2
(Magnetite)
3Fe2O3 + CO 2Fe3O4 + CO2
0
200 400 600 800 1000 1200 1400 1600
Temperature, C
Figure 5.1 Equilibrium pCO/(pCO + pCO2) ratios in gas as a function of temperature for reactions in
the FeCO system. The lines are for equilibria of reactions as indicated.
86 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Figure 4.1 shows that CO becomes more and more stable compared with CO2 as the
temperature is increased. This is also demonstrated in Figure 5.1. Therefore, at the tuyeres where
the temperatures are the highest, CO is the only stable oxide of carbon and this gas passes
through a bed of coke. By neglecting the effects of hydrocarbons or any other tuyere injectants,
the composition of the gas as it enters the bottom of the stack can be calculated assuming that
air contains 21% O2, 79% N2 and that the entire amount of O2 gets converted into CO. For
100 moles of air, therefore, the number of moles of N2 and CO would be 79 and 42 respectively.
Hence,
42
Volume % CO = 100 = 34.7
79 + 42
Volume % N2 = 100 34.7 = 65.3
Atom % oxygen
50 52 54 56 58 60
Magnetite
d -iron + Y Z
liquid oxide I H S
1400 G
N J
g-iron +
Haematite + oxygen
liquid oxide
1200
g -iron + wstite
Temperature, C
wstite
800
a-iron +
wstite
600
Q a-iron + magnetite
Fe3O4 Fe2O3
FeO Z
400
0 0.422 24 26 28 30
Wt.% oxygen
It may be noted that in Eqs. (5.10) and (5.11), FexO has been approximated to FeO in order
to use concrete values of DH 0 and DG0. Figure 5.1 presents the curves for equilibria of reactions
(5.9) to (5.11), in which the volume percent CO in CO + CO2 gas mixtures has been plotted as
a function of temperature. The stable phases are also indicated in various phase fields. The
reduction of haematite to magnetite occurs at such low levels of CO that a different gas
composition scale is required to show the equilibrium line of reaction (5.9) properly.
The reduction of iron oxides by CO and H2 is traditionally known as Indirect Reduction in
blast furnace ironmaking. This is meant to distinguish it from the reduction by solid carbon,
which is called Direct Reduction. However, as already stated in the beginning of this section,
gassolid reactions are much faster than reactions between two solids. The solid burden
materialsiron ore, sinter, coke, limestone, etc.are all porous and gas molecules can penetrate
into these pores by diffusion. Reaction with the solid is then not confined to the external surface
alone, but to an appreciable extent it proceeds on the internal pore surfaces as well. On the other
hand, adjacent ore and coke particles have direct contacts only at a few point locations.
Therefore, from a kinetic point of view, reduction by gases is much faster.
It has been established that the reaction:
FeO(s) + C(s) = Fe(s) + CO(g) (5.12)
0 3 1
DH12 = +140.1 10 J mol
0
DG12 = 140,100 25.1T J mol1
occurs through coupling of the reaction (5.11), i.e. reduction of FeO by CO, with reaction (5.5),
which generates CO through the CCO2 reaction. From a thermodynamic point of view,
therefore, direct reduction of FeO is possible if the gas composition lies in region (A) of
Figure 5.1. In this zone, the gas reduces the oxide to FeO, and carbon tends to form CO.
EXAMPLE 5.1
Figure 5.1 shows that metallic iron is at equilibrium with Fe3O4 below 560C and with FeO
above 560C. Justify this through thermodynamic considerations.
Solution: Since gas phase is also involved, according to phase rule, F = C P + 2, where F
is degrees of freedom, C is the number of components, P is the number of phases.
At 560C, P = 4 (i.e. Fe, FeO, Fe3O4, gas), C = 2 (i.e. Fe and O), since the role of CO and CO2
mixture is essentially to control oxygen potential in gas. Hence, F = 0 at 560C (i.e. it is an
invariant point).
Consider the reaction: Fe(s) + Fe3O4(s) = 4FeO(s); DG0 (Ex.5.1)
From data in Table 4.1, or from Eqs. (5.10) and (5.11), it is obtained that
DG 0 = 4DG 0f (FeO) DG0f (Fe3O4) = 52,325 62.58T Jmol1 (Ex.5.2)
Since, in reaction (Ex. 5.1), the reactants and the product are pure solids, the feasibility criterion
for the reaction is DG 0 itself and not DG. See Chapter 4 for further clarification.
Let the temperature at which reaction (Ex. 5.1) is at equilibrium be T0. Then, at T0, DG0 = 0.
This gives T0 = 836 K = 563C, which is slightly different from that in Figure 5.1, due to
different thermodynamic data sources.
Physical Chemistry of Blast Furnace Reactions 89
0.6
yFe3O4
+ (4y 3)H2
= 3FeyO
Wstite
0.4 + (4y 3)H2O
Liq. oxide
Magnetite
0.2
EXAMPLE 5.2
A gas mixture containing 50% CO2 and 50% H2, is introduced into a furnace at 1000 K.
Assuming that it attained equilibrium at the furnace temperature quickly, predict whether it will
deposit carbon as solid. Assume total pressure (PT) = 1 atmosphere.
Solution: Consider equilibrium of the reaction
H2(g) + CO2(g) = H2O(g) + CO(g) (5.16)
From the data given, DG 0 for the above reaction at 1000 K = 1990 Jmol1
pH O pCO
So, 1990 = - R 1000 ln 2 (Ex.5.3)
pH2 pCO2 eq.
Assume that initially 1 gmol of H2 + CO2 mixture was introduced into the furnace. Let x moles
of each react, before equilibrium is reached. Then the number of gmol of H2, CO2, H2O and CO
are 0.5 x, 0.5 x, x and x respectively. Since partial pressures are proportional to number of
moles,
x2
1990 = R 1000 ln 2
(0.5 - x )
pCO2 X CO2 0.5 - x
Calculations give = = = 3.20
pCO X CO x
Noting that pCO2 + pCO = (0.5 x) + x = 0.5 atmosphere, the values of pCO2 and pCO are 0.381
and 0.119 atmosphere respectively.
Now, consider the reaction,
CO2(g) + C(s) = 2CO(g) (5.5)
From Eq. (5.7), at 1000 K, K for reaction (5.5) is 1.565.
2
pCO 0.1192
J= (actual) = = 0.037
pCO2 0.381
DG = RT ln (J/K) = 31,095 Jmol1. Since it is negative, reaction (5.5) shall proceed in the
forward direction. Therefore, carbon deposition shall not occur.
A B
0.8
Degree of reduction (F0 )
0.6
0.2
0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Time, min
Figure 5.4 F0 vs. t plots for reduction of Fe2O3 and Fe3O4 in H2 at 900C.
where kC, kH are rate constants, and K11 and K17 are equilibrium constants of reactions (5.11)
and (5.17) respectively.
Mechanism of reduction
If the reduction of FeO in any ore proceeds in the manner depicted in Figure 5.5, the kinetic
Porous layer of
metallic Fe CO (or H2)
Figure 5.5 Sketch of a partially reduced sphere of FeO showing layers and kinetic steps.
94 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Oxide Oxide
Figure 5.6 Sketches of sections of partially reduced iron ore pellets, showing three patterns;
(Fe2O3, Fe3O4 and FeO have not been shown separately).
Physical Chemistry of Blast Furnace Reactions 95
It is interesting to note that at a fixed temperature and gas composition, and for any type
of ore/sinter/pellet burden of a given size range, the reducibility values do not differ by more
than a small factor.
The overall kinetics of iron ore reduction is complex because of:
Dependence of the rate on the structure of the solid, especially its porosity and pore
structure
Changes in the structure of the solid during reduction on account of swelling/contraction,
recrystallisation and grain growth
Comparable rates of chemical reaction, pore diffusion and in many cases, boundary layer
mass transfer.
Several rate equations have been proposed, and mathematical modelling exercises have been
reported in the literature. The best results are obtained by a combination of (i) experimental rate
measurements, (ii) characterisation of the ore-pore size distribution, pore surface area,
mineralogical details, etc., and (iii) quantitative analysis/mathematical modelling.
In a blast furnace, as the solid burden moves downwards, it undergoes changes in the
surrounding environment (in terms of temperature, gas composition, overlying load, etc.). In
view of this as well as complex kinetics, in actual practice, integrated tests are preferred where
the blast furnace situation is simulated in the laboratory for small batches of ore/sinter/pellets.
On this basis, an attempt is made to assess the overall performance.
1
10
Coke
1
Rate, min
2
10
Electrode graphite
3
10
Pyrolytic graphite
4
10
1 0 1 2 3
10 10 10 10 10
S, m g
2 1
Figure 5.7 Rate of oxidation of carbon samples in CO2 at 1100C as a function of internal pore
surface area.
controlled by the rate of the gasification reaction. As in the case of the gasification reaction, it
is characterised by large activation energy and is catalysed/inhibited by the reagents which
influence the gasification reaction in a similar way.
When the molar rates of reactions (5.5) and (5.11) become equal, then, reaction (5.12) takes
place stochiometrically. This equality is expressed as
1
mass of ore fraction of oxygen in ore rO
16
1
= mass of coke fraction of carbon in coke rC (5.24)
12
The factors 16 and 12 denote the atomic masses of oxygen and carbon respectively.
The calculated rates of generation of CO by gasification and consumption of CO by the
reduction reaction as a function of temperature for a sample of 1500 kg ore and 500 kg coke
are plotted in Figure 5.8 (Turkdogan 1978). At lower temperature, the gasification rate is much
lower than the reduction rate, but with the increasing temperature, they tend to equalise. This
happens because the rate of the gasification reaction increases rapidly with the increase in
temperature because of large activation energy. That is why direct reduction in a blast furnace
takes place only in the bosh and lower stack regions.
4000
CO consumption in reduction
2000 of 1500 kg of ore
Calculated rate of consumption and
1000
generation of CO, mole CO/min
800
600
400
200
CO generation by
100 non-catalytic oxidation
80 of 500 kg coke
60
40
20
10
900 950 1000 1050 1100
Temperature, C
Figure 5.8 Rates of reduction of lump haematite ore (1500 kg, 1 cm dia.) and non-catalytic internal
oxidation of coke (500 kg) at simulated blast furnace gas composition and pressure.
When the carbon burns at the tuyeres and generates CO, the gas reduces iron oxide by
indirect reduction, and only one oxygen atom of the oxide is removed by one atom of carbon.
On the other hand, if the oxide is also reduced directly by carbon in the lower part of the furnace,
the resulting CO again reduces the oxide. Thus, one carbon atom removes two atoms of oxygen
from the ore. Therefore, direct reduction improves the chemical utilisation of carbon. However,
since direct reduction is strongly endothermic, it lowers the thermal efficiency. Hence, it is
normally desirable that there should be a balance between direct and indirect reductionabout
66% indirect and the remainder direct reduction is considered to be the optimum.
To achieve this objective, the following are required:
The reducibility of the iron oxide used should be as high as possible.
The reactivity of coke should have an optimum value (opinions vary on what is the
optimum).
EXAMPLE 5.3
Calculate the rate of oxygen removal due to reduction of FeO in iron ore by CO, and the rate
of gasification of carbon in coke by CO2, for a situation prevailing at the lower stack/upper bosh
of a blast furnace. Assume the temperature as 1100C, pressure of CO + CO2 as 0.7 atmosphere,
of which 90% is CO and 10% CO2. Calculate for 1500 kg of original ore before reduction, and
500 kg of coke. Make other assumptions as required.
Solution: On the basis of Eq. (5.24), the rate of removal of oxygen from ore ( dNO /dt) = mass
of ore fraction of oxygen in ore rO (1/16), in kgmol/s, where NO is kgmol of O.
After reduction of Fe2O3 to FeO, 1/3rd of oxygen has been already removed. Considering
this and that the ore contains some gangue, assume that the fraction of oxygen remaining with
the ore is 0.2. Hence,
dN 1
- O = 1500 0.2 rO = 18.75 rO kgmol of O/s (Ex. 5.4)
dt 16
Proceeding similarly, the rate of removal of carbon from coke, assuming coke to have 80% C,
dN C 1
- = 500 0.8 0.9 rC = 30 rC kgmol of C/s (Ex. 5.5)
dt 12
This assumes that the original coke had 80% fixed carbon, and 10% of that has been gasified
already before reaching the lower stack/upper bosh.
Now, the values of rO and rC have to be estimated. Such estimates will be done on the basis
of data in this chapter and some more assumptions, which are based on literatures in this area
and are approximate only. Hence, the calculations are for illustration only and are not necessarily
representative of a real blast furnace.
Estimation of rO
From Eq. (5.20), rO = (dFO /dt). Figure 5.4 presents FO vs. t curves for reduction by H2 at
900C for two ores. Let us take ore A. The curve is approximately linear in the middle ranges.
The values of FO after 10 and 20 minutes from the start of reduction are 0.24 and 0.6
respectively. This gives
Physical Chemistry of Blast Furnace Reactions 99
0.6 - 0.24 1
rO = = 6 104 s1
20 - 10 60
On an average, reduction by CO is lower by a factor of 6 than that by H2. This gives a value
of 104 s1 for reduction by pure CO at 900C.
Taking an approximate value of activation energy of reduction as 30 kJ/mol, calculations
give rO for pure CO = 1.57 104 s1. The influence of gas composition on rate is
pCO2
for reduction of FeO by COCO2 mixture, rO = kC pCO - (5.20)
K11
From data provided, pCO and pCO2 are 0.63 and 0.07 atmosphere respectively. At 1100C,
K11 = 0.4.
Substituting the values in Eq. (5.20), rO = 0.714 10 4 s1.
Estimation of rC
From Eq. (5.23), rC = dFC/dt. Figure 5.7 presents the values of rC for some carbonaceous
materials at 1100C in pure CO2. For coke, the value is 3.2 102 min1, i.e. 5.33 10 4 s1.
In COCO2 atmosphere, the rate of reaction can be expressed as
rC = rC in pure CO2 [ pCO2 ( pCO2)eq] (Ex. 5.6)
where the equilibrium refers to reaction (5.5), for which K is given in Eq. (5.7). At 1100C, i.e.
1373 K, K = 6.0. At the given gas composition, and for total pressure of CO + CO2 = 0.7
atmosphere, calculations give the value of partial pressure of CO2 at equilibrium with
pCO = 0.63, as 0.066 atmosphere.
Inserting values in Eq. (Ex. 5.6), rC = 5.33 104(0.07 0.066) = 2.13 106 s1
Therefore, from Eq. (Ex. 5.4), the rate of reduction of 1500 kg of ore,
dNO
- = 13.4 104 kgmol of O/s
dt
and rate of carbon gasification of 500 kg of coke,
dNC
- = 30 2.13 106 = 0.63 104 kgmol of C/s
dt
Extensive viscosity measurements have been carried out in the laboratory for synthetic blast
furnace liquid slags, and enough data are available on this subject.
Slag basicity is another important parameter (see Section 4.4.3). Acceptable levels of
transfer of both sulphur and silicon from the metal to slag are facilitated if the slag is basic. But,
highly basic slags have higher viscosity as well. These two contradictory requirements are met
in the blast furnace by maintaining a V-Ratio (see Eq. (4.46)) of the Hearth slag between
1.0 and 1.25.
Nowadays it has become a standard practice to use slags containing 410% MgO in the blast
furnace since MgO lowers both the liquidus temperature as well as the viscosity. The gangue of
Indian iron ore has high Al2O3/SiO2 ratios, resulting in high Al2O3 in blast furnace slag in Indian
furnaces. In this situation, addition of larger amounts of MgO to arrive at a hearth slag
composition of about 30 32% CaO, 30% SiO2, 2530% Al2O3 and 710% MgO is resorted to.
At any given composition of slag, its viscosity decreases with increasing temperature.
Figure 5.9 (Coudurier et al., 1985) shows viscosity (h) vs. temperature (T) curves for blast
furnace-type slags at three different basicity ratios. To obtain a fluid, free-running slag, a
minimum hearth temperature is required. This is known as the Critical Hearth Temperature. It
should be as low as possible in order to cut down the heat requirement as well as to increase
the hearth lining life. Typically, it is maintained at 14001450C. At this temperature CaO
SiO2Al2O3MgO containing slags become sufficiently fluid owing to the presence of the minor
constituents (MnO, TiO2, alkali oxides, etc.).
15
CaO
= 1.6
SiO2
10 1.5
h, poise
1.25
5
Figure 5.9 The relationship between viscosity and temperature for basic blast furnace slags.
In modern blast furnaces, prepared sinter constitutes a large percentage of the iron oxide
burden. The sinter may be acid sinter, self-fluxed sinter, or super-fluxed sinter, having CaO/SiO2
ratios less than 1, approximately equal to 1 and above 2, respectively. The first slag that forms
in the belly region at around 12001300C may or may not contain any CaO. As stated in
Section 4.4.2, melting at such a low temperature is only possible because of the formation of
FeOSiO2 compounds in large amounts. These compounds have very low liquidus temperatures
when they react with the reduced FeO to form what is known as the primary slag.
102 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
As the primary slag trickles down through the bed of solids, its temperature rises. Moreover,
FeO gets reduced and the slag dissolves more CaO. At the tuyere level, the coke burns thereby
releasing coke ash consisting of SiO2 and Al2O3. This makes the slag at the tuyere level high
in SiO2 (acid slag). The slag at the bosh region is known as Bosh slag. Final composition
adjustments occur during the passage of the bosh slag into the hearth, during which the FeO
content becomes very low.
Axis
Coke
pieces
Cohesive zone
Drip zone
SiO(g) + C = Si + CO(g)
(FeO) + SiO(g) = Fe + (SiO2)
2SiO(g) = (SiO2) + Si
Raceway
Deadman SiO2 (coke ash) + C (s)
= SiO (g) + CO (g)
Tuyere
Slag
Hot metal
Slagmetal (hearth)
(SiO2) + 2C = Si + 2CO(g)
(SiO2) + 2Mn = Si + 2(MnO)
Figure 5.10 Schematic representation of the mechanism of silicon reaction in a blast furnace.
Physical Chemistry of Blast Furnace Reactions 103
containing high SiO2 and FeO also drips down through the raceway. The temperature in the
raceway zone is 1900 2000C (2200 K approximately). In the presence of carbon and
depending on the activity of silica, SiO vapour is generated by one of the following reactions:
SiO2 (in coke ash or slag) + C(s) = SiO(g) + CO(g) (5.25)
Or, SiO2 initially forms SiC, which then forms SiO:
SiO2(s) + 3C(s) = SiC(s) + 2CO(g) (5.26)
SiC(s) + CO(g) = SiO(g) + 2C(s) (5.27)
The values of DG0f , i.e. standard free energy of formation for CO and SiO2 are given in
Table 4.1. From thermodynamic data sources, DG0f for SiO and SiC are 253250 and 7565 J
at 2173 K (i.e. 1900C). At aSiO2 = 1 and pCO = 1 atmosphere, calculations yield pSiO = 4.4 and
0.044 respectively for reaction (5.25) and (5.27). Hence, for SiO formation, the dominant
reaction is (5.25).
At 1500C (1773 K), pSiO at equilibrium with reaction (5.25) is approximately
104 atmosphere. This makes SiO vapour unstable when it rises upwards in the bosh. Therefore,
in this region Si gets transferred into liquid Fe by the reaction of SiO with C dissolved in liquid
iron in the following way.
SiO(g) + [C] = [Si] + CO(g) (5.28)
Or, by decomposition as
2SiO(g) = (SiO2) + [Si] (5.29)
Other reactions have been proposed, such as:
(FeO in slag) + SiO(g) = [Fe] + (SiO2) (5.30)
In whichever way it is formed, SiO2 joins the slag phase.
Recent investigations on the mechanism of the reaction of silicon in the blast furnace have
shown that:
The percentage of Si in liquid metal is as high as 68% within 1 metre of the raceway,
decreasing to about zero towards the furnace axis, indicating that large-scale Si
absorption by metal takes place in the raceway.
The percentage of Si in metal increases with increase in RAFT (i.e. Raceway Adiabatic
Flame Temperature).
As early as the 1950s and 1960s, investigators quenched running blast furnaces by using a
cold nitrogen blast. This froze the liquids in the bosh and tuyere regions. Samples collected from
the frozen metal demonstrated the pattern of variation in Si dissolved in iron which is shown in
Figure 5.11. The maximum value was at the tuyere level.
Reactions in hearth
Molten metal droplets react with the slag in hearth while passing through the slag layer.
Extensive laboratory and plant investigations have been carried out on several blast furnace
reactions in the hearth.
104 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
+ VE
Si in HM
O Tuyere
VE
Figure 5.11 Schematic representation of the profile of silicon concentration in liquid iron near the
tuyere level.
10
1600C
1
p 2 , (atm)2
1500C
(%SiO2 ) CO
0.1
[%Si]
1400C
0.01
0.001
0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6
%CaO + %MgO
%SiO2
Figure 5.12 Silicon distribution ratio for graphite-saturated melts for blast furnace type slags
containing about 10% MgO and 10% Al2O3.
Controversies exist as to whether reactions of SiSiO2 with carbon (Eq. (5.31)) or with Mn
(Eq. (5.34)) attain equilibrium in the blast furnace hearth. From a variety of evidence, it can be
concluded that equilibrium is not attained. The actual silicon content of hot metal is a few times
higher than that predicted by the slagmetal equilibria. This is in conformity with Figure 5.11,
which indicates that Si content of metal decreases from the tuyere to the hearth level.
EXAMPLE 5.4
For the reaction (5.31), i.e. (SiO2) + 2[C] = [Si] + 2CO(g), calculate the weight percent. Si in
liquid iron at equilibrium with the slag in a blast furnace hearth at 1500C. Assume that the iron
contains 4% carbon besides Si, and the slag consists of 49 wt. % CaO, 42 wt. % SiO2, and
9 wt. % Al2O3. Make other assumptions as necessary.
Solution: The equilibrium relation for reaction (5.31) is given as
2
[%Si][ fSi ] pCO
K31 = (5.32)
(aSiO2 ) aC
Here aC may be taken as 1, since the liquid iron may be assumed to be saturated with graphite.
The activity of SiO2 in slag may be found out from Figure 4.3, Chapter 4. Although the
figure is for 1550C, it is approximately valid for 1500C as well. For this the conversion of
wt. % into mole fractions is required. It can be done using Eq. (4.26) in Chapter 4. Calculations
give the values of mole fractions (X) of CaO, SiO2 and AlO1.5 as 0.50, 0.40 and 0.15
respectively. From Figure 4.3, aSiO2 = 0.1. From Eq. (5.33), K31 = 1017.
106 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
The gas bubbles inside iron and slag melts in the BF hearth may be assumed to be pure CO.
Since the slagmetal reaction occurs mostly while the droplets of liquid iron are going down
through the slag melt, the pressure due to height of slag on the bubbles may be ignored. This
makes pCO approximately the same as the pressure of gas in the raceway. On this basis, pCO may
be taken as 3 atmosphere.
log fSi = WC eSiC + WSi eSi
Si = 4 0.18 + WSi 0.103, where W is same as wt. %.
Earlier most steel grades required sulphur contents of less than 0.040%. Subsequent to the
adoption of continuous casting, the upper limit was brought down to 0.025%. Earlier all sulphur
removal had to be completed within the blast furnace; however, with the current practice of
external desulphurisation of hot metal as well as some desulphurisation during secondary
steelmaking, blast furnaces have greater flexibility with regard to the final sulphur content in hot
metal.
10
Height above tap hole, m
4
Tuyere
Slag notch
2
Tap Hole
0
0.2 0.6 1.0 0.6 1.0 1.4 1.8 2.2
Metal sulphur, % Slag sulphur, %
(a) (b)
Figure 5.13 Variation of (a) metal sulphur, (b) slag sulphur, above and below the tuyeres.
Recent investigations have established that the dominant mechanism involved in sulphur
reactions is broadly similar to that of silicon (Figure 5.10). The sulphur in coke ash undergoes
the following reactions in the raceway:
CaS (in coke ash) + SiO(g) = SiS(g) + CaO (5.36)
FeS (in coke ash) + SiO(g) + C(s) = SiS(g) + CO(g) + [Fe] (5.37)
In the bosh and belly regions, SiS decomposes as
SiS(g) = [Si] + [S] (5.38)
Small amounts of sulphur are also absorbed by the bosh slag. It should be mentioned here that
sulphur forms some other volatile compounds COS, CS, which are also carried up into the gas
stream and undergo reactions. However, it needs to be emphasised that SiS is the dominant
vapour species.
108 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Reactions in hearth
In the hearth, the slagmetal sulphur reaction may be written in general ionic form as
[S] + (O2) = (S2) + [O] (5.39)
Assuming Henrian behaviour for all species except (O2),
(%S)[%O]
K39 = (5.40)
[%S]( aO2 - )
i.e. (LS)eq = Equilibrium partition coefficient for sulphur
(%S) (a 2 - )
= = K39 O (5.41)
[%S] eq. [%O]
2
CaO + MgO
1 SiO2 + Al2O3
0.5
0.2
0.1
0.01 0.02 0.05 0.1 0.2 0.5 1.0
Mole % FeO
Figure 5.14 Influence of basicity and iron oxide content of slag on equilibrium partition of sulphur
between slag and metal in the blast furnace temperature range.
Physical Chemistry of Blast Furnace Reactions 109
It should be mentioned that CaO is a much more powerful base and desulphuriser than
MgOabout 100 times stronger. It is also to be noted that for adequate desulphurisation, the
oxygen content of the metal should be very low. This is achieved in the blast furnace hearth by
the reaction of dissolved oxygen in the hot metal with strong oxide formers: C, Si, Mn (reference
Figure 4.1) dissolved in liquid metal. On this basis, the following reactions in terms of
compounds can be written
(CaO) + [S] + [C] = (CaS) + CO(g) (5.45)
(CaO) + [S] + [Mn] = (CaS) + (MnO) (5.46)
1 1
(CaO) + [S] + [Si] = (CaS) + (SiO2) (5.47)
2 2
On the basis of reaction (5.45), an empirical correlation that has been proposed in Tata Steel
(Gupta 1991) is:
1.79(%CaO) + 1.24(%MgO) 8130
log ( LS )eq = 1.35 - log pCO - + 4.15 (5.48)
1.66(%SiO 2 ) + 0.33(%Al2 O3 ) T
It appears that reaction (5.46) also attains equilibrium in the blast furnace hearth. On the
basis of above, the strategy for making low sulphur hot metal is the same as that for silicon,
except that higher hearth temperatures promote better desulphurisation.
The typical range of recovery of manganese varies between 60% and 70% for basic slags
(i.e. (CaO/SiO2) > 1), and between 50% and 60% for acid slags.
Reactions of titanium
Titanium is usually present in blast furnace raw materials as Ilmenite (FeO.TiO2) and
occasionally as Rutile (TiO2). Figure 4.1 illustrates that TiO2 is more stable than SiO2, and is
therefore reduced to a much lesser extent at any given hearth temperature. Titanium also forms
stable carbide, nitride and carbo-nitride. These compounds have high melting points and low
solubilities in liquid iron (0.3% for carbides and 0.2% for carbo-nitrides) and they separate to
form encrustations on the bosh walls, hearth walls and the hearth bottom, resulting in accretion
build-up on the blast furnace bottom region lining. This can often lower the furnace campaign
life since the highest temperatures prevail in this region.
For the reaction,
(TiO2) + 2C(s) = Ti(s) + 2CO(g) (5.50)
the equilibrium constant can be calculated from data in Table 4.1. Both laboratory and plant data
have shown that the Ti content of hot metal increases with greater reduction of SiO2 and MnO,
as expected theoretically. While the wt. % Ti in metal is less than 0.15, the wt. % TiO2 in slag
may be in the range of 0.31.
REFERENCES
AISE Steel Foundation, The Making Shaping and Treating of Steel, 11th ed., Vol. 2, (Ed.)
R.J. Fruehan (1998), p. 110.
Biswas, A.K., Principles of blast furnace ironmaking, SBA publications, Kolkata (1984),
p. 352 and p. 354.
Bogdandy, Von L. and H.J. Engell, The Reduction of Iron Ores, Springer Verlag, Berlin (1971),
p. 181.
Coudurier, L., D.W. Hopkins and I. Wilkomirsky, Fundamentals of Metallurgical Processes,
2nd ed., Pergamon Press, Oxford, (1985), p. 221.
Darken, L.S. and R.W. Gurry, J. American Chem. Soc., 68(1946) 798.
Gupta, S.S., Blast Furnance Ironmaking, in S.S. Gupta and Amit Chatterjee (Eds.), Tata Steel
Jamshedpur (1991), p. 145.
Turkdogan, E.T., Met Trans. B, 9B (1978) 163.
Turkdogan, E.T., R.G. Olsson, and J.V. Vinters, Carbon, 8 (1970) 545.
6
Thermal and Chemical
Features of the Blast Furnace
6.1 INTRODUCTION
Chapter 2 briefly presented the chemical reactions at various zones in the blast furnace along
with the approximate temperature levels at different heights (Figures 2.12.3). In Chapter 5 the
thermodynamics, the mechanisms and kinetics of important reactions in the tuyere zone, stack,
bosh and hearth areas have been discussed.
The processing of solid burden in the blast furnace requires an enormous amount of heat not
only to heat and melt the hot metal and the slag, but also to cater to heat demands of various
endothermic reactions as well as to provide for heat losses. The total heat requirement of a
modern blast furnace is approximately 811 gigajoules (i.e. 109 joules) per thm (i.e. per tonne
of hot metal). Out of this total heat, approximately 6070% is required for the reduction of iron
oxides, the remainder for other endothermic reactions, heating of the solid burden as well as
melting of metal and slag. About 810% of the total heat is lost through the top gas and through
the walls. About 8085% of heat input comes from the exothermic combustion reaction of
carbon and hydrocarbons, and the remainder from the sensible heat of the hot air blast.
Table 6.1 Simple overall mass balance for a blast furnace producing hot metal containing one mole
of iron
where Cp = a + bT + cT 2 (6.6)
Here, Cp(s), Cp(l), Cp(g) are heat capacities of solid, liquid, and gas respectively. Tm, Tb are
melting and boiling points respectively. DHm and DHv are the latent heats of melting and
vaporisation. a, b and c are empirical constants and T is temperature in K. The universal
convention is to prepare the thermodynamic data tables on the basis of 1 mole of the substance.
Heat of a reaction (i.e. change in enthalpy owing to reaction) may be designated as DHr,
where by Hess law,
DHr = DHf (products) - DHf (reactants) (6.7)
Here, DHf is the heat of formation of a compound from elements. The values of Cp, DHf at
standard states are available in thermodynamic data tables. Some values for the important
reactions have been noted in Chapter 5.
For easy application, Biswas (1984) has proposed a simple heat balance (in kilojoules per
thm) as follows:
3.5 103C + 1.4VbTb = 8.8 106 + 1465S + 14.1VgTg + 126.4Vg% COg (6.8)
where, C and S refer to mass of carbon and slag respectively in kg, Vb and Vg are volumes of
the air blast and top gas respectively in Nm3, and Tb and Tg are temperatures of the air blast and
top gas respectively in C. The constant term 8.8 106 represents the lump sum approximate
value of the heat of dissociation of ferric oxide + heat of liquid iron + cooling losses, etc. and
% COg is % of CO in top gas.
EXAMPLE 6.1
A blast furnace makes hot metal containing 3.6 wt. % C, 1.4% Si, the remainder being Fe
(i.e. 95%). Other data are:
The ore contains 85% Fe2O3, the remainder being 15% gangue of SiO2 and Al2O3.
The coke contains 85% fixed carbon and 15% ash.
Coke consumption is 800 kg per tonne of hot metal.
Flux contains 95% CaCO3 and the remainder is SiO2, and its consumption is
400 kg/tonne hot metal.
The blast furnace top gas contains a ratio of CO/CO2 = 28/12.
Calculate (per tonne of hot metal) (i) the weight of ore used (Wore), (ii) the weight of slag made
(Wslag), and (iii) the volume of BF gas (Vg).
Solution: Modern blast furnace practice employs prepared burdens besides ore. It has also
other features such as coal injection, etc. However, in order to illustrate the material balance
calculation, a simplified situation of old practice has been assumed here.
Note that all quantities in the following material balances are in kg per tonne of hot metal
produced.
(i) Fe-Balance: WFe in ore = WFe in hot metal = 1000 0.95 = 950 kg
M Fe 2O3 100
Wore = 950 , where M denotes the atomic mass.
2 M Fe 85
Noting that M of Fe2O3 is 160 and M of Fe is 56, Wore = 1597 kg
114 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
(ii) Wslag = Weight of gangue in ore + Weight of ash in coke + Weight of CaO in flux
+ Weight of gangue in flux Weight of SiO2 equivalent of Si in hot metal.
1 M CaO
= 1597 15 + 800 15 + 400 95
100 M CaCO3
60
+ 400 5 - 1000 1.4
28
= 562.4 kg
(iii) Carbon going out through BF gas = Carbon input through coke Carbon in hot metal.
So, carbon going out through BF gas as CO and CO2 = 800 0.85 1000 (3.6/100)
= 644 kg = 644/12 = 53.67 kgmol.
Out of the above, molar fractions of CO = 28/(28 + 12), and of CO2 = 12/(28 + 12).
Calculations yield kgmol of CO and CO2 as 37.57 and 16.10 respectively.
Oxygen (as O2) required to be supplied with air blast = Oxygen required to produce CO + CO2
48 1
Oxygen supplied through iron ore = {37.57 1/2 + 16.10} WFe in ore
112 32
= 22.16 kgmol of O2, since WFe in ore = 950 kg
N2 in air blast = 22.16 79/21 = 83.37 kgmol
Hence, the total BF gas = 37.57 + 16.10 + 83.37 = 137 kgmol = 137 22.4 = 3070 Nm3
As a result of extensive experimental measurements over the years, a fairly deep knowledge
of the internal state of a running blast furnace has been gathered. The techniques that are used
to gather data include the following:
Measurement of temperature, composition and pressure of the gas at various heights
Sampling as well as chemical-physical characterisation of the burden material, mostly in
laboratories, by simulated blast furnace tests, and occasionally, by inserting tuyere
probes into a running furnace
Quenching a running furnace using cold nitrogen as the blast followed by sectioning the
furnace, and determining the physicochemical characteristics of the solids and frozen
liquids
Visualisation and temperature measurement in the raceway of actual furnaces using
infrared cameras.
2700
2600
e
ur
ist
ry
Flame temp., K
2500
D
3 m
o
e
m ur
2400 g/M o i st
3 m
20
m
2300 / M
g
40
2200
2100
2000
1000 1200 1400 1600
Blast temp., K
Figure 6.1 Raceway adiabatic flame temperature following combustion of coke at 1800 K with air
to form CO, as a function of blast temperature and moisture content of air.
Thermal and Chemical Features of the Blast Furnace 117
and moisture content of the air blast on RAFT, whereas Table 6.2 shows the effect of changes
in furnace conditions on RAFT (Walker, 1986).
EXAMPLE 6.2
[Note: Some simplifying assumptions have been made. For example, some carbon of coke will
be gasified before reaching the tuyere zone, making the heat generated by CO formation lower.
Also, the sensible heat of ash has been ignored. All these will lower the heat input and thus make
the RAFT somewhat lower.]
18
zone
Ga
s
So
lid
s
16 3Fe2O3 + CO = 2Fe3O4 + CO2
Fe3O4 + CO = 3FeO + CO2
14
Chemical Inactive zone
Distance from tuyere level, m
12
Indirect reduction zone
10
of wustite
FeO + CO = Fe + CO2
+
8 unreduced FeO
FeO + CO = Fe + CO2
4 CaCO3 = CaO + CO2
Direct reduction CO2 + C = 2CO
and melting zone, MnO + C = Mn + CO
2 slag and iron P2O5 + 5C = 2P + 5CO
SiO2 + 2C = Si + 2CO
S + CaO + C = CaS + CO
0 500 1000 1500 2000
Tuyere Temperature, C
Figure 6.2 An idealised scheme of temperature distribution of gas and solids along the height of
a blast furnace showing the chemical reactions occurring in the three main temperature
zones.
120 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
temperature distribution of gas and solid along the height of a blast furnace, and shows the
chemical reactions occurring in the three main temperature zones. The CRZ consists of the
chemically inactive zone as well as indirect reduction zone of wustite, and is a part of the TRZ.
The salient features of an ideal blast furnace are as follows.
It consists of three zones, namely preheating zone, TRZ and CRZ, direct reduction and
melting zone.
The gas temperature is always higher than the solid temperature, thus allowing gas-to-
solid heat transfer.
The gas temperature decreases rapidly going vertically upwards from the bottom and
becomes constant at the TRZ, before it begins to decrease.
The temperature of the solids also remains constant at the TRZ.
Stockline S A Stockline
Solid
Solid Gas
Gas
Enthalpy decreasing
Furnace height
Thermal
reserve zone
Tuyere O F Tuyere
0 1000 2000
Temperature, K Temperature, K
(a) (b)
Figure 6.3 Simplified sketch of (a) Reichardts diagram, and (b) Thermal reserve zone.
0.5
Modern B.F.
0.4
H2 + H2O + CO + CO2
0.3
H2O + CO2
Wustite
Regular B.F.
0.2
0.1 Iron
Fe3C
0
700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300
Temperature, C
Figure 6.4 Variation in temperature and gas composition profiles with blast furnace practice.
122 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
CO
O/Fe A A CO2
W
0 C 1 2
P O/C
g
nC decreasing
E
E
Combining the above equations and using the values of heats of formation, the combined
mass and heat balance equation becomes
O x D 172000
- + nOB = nCg (6.17)
Fe 283000
283000
where D and S are in kJ per kgmol. Since D can be fixed in a straightforward manner, and x
has a fixed value depending on the nature of ore, (e.g. for Fe2O3, x = 1.5),
x
O D
Fe - 283000 = a fixed quantity for a blast furnace
O
= (6.18)
Fe H
172000 O
Again, let = 0.61 = (6.19)
283000 CH
124 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Then the point H in the Rist diagram (Figure 6.6), whose coordinates are (O/C)H and (O/Fe)H,
is an invariant and is known as the thermal pinch point. The operating line rotates around H
depending on the value of either (O/C)g at the top, or nOB.
O/C
Fe2O3 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0
1.4 (O/C) , (O/Fe)X
g
1.2 Hatching
W
1.0 1.3, 1.06
0.8
0.6
A
0.4 g
Slope = nC = 1.90
0.2
0
O/Fe
0.2
0.6
0.8
1.0
1.2
B
1.4 0, nO
1.6
1.8
Figure 6.6 The Rist diagram based on mass and heat balance, and FeFexOgas equilibrium at
the chemical reserve zone.
6.4.3 Rist Diagram Based on Oxygen and Heat Balance, and FeFeX O
Gas Equilibrium
Section 6.3.3 discussed the attainment of FeFeXOgas chemical equilibrium at the chemical
reserve zone in well-operated modern blast furnaces. Assuming a temperature of 950C in the
CRZ and on the basis of the FeCO phase stability diagram (Figure 5.1), it is possible to
represent the equilibria of Fe2O3, Fe3O4 and FeXO with gas in a Rist diagram. This is shown by
the hatched lines in Figure 6.6. The minimum permissible value of the slope nCg is obtained at
Thermal and Chemical Features of the Blast Furnace 125
the operating line HW. W is known as the chemical pinch point. It corresponds to FeFeX O
gas equilibrium. Hence, the line WAH represents the best possible operating practice with a
minimum coke rate. This corresponds to the concept of an ideal blast furnace (Section 6.3).
Hence, an ideal blast furnace has the highest efficiency.
REFERENCES
Biswas, A.K., Principles of Blast Furnace Ironmaking, SBA Publications, Kolkata (1984).
Peacy, J.G. and W.G. Davenport, The Iron Blast Furnace, Pergammon Press, Oxford
(1978).
Rist, A. and N. Meysson, Rev. Met., 61 (1964) 121126.
Turkdogan, E.T., Met. Trans B, 9B (1978) 164.
Walker, R.D., Modern Ironmaking Methods, The Institute of Metals, London (1986).
7
Internal Zones and Gas Flow
in Blast Furnaces
7.1 INTRODUCTION
Chapter 6, Section 6.3 presented the concept of an ideal blast furnace, which has been found
to be very useful, not only for easy understanding of some gross features, but also for
quantitative analyses and process control. In such an ideal furnace, the temperature and
composition of the gas and solid inside the furnace are assumed to vary only along the height
of the furnace and all variations in the horizontal direction are ignored.
However, in an actual blast furnace, there are significant temperature and composition
variations along the horizontal direction as well. Figure 7.1 illustrates this phenomenonthe
Temp. C
600
Level 1
700
Level 2
0
80 Level 3
00
10
0
90 Level 4
00
11
1300
1200
1225
1400
Figure 7.1 Radial temperature profiles in a 2000 m3 Russian blast furnace at four vertical levels.
126
Internal Zones and Gas Flow in Blast Furnaces 127
temperature isotherms are not horizontal (Nekrasov et al. 1969; 1970). The temperature rises
from the periphery and reaches the maximum at the centre along any given horizontal plane.
Figure 7.2 shows the variation in gas composition in the horizontal direction.
15 32
14 CO 28
CO2 Level 1
10 24
5 20
0 1.0 2.0 3.0 3.7
12 34
Level 2
CO2 content, %
CO content, %
4 26
0.1 0.5 1.8 2.4 2.8 4.55
9.5 38
5.5 34 Level 3
1.5 30
0 0.4 1.4 2.4 3.4 4.4 5.15
8 39
4 35 Level 4
0 31
0 0.2 0.7 1.7 2.7 3.7 4.7 5.45
Distance from wall, m
Figure 7.2 Radial variations in CO and CO2 content of gas at four levels for the investigation
reported in Figure 7.1.
Ore
e
Cok
Granular zone
Cohesive zone
Stagnant
coke zone
Tuyere zone
Metal
Figure 7.3 Schematic sectional diagram of the internal zones in a blast furnace.
Right at the top of the furnace is the granular zone that contains the coke and the iron-
bearing materials charged, sometimes along with small quantities of limestone and other fluxes.
The iron-bearing oxides charged get reduced to wustite and metallic iron towards the lower end
of the granular zone. As the burden descends further, and its temperature rises on account of
contact with the ascending hot gases, softening and melting of the iron-bearing solids takes place
in the so-called cohesive zone (mushy zone). Further down the furnace, impure liquid iron and
liquid slag are formed. It has already been stated in Chapter 1, and also in Chapter 4,
Section 4.4.1, that the absorption of carbon lowers the melting point of iron drastically. For
example, an iron alloy containing 4 wt. % carbon melts at only 1185C. In the cohesive zone
and below it, coke is the source of carbon for carburisation of liquid iron. However, carbon
directly does not dissolve in liquid iron at this stage. The possible mechanism of carburisation
of iron entails the formation of CO by gasification of carbon (Eq. (5.5)), followed by the
absorption of carbon by the reaction:
2CO(g) = [C]in Fe + CO2(g) (7.1)
This has also been explained in connection with the reduction of FeO by carbon in Section 5.3.3.
As discussed in Section 5.4.1, Chapter 5, the initial slag that is formed within a blast furnace
has a low melting point because it contains large amounts of FeO. This is the type of slag that
is formed in the cohesive zone. It is known as the primary slag. As the primary slag trickles
down the furnace through the active and inactive coke bed, FeO gets progressively reduced by
130 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
carbon. As the temperature rises, bosh slag containing CaO, MgO, and high percentages of silica
gets formed. To this extent, the temperature and composition of bosh slag are radically different
from those of primary slag.
As already discussed in Chapter 5, Section 5.1, carbon undergoes combustion in the raceway
of the tuyere zone (also see Section 6.2 in Chapter 6). During combustion, coke pieces swirl
around before they get gasified, and then fresh pieces descend to take their place. Finally, slag
and metal of the desired composition accumulate in the hearth, from where they are periodically
tapped.
120
H 1- e
e3
DP rg d p
Ergun equation
10
2
5
G0
y=
1 5 10 100 1000
d pG0 1
Re =
ng 1- e
Figure 7.4 Friction factor plot for flow of gas through a packed bed of solids.
and
d p G0
Re = Reynolds number = (7.4)
h g (1 - e )
Here,
rg = gas density
dp = particle diameter
H = bed height
hg = viscosity of gas
volume of empty space in bed
e = void fraction in the packed bed = (7.5)
volume of bed
G0 = mass velocity of gas
= mass flow per unit cross sectional area of bed (7.6)
= rgv0
The velocity v0 is known as the empty-tube velocity (i.e. the nominal gas velocity), since the
actual gas velocity through the bed voids is unknown.
In Eq. (7.2), the factor 150/Re is for laminar flow, and 1.75 is for highly turbulent flow
(Re > 2000). Gas flow in blast furnaces is turbulent in nature and hence Eq. (7.2) may be
simplified as
y = 1.75 (7.7)
For turbulent flow, the pressure gradient in the vertical direction can be obtained by combining
Eq. (7.7) with Eq. (7.3). Then,
DP G2 1 1 - e
= 1.75 0 (7.8)
H rg d p e 3
From Eqs. (7.6) and (7.8),
DP 1 1-e 2
= 1.75 rg v0 (7.9)
H dp e 3
132 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
The Ergun equation may be applied for a mixture of particle sizes of non-spherical shapes.
For this, a shape factor (fs) is introduced as follows.
surface area of sphere of equal volume
fs = (7.10)
surface area of particle
In Eq. (7.9), dp is to be taken as the diameter of a sphere, whose volume is the same as that of
the particle. In Eqs. (7.3) and (7.4), fs dp is to be substituted in place of dp. For a mixture of sizes
the arithmetic average of fs dp is to be employed.
Figure 7.5(b) presents the quantitative data for the same diameter ratios of the solid particles
in which ds and dl are the diameters of small and large particles respectively (Jeschar 1975). On
the left and right boundaries, uniform sizes can be seen in between the mixtures of various size
proportions. Equations (7.8) and (7.9) show that DP is proportional to (1 e)/e 3, if other factors
are kept constant. At e = 0.45, (1 e)/e 3 = 6.0, and at e = 0.3, (1 e)/e 3 = 26.0. Hence, DP
will be larger with lower e. In other words, with lower voidage in the case of particles with
mixed sizes, the bed permeability will decrease. At the same value of DP, the gas flow rate (and
thus productivity) will then go down. This is a very undesirable effect, that has to be avoided.
The following summary focuses on these issues:
(a)
0.5
Ore Sinter:
ds/dl = 0.49 ds/dl = 0.40
Void fraction e and em
0.4 0.23
0.3 Spheres
ds /dl = 0.493
= 0.027
0.2
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0
Volume ratio, Vs /Vt
Figure 7.5 (a) Figures on the extreme left and right show the packings of uniform large and small
spheres, and the middle that of a mixed bed of large and small spheres. (b) Void
fractions of mixtures of two sizes of ores, sinter and spheres of different size ratios.
EXAMPLE 7.1
Examples of packed bed reactor in ironmaking are the blast furnace stack, the sinter strand for
sintering of iron ore, the shaft furnace for sponge ironmaking by gaseous reduction of iron ore
pellets, etc. Consider the aerodynamics of such a reactor.
Given:
(i) Nominal velocity of gas through the bed is 2 ms1 at 500 K
(ii) The gas consists of 60% N2, 20% CO2 and 20% CO; gas viscosity = 3 105 kgm1s1
(iii) Bed void fraction is 0.35
(iv) Iron ore pellets are spherical with a density of 4.0 103 kgm3
(v) Pellet diameter ranges between 4 and 15 mm with a size distribution function, defined
as
15
Sd d p =1
4
where
S = me 0.1dp
dp = the pellet diameter
m = a constant.
Calculate:
(a) The pressure drop per unit length of the bed along gas flow direction
(b) The minimum critical velocity for bed fluidisation.
Solution: (a) First of all, the average particle diameter is to be calculated from the relation,
dp = 6/a, where a = average specific surface area per unit volume = A/V, where A and V are the
average surface area and the volume, respectively, of the particle.
15
- 0.1d p
Now, me ddp = 1 (Ex. 7.1)
4
e ax
The integral is of the form: x 2 eax dx =
a 3
(a2 x 2 - 2ax + 2), from Table of integrals.
Solving this with the help of Table of integrals, gives V = 0.275 103 mm3.
From values of A and V, the average value of dp = 9.28 mm.
d p G0
From Eq. (7.4), Re = , where G0 = rgv0
h g (1 - e )
273
Gas density = rg = [28 (0.6 + 0.2) + 44 0.2] = 0.76 kgm3
22.4 500
Putting in values in Eq. (7.4), Re = 724.
Figure 7.4 shows that the flow is turbulent. Hence, Eq. (7.9) is applicable for pressure drop
calculation.
DP 1 1-e 2
= 1.75rg v0
H dp e 3
where
L = superficial mass flow rate of bosh slag, kg/m2/h
vtu = superficial tuyere gas velocity (empty tube), m/s
ac = specific surface area of coke particles, m2/m3
Gtu = superficial mass flow rate of tuyere gas, kg/m2/h.
Here, the subscript l refers to liquid bosh slag.
Flooding occurs, if y 2m > 0.001 (7.17)
Since, y (hl0.2/rl), liquid slag would be responsible for flooding because:
Viscosity of liquid slag is greater than that of liquid metal, and
Liquid slag has lower density than liquid metal.
Figure 7.6 shows the y vs. m relationship for flooding (Eq. (7.17)) in a loglog plot (Beer
and Heynert, 1964). It also presents some values collected from the data of several blast
furnaces. The Sherwood diagram (Figure 7.6) suffers from the drawback that both the co-
ordinates have gas terms, and the ordinate is not dimensionless. Later, another loading and
flooding diagram was proposed by Mersmann, 1965, in connection with gas and liquid
counterflow in packed and irrigated beds. This has also been employed for the analysis of blast
furnace gas flowing through the wet zone. However, the conclusion has been the same
qualitatively, i.e. flooding limits the flow of gas through the inactive coke zone and the cohesive
zone of a blast furnace.
3
2
Flooding factor, y
0
10
6
5
1
10
4 3 2
2.10 3 4 5 6 10 2 3 4 5 6 8 10
Fluid ratio, m
Figure 7.6 Relationship between flooding factor and fluid ratio (the line is for limiting flooding curve
as per Eq. (7.17), and the crosses are the values calculated from some blast furnaces).
they are approximate. Moreover, they are only for the granular zone and coke zones. The
situation in the cohesive zone is very complex, and reliable theoretical estimates are extremely
difficult to come by.
Therefore, for practical applications in blast furnaces, an empirical parameter, called Flow
Resistance Coefficient (FRC) has become popular. The FRC for a bed is given as
DP
Gas flow rate = (7.18)
FRC
where the gas flow rate is for unit cross section of the bed, i.e. either mass flow velocity (Go),
or volumetric flow velocity (vo).
1
Hence, FRC = (7.19)
bed permeability
The FRC for a furnace can be empirically determined from measurements of pressure drop
and gas flow rate. Since it is possible to measure pressures at various heights within a furnace,
the values of FRC for individual zones can also be determined.
(DP)overall = S DP = (gas flow rate) S FRC (7.20)
zones zones
1 to 5 1 to 5
These measurements have indicated that FRCs for the granular, cohesive, coke + tuyere
zones are approximately 20%, 50% and 30% of the overall furnace FRC. This means that the
cohesive zone is responsible for the maximum flow resistance and pressure drop, to a very large
extent.
As stated in Section 7.1, the furnace productivity is approximately proportional to the mass
flow rate of gas. Therefore, for high productivity, the total FRC for the entire furnace should be
as low as possible. The role of various operating parameters and burden properties in this
situation will be discussed in more detail in Chapter 10.
REFERENCES
Beer, H. and G. Heynert, Stahl u. Eisen (1964), Vol. 84, pp. 13531365.
Besley, J.J., N.B. Melcher and M.M. Harris, J. Metals (1959), Vol. 11, pp. 610615.
Jeschar, R. et al., in: Blast furnace aerodynamics, Proc. Symp. Aus. IMM, (Ed.) N. Standish,
Wollongong (1975).
Mersmann, A., Chem. Ing. Tech., Vol. 37 (1965), pp. 218226.
Nekrasov, Z.J. and M.T. Buzoverya, Stahl in Eng., Feb. 1969, pp. 141147; July 1970,
pp. 502509.
Sherwood, T.K. et al., Ind. Eng. Chem. (1938), Vol. 30, pp. 765769.
8
Raw Materials I: Coke
8.1 INTRODUCTION
Coke is one of the most important raw materials for hot metal production through the blast
furnace route. It often accounts for almost 60% of the cost of producing hot metal in blast
furnaces, and hence, attention to coke is extremely important. Coke plays three major roles in
a blast furnace, viz. supplies energy for the chemical reactions to occur; supports the burden,
particularly at the lower region when the charge melts, thereby providing permeability for the
gases to pass through a packed bed of solids; and finally, it carburises the hot metal bath prior
to steelmaking.
Cokemaking involves carbonisation (destructive distillation) of coal under controlled
conditions in a coke oven. The quality of cokeexpressed in terms of its room temperature and
high temperature strength, reactivity, ash content and chemistryhas a major influence in
determining the coke rate and productivity of a blast furnace. The quality of coke primarily
depends on the quality of coal (or, more often, coal blend) used to make coke and the pre-
carbonisation techniques adopted prior to charging coal into the coke ovens. To a much lesser
extent, coke quality is also influenced by the actual carbonisation conditions adopted during
cokemaking, as well as by any post-carbonisation technique that is practised before the coke
made is sent to the blast furnaces.
(metallurgical) coke. Besides poor quality, Indian coal, both coking and non-coking, has adverse
washability characteristics, i.e. even after undergoing extensive crushing before washing,
removal of ash from these coals becomes difficult, without encountering large losses in yield.
Yields higher than 55% are difficult even for removing one-third of the ash present in the coal
that is mined. At the same time, because of the inordinately high ash content, all coking coal
has to be washed to yield clean coal with 1518% of ash. For this purpose, India has many coal
washeries (currently 19, with a total capacity of 27.2 Mtpa).
The coal deposits in India occur mostly in thick seams and at shallow depths. The
non-coking coal reserves aggregate 172.1 billion tonnes (85%) while the coking coal reserves
are 29.8 billion tonnes (the remaining 15%). The reserves are fairly widely distributed over
13 states in India located as far apart as Gujarat and Rajasthan in the West, Madhya Pradesh and
Chattisgarh in Central India, Tamil Nadu in the South, Jammu and Kashmir in the North and
Assam in the Northeast (Ray et al. 2005). However, the eastern states of Bengal, Bihar,
Jharkhand, etc. are the principal coal-bearing areas.
Around 0.8 million tonnes of coal on an average is extracted daily in India, and at this rate,
the reserves are likely to last just over 100 years. This does not augur well, particularly since
the energy derived from coal in India is about twice that of the energy from oil, as against the
rest of the world, where energy from coal is about one-third lower than that from oil. Thus, coal
is no doubt a cause for concern for Indian industry as a whole, particularly when it comes to
steel production using the classical BFBOF route.
includes determination of moisture, ash, volatile matter and fixed carbon contents, all of which
have an important bearing on the coking potential of a particular coal. However, since it is a
fairly standard procedure, it is not discussed in any greater detail here.
Figure 8.1 schematically represents the variation in fixed carbon, volatile matter and
moisture contents for different types of coal. An important point to note is that ash, to a very
large extent, decides the physical characteristics of coke, and this, in turn, has a major impact
on blast furnace performance. The use of high ash coke increases the coke rate and the slag
volume in blast furnaces, both of which are detrimental.
90
Fixed carbon Volatile matter
75 Moisture
60
Percentage
45
30
15
0
Subbituminous C
bituminous
High-volatile B
bituminous
bituminous
bituminous
bituminous
High-volatile A
Lignite
Subbituminous A
Meta-anthracite
Subbituminous B
High-volatile C
Medium-volatile
Low-volatile
Semianthracite
Anthracite
Coal type
Figure 8.1 Proximate analysis data for different types of coals.
It has been established that every 1% increase in coke ash increases the coke rate by
2325 kg/thm under Indian conditions, where coke with 1822% ash made from a coal blend
with 1418% ash is normally used, compared with 813 kg/thm elsewhere, where coke with ash
lower than 1215% made from coal with 1012% ash is considered suitable for use in efficient
blast furnaces. Calculations have also indicated that every 1% increase in the ash content of coke
typically raises the total silica input into blast furnaces by about 7% and decreases the
productivity by around 3%. This explains why the coke rate is higher and the productivity lower,
even in efficiently run blast furnaces in India.
Another important property of ash in coal is its ash fusion temperature since it influences
the temperature at which the ash begins to become plastic. Here again, Indian coals normally
have low initial ash fusion temperatures (1200 1250C). While this may not be of major
significance in cokemaking, it plays a vital role in coal used for blast furnace tuyere injection
as well as for direct reduction (dealt with in Chapter 13).
Since volatile matter in coal is almost completely expelled during cokemaking, low-volatile
coals yield higher amounts of coke from the same amount of coal, thereby providing more
Raw Materials I: Coke 141
carbon to the blast furnace, and vice versa. However, coal with less than 14% volatile matter (dry
mineral matter-free basis) will not coke, while coal with an extremely high volatile matter is also
not desirable, since such coals either do not coke at all or make coke of poor quality with very
low fixed carbon contents. Although it is somewhat arbitrary, coals with volatile matter less than
18% or greater than 38% are not normally considered suitable for cokemaking. However, like
ash in coal, proper blending of different coals can be carried out to formulate a blend having the
desired level of volatile matter.
Alkalis: Alkalis are present in coal in the form of sodium and potassium oxides (Na2O and
K2O) to the extent of typically 0.20 0.35%. The alkali content of iron ore, in comparison, is
normally very small. Blast furnace operation gets seriously affected if the alkali content of raw
materials is high (say beyond 2 kg/thm) because alkalis keep re-circulating between the tuyere
area and the upper stack. Normally, half of the total alkali input comes from coke ash. Fluxes
like limestone and dolomite contribute the remainder. Therefore, the alkali content in any coal
is a parameter used for its selection in cokemaking.
Both these methods are used to measure the quality of vitrinite present in any coal. Vitrinite
reflectance increases with the rank of coal and is perhaps the most significant parameter
influencing the cokemaking potential of any coking coal.
into a hard coke mass, i.e. the fluid constituents in such coals combine with the non-melting
fractions to form a strong solid mass. Some coals may have inadequate plasticity, while others
may be too fluid for this to happen. In both extremes, blending is required before coals exhibiting
this type of behaviour can to be used. In fact, very few coals by themselves make high-grade
blast furnace coke. In all such cases, optimum coal blends have to be formulated and knowledge
of the fluid/plastic behaviour of the individual coals becomes necessary.
Several plastometers (Gieseler, Sapozhnikhov, etc.) are available for measuring the plastic
properties of coal, and each of these has its respective optima for assessing the coking potential
of a coal.
Dilatometric properties: At the temperature at which fusion of any coal mass occurs, there
is significant evolution of volatile matter in gaseous form. The bubbles originating within the
pasty region exert pressure on the remaining coal, thereby resulting in swelling of the entire coal
mass. Instruments have been designed to measure this dilation/swelling properties, thereby
giving some idea of what would occur when such coals are charged into a coking chamber.
There are two types of dilatometers, viz. Audibert-Arnu and Ruhr that are available to measure
the dilatometric properties of any coal. The former is more commonly used.
1
0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0
Low rank High rank
Mean reflectance, %
Figure 8.2 Relationship between maximum Gieseler fluidity and rank of coal (MOF diagram).
30 28
26 30
25 24
Coke strength 20 Expansion, %
22
20
20
18 10
Micum index, M10
Volume change
16
15 14 0
12
Pressure 10
Contraction, %
10
10
8
6 20
5
4
2 30
0 0
0.3 0.5 0.7 0.9 1.1 1.3 1.5 1.9
Reflectance of vitrinite, Ro mean, %
Figure 8.3 Relationship between reflectance and coke strength, volume change (expansion and
contraction), and pressure for an individual coal.
146 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
IRSID test: The IRSID test initially suggested by IRSIDs laboratory in France and later
adopted by The International Organisation for Standardisation (ISO), determines the strength of
smaller-sized coke (say up to 20 mm). The drum used is identical to the Micum drum. The
quality parameters assessed by this test are the IRSID indices:
I20 = the percentage weight of coke that is above 20 mm size after rotation
I10 = the percentage weight of coke passing through 10 mm screen after rotation.
ASTM tumbler test: This test also shows the abrasion characteristics of coke and is a
modified version of the Micum test. The percentage of coke retained on a 25.4 mm screen is
reported as the stability factor, and that on a 6.35 mm screen is reported as the hardness factor.
90
80
70
60
CSR, %
50
40
30
20 y = 1.082x + 90.959
R2 = 0.6941
10
0
0 20 40 60 80 100
CRI, %
Figure 8.4 Correlation between CSR with CRI for different cokes.
150
Coal
charging car Gas collecting main
Leveler
Regenerator
Blast furnace
gas main
Air
duct Coke
oven gas
Fill Waste heat
main
flue
Transverse section thru heating flues and Transverse section thru an overn
underjet gas ducts and regeneration
(a)
IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Flue
Flue
Flue
Flue
Flue
Flue
Longitudinal section Longitudinal section
thru inspection thru crossover
holes and waste-gas and airports
recirculation ducts
(b)
Figure 8.5 (a) Transverse and longitudinal sections through an underjet-fired low-differential combination by-product coke oven.
(b) Enlarged section of waste-gas recirculation ducts in each individual oven.
Raw Materials I: Coke 151
Chimney
Quenching tower
Coal tower
Guide car
Quenching car
Figure 8.6 Schematic diagram of a top-charged conventional by-product coke oven battery.
by raising steam in boilers recovering heat from the hot waste gas evolved during operation.
With this concept, cokemaking can either be a part of an integrated steel plant, or can be
undertaken completely independently (merchant cokemaking plant). However, the fact that
coke oven gas is not available as a fuel can be a constraining factor, particularly in an integrated
steel plant.
Figure 8.7 presents a sketch of a non-recovery coke oven. Realistically speaking, todays
non-recovery ovens are not of non-recovery type in the truest sense, since electricity is
generated. However, without any by-product recovery plant, they continue to be referred to as
non-recovery ovens (sometimes also as heat recovery ovens). The important point is that they
are environment-friendly, because of which it is expected that such non-recovery coking systems
would be the technology of choice in the years to come, instead of the by-product coking
systems that can be made environment-friendly only at a considerable cost.
5 6
00 Oven floor
4
1 Oven roof
00 2 Under flue
2 3 Cooling air duct
4 Dividing wall
5 Charge car rail
6 Rail beam
The different types of modern commercial non-recovery ovens technology which are in use
at present are as follows:
Technology Country
Kembla Australia, India
Jewell Thompson the USA
PACTI Mexico
Kumbraj India
Dasgupta India
SPDCI (Shangxi Province Development Coking Institute) China
In non-recovery beehive ovens, the coking process instead of moving horizontally from the
sides as in the case of slot ovens, proceeds vertically from the top of the coal charge downwards
Raw Materials I: Coke 153
and from the bottom upwards. This makes the coking chambers horizontal with limited height.
As a result, they are simple in design and are modular individual units, thereby reducing the
capital costs of a battery of ovens considerably. Water quenching of red hot coke in a quenching
tower is carried out, in the same way as in slot ovens. Volatile matter from the coal supplements
the heat necessary for coking. However, the horizontal space requirement is at least 3040%
more than in the case of slot-oven batteries of the same capacity, and this is sometimes a
drawback.
Because non-recovery ovens operate under negative pressure and the by-products of
carbonisation are burned within the ovens, the door emissions are greatly reduced, and
sometimes, totally eliminated. In addition, any problems associated with coke pressure when
using swelling-type coals are eliminated, since there are no constraining side walls in such ovens.
There are, however, some disadvantages (enumerated earlier) that include:
Reduced output of blast furnace quality coke from each oven
No generation of coke oven gas, which can be of value in large integrated steelworks as
a fuel in subsequent processing
Low productivity rates per specific chamber volume on account of extended
carbonisation times
Requirement of more land for a given coke output
Unavoidable partial burning of the coal charged inside the ovens owing to the presence
of airleading to at least 12% lower coke yield from a given amount of coal.
Figure 8.8 compares the modes of heat supply to slot-oven and beehive oven. Carbonisation
in non-recovery ovens is, in principle, quite different from that in by-product ovens. Heat is
supplied above the coal charge directly by partial combustion of the evolving flue gases and part
burning of the top surface of the coal charge. While a part of the exit gas is sent to boilers for
power generation, complete post-burning of the remaining flue gases in the oven sole heating
flues provides heat directly beneath the coal charge.
Crude
gas Coking directions
Regenerators
Figure 8.8 Comparison of heat supply in slot-oven (left) and beehive oven (right).
154 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
The first set of non-recovery coke ovens were built in Vansant, USA, in the year 1989 and
more ovens were added in the next ten years, both in Vansant and other places in the USA, for
example, by Inland Steel in Chicago. Other non-recovery installations exist in Australia, Mexico
and India. These installations incorporate the concept of heat recovery. After the waste gas is
combusted at 10001200C, the heat is used to generate both steam and power. Once
carbonisation begins and gases are evolved, they are partially combusted. This is done by
introducing primary air through ports located on the top/sides of the oven chamber in the free
space above the coal mass. The partially combusted gases leave the oven chamber through the
downcomers in the oven walls, and enter the sole heating flues underneath the oven after more
air is introduced so that combustion can be completed. At the end of the carbonisation cycle
when the coke mass is at a temperature of about 1150C, the doors are removed and the charge
is pushed in the horizontal position by a pusher into the quench car.
Coke of high-quality with CSR exceeding 72 can be made in non-recovery ovens, owing to
the higher bulk density of the charge (more so if the charge is compacted before insertion into
the oven), higher operating temperatures particularly in terms of higher sole temperatures, and
slower coking rates (longer coking times). Many of the properties of the non-recovery oven coke
cannot be economically achieved in slot ovens.
8.8.4 Stamp-charging
In stamp-charging, the bulk density of the coal charged into any oven is increased by physically
stamping the charge into a cake, outside the oven. The cake, which is almost similar in size to
the oven, is then inserted into the oven. Stamping is carried out externally in a stamp-charging-
pushing machine which uses drop hammers to increase the bulk density of the charge to around
1150 kg/m3 before it introduces the cake into the slot oven. Crushing to more than 90% below
3 mm and 4050% below 0.5 mm is required to produce stable cakes. No extraneous binder is
added to the coal blend after crushing. Only around 10% moisture has to be maintained to
provide the binder action. With stamp-charging, low-rank, weakly-caking and high-volatile coals
can also be used, but because the charge is compacted to very high bulk densities, increased wall
pressures can be a problem. To control the wall pressure within acceptable limits so that the oven
156 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
refractory walls are not damaged, the coal blend used must be carefully chosen. An optimum
balance between high and low volatile coal is necessary in order to ensure that high-quality coke
is made without causing permanent damage to the oven walls and the oven supporting structure.
Stamp-charging has the following advantages:
Significantly higher bulk density (1150 kg/m3)
Increased throughput (810%) owing to higher bulk density
Improved coke strength owing to closer packing of the individual coal particles during
carbonisation
Coke produced is denser, smaller and more uniform in size
Less pollution during carbonisation since fine coal is not charged from the top of the
ovens.
The primary disadvantage is that the preparation and handling of the stamped cake entails
increased capital cost. Stamp-charging has been successfully used in France, Poland, the Czech
Republic, and India.
REFERENCES
Arendt, P., F. Huhn, H. Kuhl and G. Sbierczik, CRI and CSRAn Assessment of Influential
Factors, Cokemaking International, 1 (2000).
Chatterjee, Amit, Tata Tech, June 1991.
Ray, H.S., B.P. Singh, S. Bhattacharjee and V.N. Mishra, Energy in Minerals and Metallurgical
Industries, Allied Publishers, 2005.
9
Raw Materials II: Iron Ore
and Agglomerates
9.1 INTRODUCTION
Of the many variables that affect the productivity and energy consumption of blast furnaces, the
quality of raw materials is perhaps the most significant. All over the world, substantial
improvements in blast furnace performance have been brought about by using superior quality
raw materials. Consistency in quality is another key requirement for ensuring efficient blast
furnace operation.
The most widely used raw materials in blast furnace iron production are coke, lump iron ore,
sinter, pellets (sinter and pellets are together often referred to as agglomerates), and fluxes like
limestone and dolomite. Coke has been dealt with in Chapter 8. The other raw materials
mentioned will be covered in this chapter. The influence of the quality of the raw materials on
productivity, fuel rate and other parameters controlling blast furnace performance will be
discussed in Chapter 10.
Lump ore, sinter and pellets ore thus become the feedstock for liquid iron production in blast
furnaces. It needs to be mentioned that in most deposits, a maximum of 10% is hard lump ore,
and around 1520% of the ROM ore after processing is in a size that is suitable as feed for
sintermaking. Because of several advantages of using sinter in blast furnaces, sintered iron ore
has emerged as the preferred iron feedstock. Pellets have replaced sinter in certain cases on
account of their higher purity and greater size consistency. In general, more and more
agglomerates are being used in blast furnaces, with the result that the use of lump ore has
decreased in many countries from 35% in 1970 to less than 10% at present. This has also helped
in prolonging the life of the iron ore deposits in view of the fact that only a small fraction is
fit for use as lump ore, as already mentioned. Sinter usage has increased to at least 50% in most
blast furnaces, and pellets, which were virtually unknown before 1965, now constitute up to
30% of the charge. The global pellets production has crossed 300 Mt (India around 15 Mt).
Pellets are made in large quantities (36 Mt) in one central location and then transported by sea
or rail. Since sinter cannot be transported easily over long distances after it is made, sinter plants
are normally located inside almost all integrated steel plants.
All the iron oxide feedstocks for blast furnaces either contain haematite (Fe2O3) or magnetite
(Fe3O4), with iron contents ranging from 55% to as high as 66.5%. The higher the iron content
in the feed, the lower is the slag volume generated in the blast furnace, which automatically
increases the productivity and reduces the coke rate. Therefore, higher iron contents in the feed
(60% and more) are preferred. For the same reason, lump iron ores that contain less than 55%
iron are often beneficiated to enrich the iron content to acceptable levels.
the probable/inferred reserves that could be 23 times higher) are around 12 billion tonnes. This
figure keeps changing as more iron ore sources are found. Out of the total reserves, high-grade
ore (min. 65% Fe) is 13%, medium-grade ore (6265% Fe) is 47%, and the rest is low grade
ore.
The deposits of iron ore in India are located mainly either in eastern India (especially in
Jharkhand and Orissa) or in central India (Chattisgarh and Madhya Pradesh). While the reserves
are apparently quite extensive, it needs to be emphasised that high-grade lumpy ore in most of
these deposits constitutes only 67% of the total, i.e. blast furnace operation based only on lump
ore cannot be a long-term option for India. Magnetite, to the extent of around 11 billion tonnes,
is found in western India. This is the only major reserve of magnetite, virtually all other Indian
reserves are haematite. These magnetite deposits contain around 40% Fe, and occur in very fine
form. Therefore, this magnetite cannot be used without beneficiation and pelletisation.
At present, there are three large capacity pelletising plants in western India, located in Goa,
Karnataka and Andhra Pradesh. The pellets made are largely exported. However, for
conservation of Indias iron ore, pelletising is likely to be adopted to a much greater extent in
the future all over India.
Therefore, one of the steps preceding sintermaking is bedding and blending so that uniformity
in the feed to the sintering machine(s) can be ensured, which, in turn would guarantee that the
sinter produced is of consistent chemistry.
For this purpose, the individual raw materials comprising iron ore fines, fluxes (limestone,
pyroxenite, dolomite, etc.) and coke breeze are first crushed (fluxes are ground in a hammer mill,
and coke breeze is ground in a roll crusher or a rod mill) and screened to the size required
typically, iron ore between 100 mesh and 10 mm, fluxes below 3.15 mm and coke breeze below
6 mm. These materials are then individually stored in bins. The materials are discharged from
these bins in the prescribed amounts onto conveyor belts. At the last stage, a shuttle-type
conveyor belt takes all the materials together to the bedding and blending yard. The discharge
from the conveyor is heaped in the shape of triangular piles of the mixed materials on the
ground. From each of these piles, the mix is then scooped by a reclaimer, which in its turn, helps
to make long, horizontal layers.
Approximately 300 individual layers make up one bed and at least two such beds are
provided in any sintering plantone that is still being laid horizontally, and the other from
which the mixed materials are in the process of being sent for sintering. Immediately before
sintering, flux is added and minor adjustments are often made to the coke breeze amount in the
sinter mix, depending on the requirements of sinter chemistry and the prevailing thermal
conditions. More often than not, solid wastes from the plant that contain some amount of iron
and/or flux constituents are added to the sinter mix. Sintering provides an easy way for recycling
these waste materials.
If the fluctuations in sinter chemistry are such that the standard deviation in CaO content is
1.82.0% and that in the Fe content is about 0.700.75% without any bedding and blending,
these fluctuations can be minimised to 0.6% for CaO and 0.3% for Fe by adopting bedding and
blending. Thus, the need for bedding and blending operations prior to sintering is obvious.
9.4.2 Granulation
The green mix after thorough mixing is transferred to a mixing drum. In this drum, water is
sprinkled and the drum is rotated to encourage ball/granule formation. This is essential for
maintaining the permeability in the sinter bed, particularly if deep-bed sintering (bed depth
600 mm and more) is resorted to.
Since it is widely accepted that deep-bed sintering gives superior quality sinter, the
mechanism of granule formation has received considerable attention. The growth of the granules
has been described in terms of two limiting cases, or postulates. In the k-postulate, the granule
size is assumed to be proportional to the seed size. Hence,
y = kx (9.1)
where y and x are the granule size and seed size, respectively, and k is a constant of
proportionality. Recently, it has been shown that k can be calculated from the relationship
1/3
gerl + W ers
k = (9.2)
gerl - W rs + W ers
Raw Materials II: Iron Ore and Agglomerates 161
where W is the moisture content of the granulating charge, g is a minor correction for any
entrapped air bubbles in the layers and for the curvature of the liquidair interface at the granule
surface, e is the void fraction of the layer, and rl and rs are average densities of liquid and solid,
respectively.
In the second theory, the so-called t-postulate, the layer thickness t is assumed to be fixed
and independent of the seed size. Hence
y = x + 2t (9.3)
At present, no theoretical analysis exists for predicting the layer thickness, based on which the
merits/demerits of these two postulates can be assessed.
9.4.3 Sintering
The technique of sintering, whereby the fine materials charged are partially fused at a high
temperature to produce clustered lumps was developed in the 1890s, in the non-ferrous industry
as a batch process. Continuous sintering of copper ore was undertaken between 1903 and 1906
by Dwight and Lloyd in Mexico, wherein, a moving-bed of fine ore particles and other additives,
supported on a metallic chain type strand, was agglomerated by exposing the bed to high
temperatures. The heat required was supplied primarily from external sources. The same idea
was later adopted for iron ore sintering. Since then, DwightLloyd technology has been used all
over the world to produce iron ore sinter for blast furnaces. Sinter is typically 5 mm to 40 mm
in size, made from feed ore fines of below 10 mm in size.
The layout of a DwightLloyd iron ore sintering machine is shown in Figure 9.1. The sinter
mix is fed at one end of an endless belt (or strand) that consists of a large number of hollow
individual steel boxes (called pallets), which keep moving continuously like a chain at the
desired rate, determined by the vertical sintering speed, from the feed end to the discharge end
of the strand. Once the mix is fed into a pallet, heating is begun (referred to as ignition) by using
external burners located in the ignition hood at the feed end of the machine. Individual wind
Bins
1 2 3 4 5 Storage bins 1. Return fines
2, 3. Ore fines
4. Coke
5. Limestone
Mixing drum Leveler
Endless belt of pallets
Feeder Ignition hood
Sinter
W I N D B O X E S breaker
Stack
Dust Hot Cold screen
extractor screen
B.F. sinter
Rotary cooler
Fan Waste gas main
Machine fines
Under size-return fines Under size
boxes located under the strand provide the suction as each pallet moves from the feed to the
discharge end. Sintering is normally completed before the strand reaches the last two wind boxes
at the discharge end. Suction of air through these two wind boxes cools the sinter on the strand.
bed is as high as 12001300C in the combustion zone, it decreases to 60C quite quickly
beyond the combustion zone. This is quite unlike the heat exchange that takes place in the upper
part of a blast furnace, where almost 4 metres of descent is required to increase the material
temperature from room temperature to 800900C. The large difference in the particle sizes
involved and the difference in the suction conditions in the two cases are the essential reasons
for the changed situation.
To monitor the conditions existing within the bed during sintering, it is important to know
the positions of the flame front (maximum temperature zone) at any point of time. This can be
achieved in practice by embedding thermocouples at different depths within the bed. This can
easily be done in laboratory studies conducted in batch-type pot-grate set-ups, which simulate
any one portion of the bed as it traverses through the entire sintering cyclefrom ignition to
cooling. For any thermocouple, positioned, say, at the centre of the bed, the timetemperature
relationship would typically follow the pattern depicted in Figure 9.2 (Eketorp 1962). The
temperature registered by the thermocouple will at first rise rapidly to about 60C, then remain
constant until the flame front passes through that portion of the bed, and finally, begin to
decrease once the air gets sucked through that zone. After the combustion zone proceeds further
to the lower regions of the bed, the products of combustion from the flame front further ahead
also pass through the zone in question. As a result, within a few minutes, the thermocouple
temperature, after rising to the sintering temperature of around 12001300C, begins to decrease.
Heat front
1200
Flame front
Combustion zone
1000
Bed temperature, C
Cooling of sinter
800
Heating of feed
600
200
0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18
Time from ignition, min
Figure 9.2 Temperature variation as a function of time in each layer of the sinter bed in a
laboratory pot-grate sintering unit.
One striking feature of sintering is that the combustion zone (another name used to denote
the flame front) travels so rapidly that it is possible to complete sintering of a bed of
500600 mm depth within a span of around 25 minutes. The rapid dissipation of heat through
the bed and the factors that influence the rate of travel of the flame front are, therefore, of key
importance in sintering. From a fundamental standpoint, it can be envisaged that within the sinter
bed, two fronts co-existthe flame front and the heat front. While the flame front is the zone
of maximum temperature in the bed at any point of time, the heat front is the zone that follows
behind the flame front and absorbs the heat generated in the flame front. The heat front is,
164 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
therefore, always located closer to the top surface of the bed than the flame front, and the lag
between the two, has an influence on the process of sintering as well as the quality of sinter.
The rate of forward travel of the flame front is influenced by the moisture content in the
sintering mix and the amount of fuel (coke breeze) it contains. Both these factors determine the
total amount of heat generated per unit time in that portion of the bed. The exact trace of the
timetemperature curve (typical case shown already in Figure 9.2) would thus be unique for a
given set of operating conditions that also include the rate of air flow through the bed. The latter
is an independent variable that is governed by the total depth of the bed, the bed permeability,
and the extent of suction that is employed.
All these factors also have a role in determining the rate of upward travel of the cooling
front, and, therefore, the position of the heat front. Only if a balance is struck between the rate
of downward movement of the flame front and the movement of the heat front, would it be
possible to make optimum use of the air that gets pre-heated by the approach of the combustion
zone. If the speeds of these two fronts do not match, i.e. either one is slower or faster than the
other, it would be manifested by widening of the combustion zone. Such a situation, however,
would not increase its maximum temperature required for fusing the sinter mix. Most of the heat
generated in the combustion zone is absorbed in the process of drying, calcining (if raw
limestone/dolomite/dunite is used during trimming) and preheating of the lower layers of the
bed. When the combustion zone reaches the grate bars, i.e. the lowest layer in the bed, it signifies
the completion of the process of sintering. This is also often referred to as the burn through point
(BTP). The time taken from ignition to reach the BTP denotes the time of sintering.
1300
1200
1000
1100
900
Cold sinter
50 1 Hot sinter
Time after ignition, min
preheating of air
Depth of bed, mm
100 2
Combustion zone
150 3
Preheating zone
200 4
Drying zone
Cold charge
250 5
300 6 Grate
Waste gases
Figure 9.3 Vertical slice through a sinter bed (300 mm deep) in a laboratory pot-grate sintering
unit, few minutes after ignition of the top layer.
Shrinkage
Ignition hood
300
Height above grate, mm
Friable sinter
200
Wet Strong
100 charge Pla sinter
Dr stic
yz sin
Calcined on te
zone e r
0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14
Grate level Time, min
Figure 9.4 Vertical section through a sinter bed (300 mm depth) along the entire length of the
bed showing the various zones existing in a DwightLloyd sintering unit as a function
of time.
accounting for leakages), etc. Other parameters like the efficacy of bedding and blending,
ignition practice used, post-heat treatment on the strand after sinter cooling, etc. also contribute
towards determining the productivity of any sintering strand.
Sinter strand productivity can be calculated using the following expression:
P = (60 B H V r RF) Y (9.4)
where
P = productivity of sinter, tph
B = bed depth excluding the hearth layer (layer of fine sinter charged on the strand to
protect the metallic parts from excessive heat), m
H = width of the strand, m
V = speed of horizontal movement of the strand, m/min
r = bulk density of the mix on the strand, t/m3
RF = amount of return fines generated, tph
Y = yield of sinter from raw mix, %
At all times, of course, the productivity of a strand has to take cognisance of the stipulations
of sinter quality that is required by blast furnaces. The aim in most situations is to produce sinter
with a high room temperature strength as well as a high low temperature (below 550C) strength
at the highest productivity of the strand. In some cases, blast furnace operation may demand a
moderate low temperature strength combined with high reducibility of sinter. These are
conflicting requirements. Sinter with a high low temperature strength (easily produced in a sinter
plant even at high strand speeds), would not exhibit sufficient reducibility, as required in blast
furnaces. In such a situation, it becomes necessary to produce sinter with that strength, which
would simultaneously comply with the requirements of both sinter plant operation and the blast
furnace quality stipulations. For blast furnaces, sinter of the right quality often means the sinter
that has a high room temperature strength, a relatively low reduction degradation index (extent
of size reduction when the sinter is exposed to high temperature under reducing conditions), a
high reducibility as well as minimal variation in chemistry, the lowest possible fines content, and
a relatively high mean size.
present after partial melting, fusion and subsequent recrystallisation. This can be assessed by
studying and, if possible, controlling the mineralogical phases that constitute sinter.
Mineralogical studies throw light on the type of mineral constituents and their texture. A wide
variety of minerals is found in iron ore sinters such as magnetite, maghemite, wustite, troilite,
ferrites and in silicates like fayalite, olivine, glass, etc. depending on the materials that are fed
and the sintering conditions that are employed thereafter. It has been established that the type
of iron ore minerals present in the feed influence the yield of sinter; on the other hand, the
gangue minerals and the flux have a bearing on the physical strength of sinter. Therefore, the
characteristics of the feed materials, including their composition, have to be carefully selected
along with matching sintering conditions if high-quality sinter has to be produced.
9.6 PELLETISATION
Pelletisation is a process that involves mixing very finely ground particles of iron ore of less than
325 mesh (45 micron) size with fluxes such as limestone, lime, dolomite, etc. as fines, and a
binder like, bentonite (0.51%). After these materials are thoroughly mixed, the moisture level
is generally adjusted to around 10% before the feed is taken for pelletising. Pelletising is carried
out either in a rotating disc (typically 3.75.5 m in diameter) inclined at 45, or in a drum
(typically 910 m long and 2.53.0 m in diameter) rotating at 1015 rpm. The green pellets that
are made following rotation in either the disc or the drum are screened. The oversize (usually
+9 mm) is sent for heat induration, while the undersize is returned to the feed circuit for
re-grinding.
Figure 9.5 shows the principles of particle movement in drum and disc pelletisers. The paths
of motion of the particles during rotation are shown by the arrows. Joining together or
agglomeration of the fine particles in the feed into green balls/green pellets occurs by the
capillary forces exerted by the moisture in the feed. The changes that take place gradually at
various stages of ball formation are depicted in Figure 9.6. It is important to note that the amount
of water used should not either be too little or be too much. Insufficient moisture would not
generate enough capillary forces that are required for bonding, while excessive wetting would not
also have the desired effect (see Figure 9.6(f)). Once nucleation has started, the pellets grow
168 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Figure 9.5 Principle of rotation of the charge in a drum (top) and disc (bottom) pelletiser.
Figure 9.6 Stages in the formation of green balls: (a) initial wetting, (b) primary bonding,
(c) formation of flocs, (d) agglomeration, (e) optimum balling, and (f) excessive wetting.
almost at an exponential rate. Depending on the extent of growth of the balls during rotation as
well as the breakage that occurs owing to collision between the green balls already made,
equilibrium is reached with respect to the size of pellets (generally restricted to 1015 mm
diameter). These green pellets are then dried and heat-hardened at a temperature of
12501300C to produce pellets with acceptable strength.
Raw Materials II: Iron Ore and Agglomerates 169
Figure 9.7 shows the typical set-up of the equipment used for heat-hardening of green pellets
comprising the following:
A travelling grate where the green pellets are dried and pre-heated to around 600 700C
utilising the exit gases from the subsequent rotary kiln
A rotary kiln operating at a maximum temperature of 12501300C where the final heat-
hardening takes place. The rotary kiln is heated by burners which use heavy oil/gas as
the fuel positioned at the exit end.
To grinding process
Factory
steam line
Dehydrate burner
Dehydrating zone
Stack preheat Kiln burner
Drying zone
burner
Core Boiler
Green pellets
230C
330C
10501150C
1300C
100C 1100C
600C
350
450C
410C
Annular cooler
E.P.
The temperatures in various zones of the gratekiln combination are also indicated in
Figure 9.7. In contrast to sintering, no incipient fusion occurs in the case of pelletising. The
pellets develop strength by diffusion bonding and some amount of recrytallisation. Table 9.2
presents data on the typical properties of pellets suitable for blast furnaces.
In order to circumvent heat-hardening completely, attempts have also been made in several
countries to produce cold-bonded pellets that possess sufficient strength without induration.
However, so far, it has been possible to produce only limited tonnages of cold-bonded pellets.
Nonetheless, since this technology holds considerable potential in terms of energy-saving, ability
to utilise cheap fines and wastes, along with reduction in environmental pollution, cold-bonded
pellets are likely to find wider applications in the future.
170 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Table 9.2 Typical properties of pellets suitable for use in blast furnaces
Parameter Target
SiO2, % 2.8 0.1
CaO/SiO2 1.42 0.05
MgO, % 2.1 0.1
(Na2O + K2O), % < 0.075
Mean diameter, mm 11.2 1
Below 4 mm, % < 0.5
Porosity, % 26.5 0.3
Compressive strength, kg/pellet > 260
Above 210 kg/pellet, % > 80
Reduction degradation index ( 3 mm), % < 5.5
Swelling index, % < 12
Contraction, % <9
of the sample in size 816 mm is inserted into the drum before it is rotated at 80 rpm for 4 hours.
After tumbling, the sieve analysis of the product is carried out and the results reported as
percentage fractions in various sizes. The friability index (FI) is calculated from the equation
dg
Friability index = 100 (9.6)
d0
where dg is the mean geometric diameter of the sample after tumbling, and d0 is the initial mean
geometric diameter of the sample.
Some iron ores decrepitate on heating, thereby producing powdery fines. Decrepitation is
measured in terms of the percentage of below 0.5 mm fines generated during heating of the
oxide, particularly lump ore (size 25 + 19 mm) to temperatures of 400C, 600C and 800C.
Nitrogen at a standard flow rate is continuously passed for 1 hour, while the sample is
maintained at the test temperature. The results obtained give an idea of the extent of thermal
decrepitation. In case chemical decrepitation has to be determined, reducing gas has to be used
when the sample reaches the required temperature.
Differential scanning calorimetry (DSC) is a technique that is employed to record the energy
necessary to establish a given temperature difference between the material under test and a
reference material, as a function of either time or temperature, as the two specimens are
subjected to identical temperature regimes where heating/cooling are carried out at a controlled
rate. DSC data is a direct representation of the enthalpy changes that occur. Evolved gas
detection (EGD) and evolved gas analysis (EGA) are techniques used to detect whether or not
any volatile product is formed during thermal analysis, and, if so, its nature and amount.
All the tests undertaken for measuring the above characteristics of iron oxide can be grouped
into static or dynamic tests. Table 9.3 summarises the details of the various tests including the
experimental conditions employed, and the methods used to evaluate the results.
9.8.3 Reducibility
For determining reducibility, two test proceduresrelative reducibility and reducibilityare
adopted. The results obtained from the first method indicate the degree of reduction as a relative
rate compared with a standard sample; while in the second method, the rate of oxygen removal
between 30% and 60% reduction is measured and the (dR/dt) at 40% reduction in per cent/
minute is reported. Both the methods help to assess the reduction rate when the higher oxides
present in any iron oxide sample under testing are reduced to FeO.
Weight
Parameter Reduction under load Softeningmelting test
?
Sample
Size, mm 9.512.7 9.512.7
Weight, g 500 200300
Load, kg/cm2 2 1
Reducing gas
Flow rate, Ipm 15 7.2
Composition, % CO: 30 CO: 30
N2: 70 CO2: If require
N2: 70
Heating rate RT-800C: 90 min. RT-1000C: 10C/min.
8001100C: 180 min. 10001500C: 5C/min.
Figure 9.8 Schematic diagram of the reduction under load test (including test conditions).
1000
DP, mmWC
500 S-value
100
0 TS Tm
Temperature, C
(i) Softening start temperature (Ts ): It is the temperature in degree Celsius at which
softening begins denoted by a pressure differential of 100 mm water column across the
bed.
(ii) Melting temperature (Tm): It is the temperature in degree Celsius at which melting is
completed, i.e. when the pressure drop across the bed after reaching its maximum value
again comes back to 100 mm water column. If the pressure drop does not reach this
value after the test, Tm is assumed to be greater than 1550C, which is the maximum
temperature that the sample can reach in the softeningmelting test apparatus.
(iii) S value (expressed in kPaC): It is determined by measuring the area under the curve
generated by plotting the pressure differential (DP) across the bed against temperature
(shown in Figure 9.9). It is a measure of the resistance offered by the bed to gas flow
in the furnace.
(iv) Non-dripped material (%): Non-dripped material is defined as the amount of residue
that is left in the crucible after the test is completed, expressed as a percentage of the
total weight of the sample less the oxygen associated with iron.
For lump iron ores, the softening start temperature (Ts) usually varies from 1150C to
1200C depending on its composition, whereas depending on the basicity and its gangue content,
Ts of sinter is usually higher. High-quality sinter can have softening start temperatures as high
as 13001320C. The Ts values of mixed beds of lump iron ore and sinter are between the
softening temperatures of the individual components. The final melting temperature (Tm) of iron
ores and sinter varies between 1350C and 1550C. It is highly desirable to have as small a
difference between Tm and Ts as possible, so that the mushy zone temperature range (TmTs) is
restricted. This temperature difference gives a direct indication of the span of the cohesive zone
in a blast furnace. The narrower the cohesive zone, the easier it is for the gases to flow through
the bed, resulting in better reduction kinetics of iron oxide. It is preferable to keep this difference
in the range of 150180C, for optimum blast furnace performance.
The S-value, which indicates the resistance offered by the bed to gas flow, is usually higher
for lump ore compared with sinter, because lump ores generally decrepitate more under reducing
gas conditions at relatively lower temperatures. For any high-quality iron oxide burden, the
resistance offered by the bed to gas flow should be as low as possible, in order to allow faster
flow of gases through the bed.
The amount of non-dripped material measured at the end of the test gives an idea of the slag
characteristics in the drip zone of a blast furnace. It is desirable that the fluidity of the slag
formed by the iron oxide burden should be sufficiently high so that it can easily flow out of the
cohesive zone. Low residue, i.e. less of non-dripped material (maximum 3035%), is taken as
an indication of adequate slag fluidity. As far as this parameter is concerned, lump iron ores
which are acidic in nature fare better than sinter, which is generally basic.
account of the Boudouard reaction (Eq. (5.5)). Indirect reduction of iron oxide by CO produces
CO2. CO2 further reacts with C to form CO at the bottom of the stack. CO in excess of
equilibrium deposits carbon because of the backward reaction in the upper stack at a lower
temperature (Eq. (5.5)). The fine carbon thus deposited travels downwards, and gets gasified into
CO again. However, there is no net accumulation of carbon in the furnace.
In contrast, there are some elements/species that tend to accumulate inside the furnace over
a period of time, since the output in these cases is less than the input. Alkalies and zinc fall in
this category. The alkali metals enter the furnace as constituents of the fluxes, iron oxide and
coke. They are found in many coal and iron ore deposits around the world. Therefore, the iron
oxide used (lump ore or sinter/pellets) as well as the coking coal used to produce coke have to
be carefully chosen with stringent limitations on their K2O and Na2O contents. Otherwise, the
alkali oxides would generate large volumes of potassium and sodium vapour within a blast
furnace by reaction with carbon above 1500C. This occurs principally in the tuyere zone and,
to some extent, in the bosh and hearth according to the overall reaction:
2K2(Na2) SiO3(s) + 6C(s) = 4K (Na)(g) + 2Si + 6CO(g) (9.7)
Of course, a part of the alkali silicates joins the slag phase. The vapour generated as per
Eq. (9.7) travels upwards and reacts with the burden. Both potassium and sodium react in almost
the same way and, hence, only one will be dealt with. The following reactions are of importance.
Formation of cyanides in the upper part of the stack. For example:
2K(g) + 2C(s) + N2(g) = 2KCN(g) (9.8)
The cyanide vapours get absorbed by the solid burdens and descend downwards.
Formation of carbonates in the upper part of the stack. For example:
2K(g) + 2CO2(g) = K2CO3(s) + CO(g) (9.9)
These carbonates deposit on the descending burden. At a higher temperature, they either get
decomposed into the respective vapours through the reverse reaction, thereby causing excessive
decrepitation, or alternatively, they dissolve in the slag (which is less detrimental to the process,
but gives rise to problems of slag disposal).
Since alkali metals have negligible solubility in hot metal, they can be flushed-out only
through the slag as oxides. Acid slags have the capability of absorbing more alkali oxide than
basic slags, and hence SiO2 in the form of quartzite and feldspar is occasionally charged into the
furnace to flush-out excess alkalies.
Accumulation of alkalies in the elemental form or as cyanides is definitely harmful to
efficient blast furnace operation owing to the following reasons.
1. Increased productivity of blast furnaces requires smooth gas flow and high burden
permeability. Disintegration of the oxides or the coke into smaller pieces because of
reduction and reaction lowers the permeability and therefore, decreases the productivity.
Alkali metals make the coke more reactive besides leading to greater disintegration of
ore, coke and sinter as shown in Figure 9.10 (Sasaki et al. 1977). The fact that the coke
becomes more reactive can also have an adverse effect on productivity.
178 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
10
15
Tuyere
17
20 30 40 50 84 88 92 96 0 40 80 0 10 20
Mean coke size, mm Coke drum Reactivity, % (K2O + Na2O) in
strength, % ash, %
Figure 9.10 Variations in size, strength and reactivity of coke along the height of a blast furnace as
a function of the alkali content of coke ash.
2. Alkalies and alkali cyanides enhance degradation and erosion of the refractory lining,
particularly in the stack area.
3. Alkali cyanides tend to bind ore pieces forming accretions and thus cause operational
problems (scaffolds in the stack which is dealt with in detail later in Chapter 10,
Section 10.2.4).
Therefore, the best way to alleviate the problem of alkalies is to choose raw materials with
low alkali contents to keep the alkali input below a maximum of 2 kg/thm.
REFERENCES
Chatterjee, Manoj, World Iron Ore Industry and Role of Indian Iron Ore Sector, Steel Scenario,
Vol. 15 (2005) No. Q1.
Eketorp, S., Chipman Conference Proceedings, MIT Press, 1962.
Gupta, S.S. and Amit Chatterjee, Blast Furnace Ironmaking, SBA Publication, 1995.
Habishi, F., Handbook of Extractive Metallurgy: Iron, Vol. 1, WileyVCH, Weinhein, 1997.
Sasaki, K., et al., Trans. Iron Steel Inst. Jap., 17 (1977), 252.
10
Blast Furnace Productivity, Fuel
Efficiency and Modern Developments
10.1 INTRODUCTION
Around the year 1960, the worlds best blast furnaces were capable of producing about 2000 tpd
(i.e. tonnes per day) of hot metal. Around the year 1980, the production in a few blast furnaces
in Japan went up to 12,000 tpd, which was the maximum at that time. After 2000, the maximum
production in the largest individual blast furnace (e.g. the Schwelgern furnaces of ThyssenKrupp
in Germany) has touched 15,000 tpd. The world average per furnace is obviously lower, but has
been going up steadilyfor example, the average production in furnaces in Germany, which was
about 1200 tpd in 1971 increased to 4700 tpd of hot metal in 1998. At the same time, it needs
to be noted that the number of very large furnaces (greater than 3000 m3 working inner volume)
has not gone up substantially; instead, what has happened is that many furnaces of lower
capacities have been shut down.
Large blast furnaces with working volumes more than 2000 m3 which have recently been
built in Asia include Baoshan No. 3 (4000 m3) in China, POSCO Kwangyang No. 5 (3000 m3)
in Korea and China Steel, Kaoshung No. 4 (3000 m3) in Taiwan. Two very large furnaces
(38004200 m3) are planned to be installed by Tata Steel over the next few years. Jindal South
West Steel is also in the process of installing a similar capacity furnace. Since ironmaking and
steelmaking capacity is predominantly going up in Asia, most of the twelve new blast furnaces
built recently have been in Asia; whereas in the Western world, the number of furnaces in
operation has been decreasing year by year.
It is interesting to note that in 1992, there were 555 blast furnaces existing in the Western
world, 390 of which were in operation (around 70%) and the output amounted to 314 Mt or
about 800,000 tonnes per furnace, i.e. production of 2250 tpd per furnace per year (assuming
355 days of operation, which is typical today). At present there are about 700 blast furnaces
(including 300 in the Western world) in operation globally. During the past decade the number
of blast furnaces available in the USA has also decreased from 83 to 43 and the operating
furnaces from 48 to 40. Despite this decrease of 17% in the number of operating furnaces, the
production has increased by 27% in the USA.
179
180 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
efficiency of blast furnace ironmaking. The silicon content in hot metal, which should be low
for efficient steelmaking is another index of furnace performance. Over the years, the silicon
content of hot metal has been reducedfrom about 1% in 1960 in best operations to about 0.3%
now. Both CR and silicon content are related to furnace productivity and shall be discussed later
in this chapter.
Another factor that is taken as a measure of performance is the blast furnace refractory lining
life. Though blast furnace ironmaking is a continuous process, all furnaces have to be shut down
after some years of operation for complete relining (localised repairs are carried out during a
campaign by going in for temporary stoppages). Earlier, each campaign lasted 56 years, but
now, for modern furnaces the campaign length extends to more than 10 years and can often
reach 20 years. Normally speaking, at the end of a campaign, the furnace is modernised (lines
changed, top-charging gear altered, stoves attended to, etc.) besides the entire furnace getting
relined.
Figure 6.2 gave a schematic representation of the TRZ and CRZ. At the CRZ (which is a
part of the TRZ), the gas is at chemical equilibrium with wustite and metallic iron. As shown
in Figure 6.4, equilibrium is found to exist in modern well-operated blast furnaces. Figure 6.6
contained the Rist diagram of a blast furnace based on oxygen and heat balance, as well as
Fewustitegas equilibrium. The slope of the line is ncg, i.e. gm.atoms of carbon input through
coke per gm.atom Fe. ncg is proportional to coke rate. The minimum coke rate is depicted by the
line HW. H is the thermal pinch point and depends on enthalpy balance, while W is the chemical
pinch point and corresponds to Fewustitegas equilibrium at the CRZ. From this, it follows that
the minimum coke rate is obtained under the following circumstances:
When the FeFexOgas equilibrium is attained at the CRZ, i.e. when a furnace is
working ideally
When point H is moved upwards as much as possible.
This requires the following:
Minimisation of the heat loss through the wall and the top gas
Optimum degree of direct reduction
Higher blast temperature and greater oxygen enrichment of the blast.
At the raceway, the gas consists of CO, H2 and N2. Roughly speaking, the gas volume
required per tonne hot metal (i.e. the specific gas volume) will be the minimum if the fuel
requirement (coke + coal, etc.) is the minimum. For this to happen, FeFexOgas equilibrium
at the CRZ is desirable, which calls for adequate reducibility of the iron-bearing burden (ore,
sinter, pellets).
ascending gas and the solids. Hence, an optimum size has to be chosen for the highest
productivity as illustrated schematically in Figure 10.1. As already noted in Section 7.1, the
optimum size range for lump ore is 1030 mm and for coke is 4080 mm. The coke size is
always 34 times larger than the ore size since coke is to be only partially burnt as it descends.
It also has a lower density, and hence a greater tendency for fluidisation. Of course, in the lower
bosh region of a blast furnace, coke is the only solid that remains, and which helps to support
the burden.
6
5
Productivity
Relative resistance to flow
3
Heat
2
Flow resistance
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Particle diameter, cm
Figure 10.1 Influence of particle diameter on the resistance to flow, rates of heat and mass transfer
as well as productivity.
Chapter 7, Section 7.5 introduced an empirical parameter, viz. Flow Resistance Coefficient
(FRC), employed in operating blast furnaces. The higher the FRC, the greater is the resistance
to flow. Figure 7.3 has schematically shown the various internal zones in a blast furnace and it
is to be noted that the FRC is the highest in the cohesive zone. Therefore, the cohesive zone
provides the maximum resistance to the gas flow. Several investigations have concluded that
flooding in the cohesive and the deadman zones is the principal limiting factor governing gas
flow, as illustrated in Figure 7.6.
Hartig et al. have reported data on the measurement of gas pressure at various locations
inside a blast furnace. A summary of their findings is depicted in Figure 10.2 (Hartig et al. 2000).
The pressure gradient along the furnace height (Dp/h) is 0.027 in the granular zone; but it is
higher in the lower part of the furnace. Calculations based on these data show that D p/h is about
0.13 in the cohesive zone, i.e. about five times more than in the granular zone.
28
24
Dp = 0.35 Dp = 0.2
Dp/h = 0.13
16
Dp = 0.55 Dp = 0.55 12
Dp/h = 0.065 Dp/h = 0.06
0
1.4 2.2 3.0
p,bar Gas pressure, bar
h, m
of the input materials as well as in the control parameters. These variations are referred to as
furnace irregularities. Earlier blast furnaces exhibited more severe irregularities, often leading to
a considerable loss of production arising from the following sources.
Malfunctioning or failure of the mechanical and electrical devices
Faulty routine operations, like tapping, charging, etc.
Malfunctioning or failure of any of the auxiliary facilities
Abnormalities developed inside the furnace because of physicochemical phenomena.
To minimise irregularities, besides going in for regular maintenance and repair of the
mechanical and electrical devices, immediate adoptions of short-range corrective procedures are
undertaken by adjustments of the inputs. Alteration in the blowing procedure through the tuyeres
has an immediate effect, whereas any change made in the amount/sequence of any of the
constituents of the burden, takes at least 46 hours to manifest itself. Of course, with the use
of sophisticated sensing devices and improved process control, the occurrence of serious
irregularities is much less nowadays than what it was earlier. However, abnormalities caused by
physicochemical phenomena inside the furnace still have to be taken care of and will be briefly
described.
The flooding phenomenon has already been discussed in Chapter 7. In Section 10.2.3, it has
already been mentioned that flooding is the principal limiting factor in increasing the production
rate in blast furnaces. In the granular zone of the upper stack region, bed fluidisation constitutes
the limiting factor for gas flow. However, fluidisation of the entire bed seldom occurs in an
operating furnace. The more common irregularity related to this phenomenon is known as
186 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
channelling, where segregation of small particles in a localised region causes movement of the
particles, creating more voids locally. Consequently, this results in preferential higher gas
velocity and local bed instability.
Scaffolding occurs because some materials adhere to the furnace wall and project towards
the furnace centre. Once this happens to any appreciable degree, wedging or bridging of the
charge materials occurs, both across horizontal cross sections as well as vertically along a part
of the lining in that area. This interrupts smooth descent of the burden.
Chemical analyses of samples from such scaffolds have indicated the presence of
compounds of sodium, potassium, zinc, lead as well as powdery coke. The formation and
recycling of volatile compounds, especially alkalies, in the temperature range of 8001100C,
have been discussed in Chapter 9, Section 9.9. Undoubtably, this is one of the major causes of
scaffold formation since the compounds are low melting. The liquid phases formed act as binders
for the accretions to grow. Carbon deposition occurs in the temperature range of 400600C on
account of the reaction: 2CO(g) = C(s) + CO2(g). It is catalysed in the presence of iron and alkali
compounds. Carbon deposition in the pores and joints of the brick lining results in bulging of
the bricks which aids wedge formation.
Hanging is stated to occur when the burden does not descend in a uniform manner. It has
various reasons, including scaffolding and flooding. Sudden swings in blast pressure can
sometimes overcome hanging. However, this invariably results in a sudden downward slippage
of the solids. If as a result of such slips, relatively cold burden materials come to the hearth in
substantial quantities, the liquid metal in the hearth may get chilled, thereby jamming the entire
furnace.
100
95
90
% + 9.5 mm in burden
85
80
75
70
65
30 32 34 36 38 40
Iron, 1000 tonnes per week
Figure 10.3 Increase in blast furnace output with increase in the degree of screening.
Increasing percentages of sinter in the burden, say from 2030% to about 6070% (often
considered to be the optimum) have a marked beneficial influence on furnace performance. Use
of higher percentages of sinter becomes difficult because at lower sinter basicity (basicity has
to be lowered if higher amount of sinter is to be used in order to keep the flux input into the
blast furnace constant), sinter properties like strength and reducibility tend to deteriorate
appreciably. Depending upon the quality of ore and the physical and chemical properties of
sinter, it is generally agreed that, on an average, in the range of 20 70% sinter, every 1%
increase in the proportion of sinter increases the hot metal output by about 0.35% and reduces
the coke rate by about 0.3%.
There is no doubt that with sinter of proper quality, at least up to 70% sinter in the burden,
improves the blast furnace performance dramatically in terms of lower coke rate and higher
productivity. As a result, there are no efficient blast furnaces in the world that do not use sinter.
(often taken as a measure of furnace operating efficiency), lower coke rate and higher
productivity. In early trials in some plants, doubling of production and decrease in coke rate by
about 20% were reported by switching over from lump ore to a predominantly pellet burden. At
present, 1525% pellets are used in many furnaces along with sinter/lump ore. Higher
percentages of pellets are normally avoided because of the following reasons:
High cost
Tendency of pellets to swell when gas pressure is developed in the pores during
reduction, which ultimately leads to disintegration of the pellets
Difficulty to produce fluxed pellets owing to an even higher swelling tendency.
In India, pellets were tried by Tata Steel in the late 1960s but this effort was given up when the
cost of making pellets became inordinately high, following the oil crisis. However, the use of
pellets is again likely to begin in many furnaces over the next five years. Many steel plants
overseas have found it worthwhile to employ a mixture of unfluxed pellets and superfluxed
sinter.
The advantage of pellets is in terms of better reducibility, superior reductiondegradation
index and improved softeningmelting characteristics. The influence of these properties of iron-
bearing materials on blast furnace performance will now be discussed (the procedure for
measuring these values has been already given in Chapter 9).
10.3.3 Reducibility
Chapter 5, Section 5.3.1 discussed the salient features of kinetics of reduction of iron oxides by
H2 and CO. The fundamental studies were carried out primarily in the laboratory using single
pellets owing to their uniform size and the consequent ease of using mathematical tools. It has
been shown that the reducibility of pellets (and sinter) should be high because of the following
reasons:
To allow attainment of Fewustitegas equilibrium in the CRZ with consequent decrease
in fuel consumption, as discussed in Section 10.2.2
To ensure complete reduction of wustite to Fe before the burden reaches the cohesive
zone. If this does not happen, the residual FeO would tend to form low melting
FeOSiO2 type slag, which would flow downwards into the adjacent coke layers causing
loss of permeability.
As discussed in Section 5.3.1, the greater the porosity of the oxide, the higher is the
reducibility. Fluxed sinter is produced by the addition principally of CaCO3, which decomposes
into CaO and forms various double compounds with SiO2 and iron oxides. Figure 10.4 compares
the degree of reduction of some of these sinters with that of haematite and magnetite for the case
of hydrogen reduction at 800C (Watanabe 1962). It may be noted that calcium ferrites have
adequate reducibility; the least reducible phase is CaO FeO SiO2 which is similar to Fayalite
(2FeO SiO2). It is well-established that Fayalite is a low-melting compound that is formed
during sintering/pelletising as a glassy phase with very little porosity. Hence, it has a deleterious
effect on reducibility. Laboratory measurements on self-fluxed pellets containing
5% CaO showed that the high temperature reducibility of pellets which had been partially
reduced at 1000C improved dramatically at 1300C as shown in Figure 10.5
(Turkdogan 1978).
Blast Furnace Productivity, Fuel Efficiency and Modern Developments 189
100
CaO 2Fe2 O3
90
80
Haematite Magnetite
70
Degree of reduction, %
60 CaO Fe2O3
50 2CaO Fe2O3
Self-fluxing sinter
40
30
10
0
10 20 30 40 50 60
Time, min
100
92
88
84 No CaO added
80
0 40 80 120
Time, min
Figure 10.5 Effect of lime on the reducibility of sintered laboratory pellets at 1300C after 80%
reduction at 1000C in CO/CO2 = 9 at atmospheric pressure.
190 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
58
56
Permeability
54
52
50
48
38 40 42 44 46 48 50
RDI (3 mm), %
K.H. Peters et al. have reported extensive measurements with probes in the blast furnaces
of Thyssen, Germany. With a higher RDI in sinter, the fuel rate increases because of improper
gas flow as shown in Figure 10.7 (Peters 1990). Charging of more coke in the central part of
the furnace helps in maintaining a proper gas flow with consequent lowering of the fuel rate and
improvement in productivity.
Blast Furnace Productivity, Fuel Efficiency and Modern Developments 191
480
BF Schwelgern
470
460
450
all coke
Fuel rate, kg/thm
with coal
440
(a)
490
BF 6, Ruhrort
480
470
Figure 10.7 Influence of sinter RDI on the fuel rate in a blast furnace.
Unreduced
material
Partially reduced
material
Softening
Dripping of melt
Figure 10.8 Schematic representation of the sequence of events during softening and melting of
the burden.
Both these objectives can be achieved by fluxing the sinter or pellets by CaO. As discussed
in Section 10.3.3, CaO prevents the formation of the low-melting fayalite phase and increases
the extent of indirect reduction. This influences the quantity of slag formed in the dripping zone.
Table 10.1 contains some laboratory data that illustrate this point (Clixby 1986). Further, the
residual material left after testing consists of solid unmelted oxides and iron. The use of
superfluxed sinter (CaO/SiO2 2) results in 70% indirect reduction and 100% residual, and
hence is the best from these points of view.
6.4
Slag/metal ratio, ()
50
6.2
30
6.0
5.8 10
0 10 20 30 40 0 10 20 30 40
Amount of fine coke, wt. % 3 mm fine coke, wt. %
(a) (b)
Figure 10.9 Relationship between the amount of coke in the inactive coke zone with
(a) permeability, and (b) slag/metal ratio.
1.45
1.4
Productivity index, t/m /d
3
1.35
1.3
1.25
1.2
1.15
1.1
1.05
44 46 48 50 52 54 56 58 60 62 64
Coke CSR
Figure 10.10 Relationship between blast furnace productivity and CSR of coke.
194 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
higher coke CSR (Kumar and Mukherjee, 1991) while Figure 10.11 (Kumar and Mukherjee,
1991) illustrates the decrease in the corrected fuel rates of several blast furnaces around the
world with increasing CSR.
540
530
Inland 1981
520
510
Corrected fuel rate, kg/thm
Inland 1984-3/87
Inland 1984
500
490
NSC
480
Inland 4/33-1/89
470
BHP
460
Sumitomo
450
440
25 35 45 55 65 75
CSR
The configuration of the cohesive zone in a blast furnace has been classified into four
general shapes, viz. inverted U, inverted V, W and flat as illustrated in Figure 10.12. Among
these configurations, the inverted V-shape is preferred, since it gives a taller central coke zone,
which results in improved permeability.
W-Type Flat
Inverted U Inverted V
2 2
( rg )1/2
(vtu rg ) >C (10.5)
Gtu
where C is a constant, and Gtu = rgvtu (10.6)
Combining Eqs. (10.5) and (10.6), and simplifying, the conditions for flooding can be
written as
196 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
3
G Gtu
tu
1/2
> C , i.e, 1/2
> C1/3 (10.7)
( rg ) ( rg )
Equation (10.7) shows that the maximum mass flow velocity (i.e. mass flow rate) of gas through
the furnace is higher at a higher gas density without causing flooding. A similar conclusion can
be reached regarding the granular zone. From Section 7.3, it can be shown that G (rg)1/2 for
bed fluidisation as well. The average value of gas density is proportional to the average pressure
in the furnace. With increasing top pressure ( pt), the gas pressure for blowing at the tuyeres ( pb)
is also higher. Hence, pav = [( pt + pb)/2] is higher for HTP.
As discussed in Section 10.2, productivity can also be improved by lowering the fuel
consumption per tonne hot metal for which attainment of FeFexOgas equilibrium (i.e. faster
indirect reduction) is desirable. As has been shown in Figure 10.1, faster gas-solid heat and mass
transfer is also required. Again, increasing the gas density speeds up these steps. Therefore, it
can be theoretically predicted that both furnace productivity as well as fuel efficiency can be
improved by HTP.
As discussed in Chapter 5, Section 5.1.2, the reaction given by Eq. (5.5):
CO2(g) + C(s) = 2CO(g)
is known as the Solution Loss Reaction in blast furnace ironmaking, since it leads to loss of
carbon in the upper part of the stack. Increased pressure tends to cut down this loss and this is
another benefit of HTP. Since, along with employment of HTP, increasing use of prepared
burdens, etc. were also practised, no clear-cut data are available on the isolated benefit of HTP
on productivity and fuel efficiency.
furnace, e.g. coke can be preferentially charged at the centre or on the sides depending on the
existing gas temperature profile. As a result, most modern blast furnaces are now equipped with
bell-less tops and even the existing furnaces are likely to incorporate this facility during future
shutdowns.
Tuyere
Injection lance
L
Raceway
Blow pipe
Since the residence time of the coal particles in the tuyere zone is a few seconds only, it
has been inferred that the first three steps are very fast and require a maximum of 0.1 second.
However, the combustion of char requires 1 to 4 seconds. Unless the combustion is completed
in the tuyere zone, the fine char particles tend to block the bed voids, thereby increasing the
resistance to gas flow. This has an adverse effect on productivity and fuel efficiency. It also
enhances the solution loss reaction in the upper stack and increases the CO content of the top
gas. Further, since these fines are easy to fluidise and elutriate, the dust losses tend to increase.
Consequently, efforts are made to make sure that complete combustion of injected coal takes
place in the tuyere zone. The factors that govern combustion efficiency and the overall efficacy
of PCI are discussed below.
The particle size of the coal injected should be as small as possible. However, this
increases the grinding cost and can give rise to problems of flowability during injection.
To avoid such problems, very fine grinding is avoidedideally speaking the coal
injected should consist of a mixture of fines and some relatively coarser particles.
Figure 10.14 shows the coal pulverisation and preparation system used in the Fairfield
Works of U.S. Steel (Oshnock 1995). The size distribution is also shown in this figure
about 80% of coal is below 200 mesh (0.075 mm) in size. Coal of this size is
conveyed to the storage bin(s) by heated inert gas. The purpose of using gas heated to
above 100C (150C typically) is to remove moisture from coal. High moisture levels
affect the flowability of the coal particles. It also gives rise to endothermic reactions in
the raceway, which lowers the RAFT (see Table 6.2).
Coal receiving Bag filter
Conveyor Cyclone
Coal bin
Raw coal
Storage
(a) (b)
Figure 10.14 (a) Schematic representation of a coal pulverisation and preparation system,
(b) Size range of pulverised coal and the types of injection systems.
The hot blast temperature should be high. The rates of char gasification as well as
oxidation of the volatiles are markedly speeded-up at higher temperatures. A minimum
hot blast temperature of 1250C is recommended for high PCI rates.
200 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Coals containing high volatile matter (VM) normally also exhibit superior combustibility
owing to the fact that the char of high VM coal is more porous, and hence more reactive.
However, very high VM levels lower the carbon available, and hence there is a
maximum value of VM for PCI coals.
Ash in coal is undesirable since it increases the slag volume and affects both fuel
efficiency and productivity. High ash in PCI coal also tends to increase silicon content
in hot metal. Hence, rigorous specifications have been evolved in terms of ash, VM and
combustibility of PCI coals.
It is reported that at high rates of PCI (200 kg/thm and more), the maximum combustion
efficiency is about 7080%. This means that some unburnt char particles find their way into the
upper regions of the furnace, thereby increasing the FRC (i.e. flow resistance coefficient).
Operating data have confirmed that the FRC tends to increase with high rates of coal injection,
particularly if the coal chosen is not appropriate. In such a situation, even burden descent can
become irregular. Another important point to note is that PCI requires that the coke used in
conjunction be of the highest quality. Otherwise, the coke would tend to disintegrate since a
lower amount of coke has to support the burden. Further, with decreasing coke rate, the coke
residence time in the furnace increases, thereby calling for better quality coke. The success of
PCI also requires high-quality sinter. This has been demonstrated by blast furnace trials at
several plants all over the world, including India (Bhilai and Tata Steel).
The endothermic decomposition of the injected coal lowers the RAFT. This is compensated,
to some extent, by the increase in the blast temperature. However, since this is not always
sufficient, simultaneous oxygen enrichment of air becomes a must. For such a situation, several
models have been proposed for calculating the RAFT. The formula used by Nippon Steel, Japan,
is
tf = 1524.0 + 60RO2 + 0.84tb 2.7Rcoal 6.3Mb (10.12)
where
tf = RAFT, C
RO2 = oxygen enrichment rate, vol%
tb = blast temperature, C
Rcoal = coal injection rate, kg/thm
Mb = moisture content in blast, gN/m3
Oxygen enrichment by itself also contributes to higher productivity and lower coke rate as
shown in Figure 10.15 (Zhang and Bi, 2003).
2.5
3
2.4
2.3
2.2
2.1
2.0
1.9
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Oxygen enrichment, %
560
2.2
550
Productivity
2.0 1.0
540
Flue rate
520
1.6 0.8
510
Silicon
1.4 0.7 500
Figure 10.16 Blast furnace performance at British Steel from 1980 to 1988.
REFERENCES
Clixby, G., Ironmaking and Steelmaking, Vol. 13 (1986) 169.
Gupta, K.N., in Blast Furnace Ironmaking (Eds.) S.S. Gupta and Amit Chatterjee, Ch. 9, Tata
Steel, Jamshedpur, 1991.
Hartig, W. et al., Ironmaking Conf. Proc., ISS, Vol. 59 (2000), Pittsburgh, 316.
Kumar, A. and T. Mukherjee, in Blast Furnace Ironmaking (Eds.) S.S. Gupta and Amit
Chatterjee, p. 106, Tata Steel, Jamshedpur, 1991.
202 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
McDonald, N.D., Future of ironmaking in blast furnace, Special Report, 72, Iron and Steel Inst.,
London (1962), p. 151.
Nicolle et al., Proc. 6th Int. Iron & Steel Cong., Nagoya (1990), ISIJ, Vol. 2, p. 430.
Oshnock, T.W., Iron & Steelmaker, ISS-AIME, January 1995, p. 45.
Peters, K.H., Ironmaking Conf. Proc., Detroit, Vol. 49 (1990), ISS, pp. 277278.
Shimitzu et al., Proc. 6th Int. Iron & Steel Cong., Nagoya (1990), ISIJ, Vol. 2, p. 423.
Turkdogan, E.T., Met. Trans B, Vol. 9B (1978), p. 163.
Watanabe, S., in Agglomeration, (Ed.) W.A. Kuepper, Interscience Pub, New York (1962),
p. 865.
Zhang, S. and X. Bi, Ironmaking and Steelmaking, Vol. 30 (2003), p. 472.
11
Blast Furnace Products
and Their Utilisation
11.1 INTRODUCTION
Hot metal of optimal quality, with respect to composition and temperature, is vital for ensuring
efficient steelmaking. Attention to hot metal quality is required so that regular production of the
desired steel grades at acceptable levels of productivity becomes possible. Consequently,
steelmaking today demands hot metal at as high a temperature as possible (minimum 1300C),
with stringent chemical analysis specifications, particularly in terms of the silicon, sulphur and
phosphorus contents. This is mandatory not only for the success of BOF steelmaking, but is also
demanded by continuous casting, so that the liquid steel made can be cast at relatively high
casting speeds to yield cast products (slabs, blooms, billets) of acceptable quality.
The exact stipulation of hot metal quality varies from country to country, and even for
different plants in the same country, depending on the type of raw materials used in ironmaking,
grades of steel that have to be made, type of the final product, etc. Table 11.1 shows the typical
range of hot metal composition stipulated for blast furnaces in Japan, Europe, North America and
India. The temperature of hot metal also varies widelyfrom as low as 12801350C in India
to as high as 15001550C in Japan. The temperature of hot metal tapped from blast furnaces
depends, to a very large extent, on the actual blast furnace operating conditions, such as RAFT,
extent of PCI, slag volume, etc. The temperature of hot metal immediately prior to charging into
BOF vessels is also a function of the time taken to transport hot metal to the BOF shop, type
and capacity of the ladles used for transport, extent of hot metal pre-treatment (if any), use of
a mixer (if any) in the BOF shop, etc.
Using a larger number of holes (68 instead of 3 4) in the oxygen lance, even for
relatively small (130 150 t) BOF converters
Higher lance height
Concurrent purging of argon/nitrogen through the bottom tuyeres
Using a higher slag volume.
Slag layer
Working lining Hot metal impact area
Figure 11.2 Cross sectional view of a torpedo ladle containing hot metal (and some slag).
208 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
of heat from such ladles during this transit is fairly small. This is quite different from open-top
ladles where excessive heat loss cannot be prevented. This is one of the prime reasons why
open-top ladles were gradually discarded.
The slight loss of heat during the transit of torpedo ladles is essentially a result of conduction
through their refractory walls. However, at the melt shop when hot metal is poured from these
torpedo ladles into the open-top transfer ladles required for subsequent hot metal charging into
BOFs, considerable heat loss takes place on account of radiation. For this reason, metal and slag
tend to solidify around the mouth of torpedo ladles. Therefore, it becomes necessary to remove
the solidified slag/metal from the mouth of the torpedoes periodically. In general, 200 tonne
torpedoes can easily transfer 300,000 tonnes of hot metal before relining, while 320 tonne ladles
can transport as much as 500,000 tonnes.
predominant phase at basicities of around 1.9, while anorthite is formed when the basicity is
around 0.5. Although both these minerals are refractory in nature with melting points of about
1550C, they form a eutectic at 1380C, containing equal proportions of both these constituents.
Thus it is important to operate blast furnaces between these two extremities of basicity so that
both gehlinite and anorthite are present.
It needs to be borne in mind that in the normal range of blast furnace slag compositions,
magnesia also forms two mineralsakermanite (2CaO MgO 2SiO2) and monticellite
(CaO MgO SiO2). Akermanite is found in slags containing low amounts of alumina and
magnesia. On the other hand, if the alumina or the magnesia content of the slag is high, magnesia
combines with lime and silica to form monticellite. A study of the viscosity of blast furnace slags
reveals that acceptable viscosities are obtained with either 5% or 10% MgO in the slag, for slags
containing up to 20% alumina. However, for slags containing more than 20% alumina, MgO
exhibits a pronounced fluxing effect, so much so that the amount of MgO present must be taken
into account when estimating the slag basicity (hence the two formulae for slag basicity given
right at the beginning of this section).
downstream and upstream facilities of any steel plant for which, sometimes, the blast furnace gas
has to be mixed with richer coke oven gas. Blast furnace gas and coke oven gas can also be used
for in-plant power generation.
The typical analysis and calorific value of blast furnace gas are compared with coke oven
gas, natural gas, etc. in Table 11.2 (Ray 2005).
Table 11.2 Typical analyses and calorific values of some gaseous fuels
Blast furnace gas 3.7 26.3 0.0 0.0 57.1 12.9 0.0 3.9
Producer gas 15.0 24.7 2.3 0.0 52.2 4.8 0.2 5.8
Coke oven gas 57.0 5.9 29.7 1.1 0.7 1.5 0.0 21.5
Water gas 49.7 39.8 1.3 0.1 5.5 3.4 0.2 11.4
Oil gas 50.0 10.2 27.6 5.1 2.6 0.2 19.7
Natural gas 0.0 0.0 94.5 0.5 4.0 0.2 0.3 35.7
Clean gas
Gas for use
Dust Wet holder
catcher scrubber Demister
particles are mechanically separated by sudden expansion of the gas, accompanied by a change
in its direction of flow. Dust catchers are actually common to both wet and dry gas cleaning
plants as the first step in removing the dust. Typically, the dust removal efficiency of dust
catchers varies between 60 and 70%, i.e. for an inlet dust loading of 2025 g/Nm3, dust catchers
can reduce the dust content to 46 g/Nm3. The dust collected in the dust catchers is completely
dry and is, therefore, ideal for recycling directly to the sinter plant, where its iron content can
be utilised. The typical composition(%) of blast furnace dust is: total Fe 3032,
silica 6 7, alumina 2 3, lime 2.5 3, traces of sulphur (and sometimes zinc), and the remainder
carbon.
In the second stage of wet-type gas cleaning, generally venturi scrubbers are employed to
remove the finer dust particles using high pressure water jets. The dust content of the gas gets
reduced from 46 g/Nm3 to approximately 5 mg/Nm3. However, simultaneously, the gas
becomes saturated with water, thereby requiring a subsequent treatment in a demister to bring
the mist content down to 5 g/Nm3. Furthermore, though venturi scrubbers offer high-dust
cleaning efficiencies, they give rise to substantial pressure drops in the system. This can be
particularly disadvantageous if the gas has to be transported for power generation. Further,
during wet gas cleaning, the sensible heat of blast furnace gas is lost, and a large amount of
waste water is generated. Consequently, additional capital investment is required for water
recycling. Problems can also be encountered in recycling the sludge, particularly if the zinc
content is high.
An alternative technique that has recently come into vogue is dry gas cleaning. In dry
cleaning of blast furnace gas, bag filters or electrostatic precipitators are used. By adopting this
method, it is possible to eliminate completely the use of water, simplify the return of the dust
that is removed, and facilitate the utilisation of the sensible heat of the gas in downstream
facilities like blast furnace stoves and boilers in power plants. Another distinct advantage of the
dry system is its lower pressure drop, which allows gas from furnaces operating with high top
pressure to be directly coupled with gas turbines. In such a situation, the increased enthalpy of
the blast furnace gas as well as its higher pressure enhances power generation by almost 40%.
The choice of the gas cleaning system to be adopted remains an issue of debate among
ironmakers today, particularly since both environmental and energy conservation considerations
are involved. While most European steel plants favour the wet-type system, in recent times there
is a growing popularity of the dry-type system among the Chinese and Japanese steelmakers.
REFERENCE
Ray, H.S. et. al., Energy in Minerals and Metallurgical Industries, Allied Publishers, 2005.
12
Blast Furnace Modelling
and Control
12.1 INTRODUCTION
Increase in productivity, improvement in product quality and decrease in the cost of production
are the objectives that are common to all blast furnaces. While earlier, the skill and experience
of the operators were important in fulfilling these goals, in recent years, the art of mathematical
modelling has advanced to such an extent that it has also become an effective tool. As a result,
mathematical models have been extensively applied for better understanding and improved
process control of blast furnaces.
Amount of injectant
Vertical
Probe Measurement/phenomena explored probing
Profilometer Layer thickness across the radius at throat
Radial ore by coke ratio
Burden descent rate
Radial Multipoints
Top probe Gas flow distribution profilometer vertical probing
Vertical probe Location and shape of various isotherms
Presence of reserve zones
Behaviour of burdendecrepitation, reduction rates Gas and
T c above
Shaft upper Gas flow pattern burden
probe Shape of cohesive zone probe Gas and T c
Gas and T c manual
Shaft middle Gas flow pattern automatic
probe
probe Shape of cohesive zone probe
Stave Scaffold development and dislodging
thermometer Location of root of cohesive zone
Belly probe Layer thickness in the cohesive zone
Status of burden reduction
Gas composition and temperature
Early warning of furnace thermal level change
Tuyere coke Coke condition at tuyere
sampler Raceway depth
Core probe Deadman condition
Coal combustion behaviour
Hearth Liquid flow phenomena
thermometer Wear pattern in the hearth
Figure 12.2 Various probes used in a blast furnace (the utility of the measured parameters in
understanding the different phenomena occurring within the furnace is also included).
214 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Figure 12.3 is an illustration of these zones. The figure also lists the probes used to gather
the data required in order to undertake process analysis of each of these zones. The process
variables that play a role in defining the internal state of a blast furnace in any of these zones
include:
Temperatures of the gaseous and liquid phases
Molar fractions of CO, CO2, H2 and water vapour
Fractional reactions of the burden materials (iron oxide, limestone and coke)
Bulk density of the solids
Gas pressure.
Vertical probe
Profile meter
Ore
Layer thickness
Coke
Lumpy
zone Shaft probe Pre-heating zone
Gas flow
Indirect reduction zone
Figure 12.3 Various zones in a blast furnace and the position of the probes.
The first step is to describe the process variables in terms of differential equations. These
differential equations can be derived based on conservation principles. The important reactions
that are normally modelled include:
Indirect reduction of iron oxide by CO and H2
Solutionloss reaction
Limestone decomposition
Direct reduction of molten wustite
Water gas reaction
Water gas shift reaction.
A brief description of the various process models that have been developed so far using this
approach are presented in the next section.
Blast Furnace Modelling and Control 217
0.5
0.4
0.3
Fraction
At 3 m distance
At 2 m distance
0.2
0.1 At 1 m distance
At falling point
0
0 10 20 30 40
Particle size, mm
Figure 12.4 Predicted particle size distribution of the burden materials at four different locations in
the stockline of a blast furnace with variable throat armour.
218 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
size and the distance away from the zone of free-fall. Similarly, Figure 12.5 (Das 2006) plots
the inner and outer trajectories of the solids discharged at various chute angles from a rotating
chute bell-less top. It also contains the actually measured data that show close agreement
between the model prediction and the actual measurements.
4000
3500
Distance from furnace
3000
centre, mm
2500
2000
1500
Inner trajectory(av)
1000
Outer trajectory(av)
500
0
20 25 30 35 40
Chute angle, deg
Figure 12.5 Predicted and measured inner and outer trajectories of the solids discharged at various
chute angles from a rotating chute.
Gas flow
Erguns equation, continuity
Enthalpy balance
Temperature of gas and solid
within the stack, as well as particle size distribution, etc. are made available for inclusion in the
entire computation domain, the model can simulate the internal state of a blast furnace at any
instant of time. In addition, the reduction reactions (from magnetite to wustite and from wustite
to iron) as well as carbon gasification reaction can also be modelled. The model can be further
augmented by seamless coupling of all the associated phenomena like the flow of solids/gas/
liquids, chemical kinetics as well as heat and mass transfer.
Such a model can provide a reasonably representative chemical and thermal picture of the
furnace, with regard to the various phases present under a given set of operating conditions. The
model can be further refined using plant data and experimental data obtained from softening
melting experiments (see Chapter 9, Section 9.8.5) as inputs. A typical prediction of the steady
state temperature profiles that can be obtained once this is done, is shown in Figure 12.7 (Das,
2006). The predicted profiles appear to be reasonable, although the simulation results do not
clearly show the existence of a thermal reserve zone.
25 25
20 20
15 15
10 10
5 5
1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5
(a) Gas (a) Solids
influence on the reduction of iron oxide and its subsequent melting beyond the raceway zone.
Most of the gases in a blast furnace (CO and H2) are generated in the raceway.
The configuration of the raceway zone and the different physical processes that occur therein
can be simulated by a mathematical model. Often, one-dimensional analysis is the first step,
before the two-dimensional numerical solution of the conservation equation of mass, momentum
and heat for both the carrier phase (air) and the dispersed phase (coke) is taken up. The state-
of-the-art models of reaction kinetics of the combustion of coke and the auxiliary fuel are
considered when developing the raceway model. Commercial CFD software packages are
available to model the flow characteristics in the raceway and solve the associated differential
equations.
Based on this approach, a large variety of model predictions are available. Some typical
results that have been obtained for the predicted radial distributions of CO2, O2, CO and coke
are presented in Figure 12.8 (Das 2006).
0.25
0.14 W O2 = 0.02
0.12 0.20 W O = 0
2
Mole fraction of CO2
Mole fraction of O2
0.10
W O2 = 0.02
0.15
0.08
0.06 0.10
0.04
W O2 = 0 0.05
0.02
0.00 0.00
0.0 0.3 0.6 0.9 1.2 1.5 1.8 0.0 0.3 0.6 0.9 1.2 1.5 1.8
Length along raceway, m Length along raceway, m
(a) (b)
10
0.40 W O2 = 0.02 9
3
Coke consumption, kg/m
0.35 8 dp = 1.5 cm
Mole fraction of CO
0.30 W O2 = 0 7
0.25 6
5 dp = 2.0 cm
0.20
4
0.15
3
0.10 dp = 1.0 cm
2
0.05 1
0.00 0
0.0 0.3 0.6 0.9 1.2 1.5 1.8 0.0 0.3 0.6 0.9 1.2 1.5 1.8
Length along raceway, m Length along raceway, m
(c) (d)
(W O2 denotes the extent of oxygen enrichment of the blast; W O2 = 0 denotes no enrichment;
W O2 = 0.02 denotes 2% oxygen enrichment.)
Figure 12.8 Radial distribution of: (a) CO2, (b) oxygen, (c) CO, and (d) coke.
Blast Furnace Modelling and Control 221
6
Distance, m
4 .0
50
140
3 .
23
14
2
0
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Distance, m Centre line Distance, m
Figure 12.9 Computed temperature profile in the hearth of a blast furnace.
222 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
REFERENCE
Das, S.K., R.P. Goel, S.P. Mehrota and Maruthi Prasad, Steel Tech., Vol. 1, August 2006,
pp. 2533.
Part C
Alternative Ironmaking
Sponge Ironmaking
Smelting Reduction
13
Sponge Ironmaking
13.1 INTRODUCTION
Iron units in various forms are required for making steel. Traditionally, blast furnace hot metal
and recycled steel in the form of scrap have been the main sources of iron. However, blast
furnace hot metal production has decreased over the years owing to problems associated with
the availability of high-grade metallurgical coke. With increased efficiencies in steelmaking as
well as with the advent of continuous casting, scrap generation has also decreased. All these
factors have contributed towards the development of alternative technologies to produce iron
units. Today, processes are available to produce solid iron (Fe) in the form of sponge iron (also
referred to as Direct Reduced Iron or DRI) as well as to produce hot metal without high-grade
coke, i.e. via Smelting Reduction (SR).
The reactions and physicochemical fundamentals of ironmaking processes (including the
alternative methods) have already been discussed in Chapter 5. Hence, these are not repeated in
this chapter.
normal atmospheric temperatures, since heat gets generated along with the evolution of
hydrogen. This phenomenon is often referred to as in-situ rusting. Several passivation techniques
have been developed to retard oxidation of sponge iron in the presence of air and/or water to
prevent/reduce reoxidation during storage and shipment. However, the fact remains that DRI
always has a tendency to reoxidise. This plays a role even during subsequent melting under
reducing conditions, particularly if the rate of melting is slow. Reoxidation certainly poses
problems if sponge iron has to be pre-heated prior to charging into any high-temperature furnace,
and, therefore, pre-heated sponge iron is seldom employed in steelmaking.
Sponge iron should have a low gangue content (preferably below 45%). Otherwise,
subsequent melting would consume extra energy for melting the gangue constituents. Generally
speaking, DRI is required to have a uniform chemical composition with a narrow range of
variationboth these requirements are easily fulfilled. In gas-based DR processes, the sulphur
content is usually very low, provided the sulphur content of the oxide feed is low, whereas, in
coal-based processes, the sulphur content is higher because of the unavoidable sulphur pick-up
from coal. Tramp elements such as copper, zinc, tin, lead, arsenic, etc. are not found in DRI since
it is produced from selected raw materials. Uniformity in composition, absence of tramp
elements and the low levels of sulphur normally present, make DRI an ideal charge material for
replacing scrap in the production of high-quality steel and special grades of cast iron (like SG
iron).
Being a bulk material with a controlled size, DRI can be stored in bins, continuously
metered when discharged, and then, transported by belt conveyors for continuous charging into
any melting unit. These are the major advantages of DRI compared with other solid charge
materials like, scrap and pig iron. Handling of the latter materials is difficult, the materials are
not amenable to close control during feeding, and continuous charging is often totally ruled out.
Unlike scrap/pig iron, DRI always contains FeO. The residual FeO in DRI, as long as it is not
very high, can sometimes also be an advantage. Addition of DRI leads to CO formation when
the residual oxygen reacts with carbon present in the melt, resulting in stirring of the molten
bath.
Electrostatic
precipitator
Iron ore
Coal Cooling
system Waste gas
Limestone
Air
Rotary cooler
Screening
All rotary kiln-based DR processes operate on the countercurrent principle i.e. the gases
move in a direction opposite to the flow of solids. Various unit operations and unit processes
like transport, mixing, charge separation by size, heating, gas generation, and reduction occur
both in parallel as well as in series. Segregation of the charge materials (ore, coal, flux) on
account of size and density differences, as well as because of the slope and rotation of the kiln,
Sponge Ironmaking 229
has to be prevented to the extent possible, by adopting the appropriate kiln design and through
proper operating measures.
Another area of critical importance in rotary kiln operation is the prevention/minimisation
of localised areas of high temperature. Unless this is successfully carried out, partial melting of
coal ash takes place, leading to the formation of accretions (build-ups) on the kiln lining as well
as clusters of fused materials (in the shape of spheres/balls) within the bed. The difference
between the gas-phase temperature and the charge-bed temperature (normally about 100 150C)
has a major influence on both these phenomena.
To prevent such occurrences, the temperature of the charge bed inside the kiln has to be
confined to a maximum of around 9501050C so that the ash in coal does not fuse, and the
entire charge remains strictly in the solid state. High reactivity of coal encourages reaction of
CO2 in the gas phase with solid carbon in the bed resulting in the formation of CO. Since this
is a highly endothermic reaction, high reactivity automatically ensures that the gas temperature
does not exceed the solid bed temperature by more than the stipulated limit of 150C maximum.
A flux (like limestone or dolomite) has to be added along with coal so that CaO forms CaS by
reaction with sulphur, thereby controlling the sulphur in sponge iron.
The product discharged from the kiln is cooled to room temperature in an indirectly cooled
rotary cooler. No water normally comes in direct contact with the reduced product in the cooler
and, therefore, there is very little chance of re-oxidation. Since sponge iron is magnetic in nature,
it can be easily separated from the non-magnetic portion of the cooler discharge, consisting
mainly of coal ash (or char), by using magnetic separators.
The most critical part of rotary kiln reduction is the controlled combustion of coal and its
conversion to carbon monoxide, for which the role of the reactivity of coal has already been
highlighted. This conversion is also aided by controlled introduction of air from the discharge
end of the kiln as well as through blowers mounted on the kiln shell, which rotate with the kiln
and supply air to the secondary air pipes protruding up to the centre line of the kiln. The shell-
mounted blower and the secondary air pipe assembly, thus provide air at several locations in the
space above the charge bed, axially along the kiln length. Radial/submerged injection of air into
the charge bed through under-bed nozzles is also often resorted to in the pre-heating zone of a
rotary kiln, covering about 30% of the initial length.
A 100,000 tpa (i.e. tonnes per annum) rotary kiln (300330 tpd), which is a common size
can generate around 80,000 85,000 m3 of gas at 950 1000C, from which 7.5 MW of power
can be generated. For a 500 tpd, 150,000 tpa plant, which is the largest single kiln that is
available at present, the corresponding figures are 110,000 m3 and 10 MW. More than 70% of
the power generated becomes surplus after meeting the requirements of the entire DR plant.
Several coal-based rotary kiln processes are available, e.g. SL/RN, Codir, Accar, TDR,
DRC, Jindal, etc. all of which are similar in terms of their broad process features. The
contribution of all the different coal-based processes towards the global sponge iron production
for the year 2005/2006 was only 8.4/10.6 Mt, corresponding to 15/19.7% of the total world
production of DRI. Though globally natural gas is the preferred reductant for producing sponge
iron, because of the restricted and localised availability of natural gas in India (only off-shore
in Bombay High), coal-based rotary kiln processes are more popular in India. They
contributed as much as 5.42/7.1 Mt (54/60.2 %) out of 10.1/11.8 Mt to Indias production in
200405/2005 06. In both the years, India was the highest producer of DRI in the world; a
situation that has emerged over the last three years.
230 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Fastmet process
The Fastmet process is a solid reductant-based rotary hearth furnace (RHF) process. Successful
trials began in 1991 in a 2.5 m diameter pilot rotary hearth furnace to treat fine oxides
(particularly wastes). The Fastmet process flow sheet is shown in Figure 13.2.
Feed preparation
Gas Off gas
Pelletiser Dryer air Combustion cleaning
air system
Mixer Fan
Heat Stack
exchanger
Flue gas Dust recovery
Dryer conditioner
Briquetter Off gas treatment
Burners
Fuel gas
Product discharge Hot DRI Oil
Pulverised coal
Rotary hearth furnace
DRI cooler
Briquette m/c EIF* Caster Reduction
DRI DRI container
HBI Liquid Solid
Hot DRI fast iron fast iron
(*EIFElectric Ironmaking Furnace)
When the primary oxide feedstock is virgin iron ore, the oxide in the form of concentrate
fines along with reductant fines are pelletised, dried, and then charged to the RHF in a single
layer. In those cases where steel mill wastes are the primary feed material, the feed is often
briquetted before charging on the hearth, again in a single layer. As the hearth rotates, the pellets/
briquettes are heated to 12501400oC by combustion of gas, oil or pulverised coal. The
agglomerates containing the reductant get reduced to metallic iron. As explained in Chapter 5,
the reduction is accomplished by intimate contact between the carbon contained within the
pellets/briquettes and the iron oxide fines, at these relatively high temperatures. Since the
reduction is very rapid, the residence time of the charge on the hearth is typically as less as 6
to 12 minutes, during which 90 to 95% of the iron oxide is converted to metallic iron. The DRI
produced is continuously discharged at around 1000C from the furnace, either into refractory
lined cans for hot transfer to the melt shop, or into briquetting machines for the production of
HBI. The carbon content in the product can be controlled between 1 and as high as 6%, if
required. It becomes an ideal material for steelmaking since it is highly metallised and contains
sufficient carbon.
In April 1994, Midrex and Kobe Steel constructed a Fastmet demonstration plant at Kobe
Steels Kakogawa Works in Japan, which was designed for a production capacity of 2.22.5 tph,
using an 8.5 m diameter rotary hearth furnace. The first commercial Fastmet plant was
commissioned at the Hirohata Works of Nippon Steel in April 2000 to process around 190,000
tpa of pellets made from steel plants wastes in a 21.5 m diameter RHF. A second commercial
plant began operations in May 2001 at Kobe Steels Kakogawa Works to process 14,000 tpa of
wastes like blast furnace flue dust, BOF/EAF dust and mills scale (in the form of pellets rather
than briquettes) in an 8.5 m diameter RHF (the same as in the demonstration plant) fuelled by
waste oil.
Tails Scrubber/water
52% Fe removal
13% SiO2
Feed Reactor train 4050C
6% Al2O3
system 12 bar pressure
H2O
500
Steam 570C
reformer R4
R3 Recycle gas
R2 780
CO shift reaction 800C
CO + H2O = H 2 + CO2 R1
CO 2
Air
removal
Natural gas Reducing
CO
Natural gas heater
Shift
gas CO2
Steam (CH 4)
810830C
Reforming Briquettes
CH4 + H2O = 3H2 + CO Natural gas Air 85.7% Fe
Residual CH4, H2O 0.51.5%C
standard steam reformer. The composition of the recycle gas entering the last reactor is adjusted
in accordance with the desired carbon content of the product. The recycle gas taken from the
top gas leaving R4 is first quenched to 4050C and then scrubbed in a wet scrubber to remove
dust and water produced by the hydrogen reduction reactions. The clear recycle gas is
compressed in a centrifugal compressor before a portion is passed through a CO2 removal system
for control of the CO2 level in the reducing gas. The make-up gas required to balance the gas
consumed in the reduction reactions and as a fuel, is supplied from a conventional steam
reformer system.
The temperature in reactor R1 is maintained at around 780800C so that the final reduction
to 93% metallisation takes place. This is accompanied by carburisation of some of the Fe to iron
carbide.
Metallisation and carbide formation reactions
FeO + H2 = Fe + H2O (13.4)
FeO + CO = Fe + CO2 (13.5)
3Fe + 2CO = Fe3C + CO2 (13.6)
3Fe + H2 + CO = Fe3C + H2O (13.7)
Fe + CO + H2 = Fe(C (free)) + H2O (13.8)
3Fe2O3 + 5H2 + 2CH4 = 2Fe3C + 9H2O (13.9)
Fe3O4 + 2H2 + CH4 = Fe3C + 4H2O (13.10)
234 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Hot fine DRI at around 650C is then transported by a sealed system to a double-roll
briquetting machine for hot briquetting to HBI, having a density above 5 g/cm3. The briquettes
are subsequently air cooled on a cooling conveyor. The product from Finmet typically analyses
9293% total iron, 84 85% metallic iron, 0.81.85% carbon with a gangue content of around
3%. The product has a phosphorus content of 0.050% and sulphur content of around 0.020%
max.
Commercial Finmet plants have been designed with multiple reactor trains, each reactor train
having a nominal capacity of 500,000 tpa. The following commercial plants based on the Finmet
process have been built.
Orinoco Iron at Puerto Ordaz, Venezuela (1 Mtpa)
BHP DRI at Port Hedland, Australia (2 Mtpa; now closed)
Charging bin
Reducing
Cooling
gas
gas
source
Heater header
Reactor
1 2 3 4
first stage consists of heating and preliminary (secondary) reduction of the iron oxide that has
just been charged, using gas from the subsequent reactor where the main (primary) reduction
takes place. Once the secondary reduction is completed, the first reactor is switched to the
second stage of reduction by means of automatic valve manipulation. The bulk of the reduction
by reformed and desulphurised natural gas then begins, using gas that is richer in composition.
In the HYL process, natural gas is reformed using excess steam in the presence of a catalyst.
The steam is condensed before the reducing gas is brought to a temperature of
8701030C. This hot gas first partially reduces the reduced ore and then the fresh ore during
the secondary phase of reduction. To obtain the desired temperature in the reactor, part of the
reducing gas is burnt with air pre-heated to the same temperature as the reducing gas. When most
of the reduction is completed, the reactor is changed to the cooling and carburisation mode,
where the final stages of reduction take place along with carbon deposition on the product. The
gas used in this stage is fresh gas coming directly from the reforming unit (75% H2, 14% CO,
7% CO2 and 4% CH4).
At present, three HYL I plants (located in Venezuela, Indonesia and Iran) having 9 modules
with total plant capacities varying from 1 to 2 Mtpa, are in operation. However, being a batch
process the popularity of HYL I has continuously been on the wane. The production from HYL
I plants all over the world, which was as high as 3.04 Mt in 1994, has gradually come down
to just over 1.0 Mt in 2004. HYL I, which in its heyday in the early eighties, contributed almost
40% to global DRI production, now has less than 1% share.
Midrex process
This process was developed by Midland Ross Corporation of Cleveland, USA in 1967.
Figure 13.5 shows the basic flow sheet. The reducing gas is, as usual, generated by reforming
natural gas. In the Midrex reforming system, a proprietary nickel catalyst is used. A single
reformer is utilised instead of a reformer/heater combination and the reformed gas does not need
to be cooled before it is used in the process. Hence, there is also no need for a separate CO2
removal system. These are some of the advantages of this process, which has made it the world
leader in direct reduction.
The iron oxide feed to a Midrex shaft can be in the form of pellets or lump ore as shown
in Table 13.1 (Amit Chatterjee et al. 2001). However, generally speaking, the charge consists
of around 60% pellets and 40% lump ore of a particular type. Pellets are the preferred feedstock
owing to their superior physicochemical characteristics compared with lump ores. As a result,
236 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Flue
gas Natural gas
Cooling gas compressor
Feed gas Fuel gas
Ejector
stack Natural gas
Combustion air Direct reduced iron
Heat recovery
Table 13.1 Typical chemical composition of the oxide feed to the Midrex process
in most cases, a minimum amount of pellet usage becomes mandatory. Figure 13.6 shows the
movement of solids and gases in the shaft of a Midrex furnace.
Insulated
Gases Gases Gases
Solids
Insulated upper
reduction zone
upper
length = 2x
reduction
zone
Solids
Reducing gas
Un-insulated
cooling zone
Solids
length = 1x
Un-insulated
cooling zone
DRI
The spent reducing gas (or top gas) leaving the shaft furnace at a temperature of 400450C
is cooled and cleaned in a gas scrubber before approximately 60% of the gas is returned to the
reformer; and the rest used as a fuel. The process gas is compressed and pre-heated before
entering the reformer at around 900C, where it is mixed with make-up natural gas. The
reformed gas made up mostly of carbon monoxide and hydrogen exits from the reformer at about
850C. The ratio of H2 to CO is controlled at about 1.51.8, and the reducing quality of the gas
(CO + H2 as a proportion of CO2 + H2O) is maintained at 1112 for best operations.
The iron oxide burden is first heated to the process temperature before it is metallised by
the upward flowing, countercurrent reducing gas injected at 800870C through tuyeres located
at the bottom of the cylindrical section of the shaft. The reduced material then passes through
a transition zone before reaching the lower conical section of the furnace. Low carbon DRI (less
than 1.5% C) is directly cooled using a circulating stream of cooled exhaust gas introduced in
the conical section, before cold DRI is discharged. When higher carbon DRI (up to 4.0% C) has
to be produced, natural gas is introduced along with cooling gas into the conical section. In this
zone, natural gas readily decomposes (cracks) in the presence of highly reactive metallic DRI,
thereby generating nascent carbon, which gets absorbed in the product before it is discharged.
In both cases, the final product is DRI with 9394% metallisation, with the desired carbon
content.
A large number of Midrex plants are operating successfully all over the world. Without any
doubt, Midrex is the most widely used DR process in the world today. The actual production
in 2004/2005 was 34.4/34.96 Mt out of 54.6/56 Mt DRI produced in the world, i.e. just over 64%
in both years. Plant capacities vary from 0.35 Mtpa (minimum) with one module in many plants
to five modules in the 3.2 Mtpa at Mobarakeh Steel Plant in Iran, which is the largest Midrex
plant in the world. Essar in Hazira, Gujarat has five modules, three with a capacity of
440,000 tpa each and two modules of 0.6 and 1.8 Mtpa capacity. It is the worlds largest
gas-based merchant HBI plant.
Iron ore
H2O
Gas heater
Fuel Reactor
CO2
Natural gas
Reformer
H2O
Fuel
Water Natural gas
DRI
The upper zone of the furnace is fed with hot reducing gases from a heater, which receives
cooled, scrubbed reducing gas from the top of the reactor, along with fresh make-up reducing
gas from the natural gas reformer. The cooling zone in the lower part of the reactor is supplied
with cooling gas, which is recycled by means of a gas compressor. Suitable cooling gas is fed
as make-up in this recycle stream. After cooling, the DRI is discharged through a sealing
mechanism, similar to the one at the feed end of the reactor.
Some of the distinctive features of the HYL III process are given below.
Natural gas reforming is carried out using only steam in the presence of a catalyst.
To maintain the highest possible temperature for reduction, a combustion chamber is
incorporated in the reducing gas inlet to the reactor. Partial combustion of natural gas
also improves the carburising efficiency of the gases, and makes it possible to achieve
reduction temperatures in excess of 900C. This also enables HYL III units to produce
high carbon containing DRI.
The reducing zone in the upper part of the shaft furnace is separated from the cooling/
carburisation zone in the lower part by an isobaric zone, which prevents the gases from
mixing in the cooling and reducing zones. This helps in independent control of
metallisation and carbon content of sponge iron. Accordingly, it is possible to produce
DRI (or HBI) with different carbon levels to meet the specific demands of steelmakers.
This has given rise to the concept of equivalent metallisation (actual metallisation + five
times the carbon content in DRI), since the carbon content of DRI has a strong influence
on its melting behaviour during steelmaking.
High pressure (4 atmospheres or more) operation allows the equipment size in the gas
handling plant to be reduced. It also lowers the energy requirements.
The reforming section is independent of the reduction section, thus allowing the reformer
to operate stably and maintaining the appropriate operating conditions reliably over long
periods.
Sponge Ironmaking 239
The process gas is not recycled through the reformer resulting in longer life of the
catalyst. As a result, high sulphur inputs can be tolerated, without any deleterious effect
on the equipment, or on the quality of DRI, without having to utilise a bypass route.
The energy consumption in the HYL III process varies between 9.0 and 10.0 GJ/tonne of
DRI. HYL III plants are available in capacities between 0.25 and 2.0 Mtpa. Eighteen modules,
in at least 1012 plants all over the world, with a total capacity of around 11 Mtpa are now in
operation. In 2004/2005, just over 11.0/11.1 Mt of DRI/HBI was produced in these plants. As
far as India is concerned, the worlds largest HYL III module, with a capacity of 0.9 Mtpa of
HBI, was installed at Raigarh in Maharashtra in 1993 by Grasim.
PSA
NG
Humidifier
NG
Fuel Oxygen
DRI
Both the reducing and the reforming reactions take place inside the reactor. The reacted exit
gas leaves the top of the reactor. Steam is condensed and is removed before the gas is
compressed and sent for CO2 removal, after which, it is mixed with natural gas, thereby closing
the circuit. Figure 13.8 also shows an optional cooling circuit, if the product has to be cold
discharged. In the latter case, the natural gas is split between the reduction and the cooling
sections. The cooling circuit consists of a compressor and a quenching system to maintain a
closed circuit with make-up natural gas to cool the DRI down to 45C. The reducing gas entering
the reactor contains controlled concentrations of H2O and CO2, and when it comes in contact
with metallic iron which acts as catalyst, some reforming of methane takes place. The reactions
consume oxidants and produce reducing agents, which react with the remaining iron oxides and
produce more oxidants.
The HYL IV M process employs a moving-bed shaft furnace (similar to HYL III) to reduce
iron ore pellets and lump ore at normal reduction temperatures, but at intermediate reduction
pressures. The process can produce cold/hot DRI as well as HBI. The first HYL IV M plant
began production in April 1998 in Monterrey, Mexico; hence the suffix M. This IV M plant has
a capacity of 675,000 tpa, and consists of only three (rather than four) main unitsthe reduction
system, the DRI handling system and the external cooling system (i.e. no reforming section).
Midrex has also adopted self-reforming in some of their existing plants.
REFERENCE
Chatterjee, Amit, Ramesh Singh and Banshidhar Pandey, Metallics for SteelmakingProduction
and Use, Allied Publishers, 2001.
14
Smelting Reduction
14.1 INTRODUCTION
Until recently, blast furnaces were the only source of hot metal on a bulk scale. However, with
the world witnessing a gradual shift from integrated steel plants using the Blast FurnaceBOF
combination to a multiplicity of smaller mini-mills essentially based on electric arc furnaces,
alternative means of producing hot metal using Smelting Reduction (SR) have come into
existence. The raison dtre of smelting reduction is to produce liquid hot metal, i.e. a product
similar to blast furnace hot metal, by reducing iron oxide feeds (preferably those not acceptable
for traditional blast furnace ironmaking, for both physical and chemical reasons) using coal,
oxygen and/or electrical energy.
To fulfil these requirements, several SR processes have been suggested. All of them aim to
produce hot metal, without using either coke or high-grade iron oxide as the feedstock. However,
it needs to be stressed that only a very few of the SR processes that have been conceptualised
till date, have reached commercial scale. This has happened despite the fact that these new
processes are one-generation ahead of classical blast furnaces, in terms of their intrinsic process
versatility as well as superior environmental friendliness. Even in future, it remains to be seen
whether many of the SR processes presently under development, can go past the rigours of pilot
plant trials before getting commercialised.
241
242 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Table 14.1 Raw materials used in blast furnaces and in smelting reduction
feedstock and non-coking coal, and use carbon-bearing fines as well as other relatively
inexpensive carbon/hydrogen containing materials as the reductant(s). Oxygen and electricity are
used as required. The ultimate goal is to exclude coke to the maximum possible extent, if not,
eliminate it completely.
A forecast of the technologies to be adopted for hot metal production in the foreseeable
future is shown in Figure 14.1 (Amit Chatterjee et al. 2001). It may be noted that while it is
expected that SR technologies would find increasing applications in future, the traditional blast
furnace ironmaking is likely to maintain its dominance even after a century from now.
100%
Figure 14.1 Forecast of the technologies to be adopted for hot metal production.
Off-gas
Post combustion
Final reduction
Smelting reduction Coal
vessel
Melting
Oxygen/air
to varying extents in stage one, followed by the removal of the remaining oxygen via liquid
phase reduction reactions in stage two. Sometimes, the latter is completed in two steps rather
than one, i.e. SR then becomes a three-stage operation.
The initial reduction of iron oxide begins in the temperature range of 850C to 1050C. The
basic reactions involved are as follows:
3Fe2O3 + CO = 2Fe3O4 + CO2 (14.1)
Fe3O4 + CO = 3FeO + CO2 (14.2)
FeO + CO = Fe + CO2 (14.3)
The carbon monoxide required for reduction, is generated by the well-known Boudard reaction:
C + CO2 = 2CO (14.4)
Up to this stage, SR is similar to solid-state DR. Beyond solid-state reduction of haematite/
magnetite to wustite, smelting reduction, essentially involves reduction of molten FeO by CO.
This gives rise to far higher transport rates owing to convection, and a remarkable increase in
the conversion rate because of enlargement in the specific phase contact area. The latter is a
direct consequence of the dispersed nature of the phases. These two major advantages of SR
accrue because of the formation of liquid phases, which does not happen in DR.
From studies on the oxidation and reduction behaviour of pure molten iron oxide by CO/
CO2 mixtures at 1500C, it has been concluded that the rate controlling step for both oxidation
and reduction is the inter-diffusion of iron and oxygen atoms within the melt. It has also been
found that mass transport plays an important role in the reduction kinetics. The overall reaction
rate is proportional to the square root of the gas flow rate. Therefore, all out efforts are made
to increase the amount of gas that is available for reduction.
To generate sufficient amount of reducing gas, all SR processes consume fairly large
quantities of reductant (normally coal). Having generated the large volume of gas that is
required, its effective utilisation becomes extremely important. However, this gives rise to one
of the inherent deficiencies of SR, i.e. with most SR reactor configurations given the productivity
244 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
requirements, the entire gas cannot be fully utilised in the process, and rich gas at a high
temperature leaves the SR reactor. It is for this reason that the use of the export gas in any SR
process has a marked influence on the cost of the hot metal made. In fact, in many cases, unless
the net export gas from the SR reactor is gainfully utilised, ironmaking itself becomes totally
uneconomical. Without sufficient credit for the off-gas, the cost of hot metal made by smelting
reduction can be as much as 4050% higher than that of blast furnace hot metal, despite starting
with less expensive and inferior grade raw materials. The reverse is the case if adequate credit
can be obtained from the utilisation of the off-gases. The most convenient way to utilise the exit
gas is to cogenerate electrical power. Alternatively, the exit gas can be fed to a shaft furnace
direct reduction unit, located adjacent to the smelting reduction reactor.
14.4.3 Commercialisation of SR
The first SR process that was suggested after this re-awakening was INRED (Intensive
Reduction). Work on this process began in Sweden in 1972. INRED was a novel concept of
producing hot metal of blast furnace quality at a very rapid rate. The process was tried out in
Smelting Reduction 245
a 60,000 tpa demonstration plant set up at Mefos, Lulea, Sweden. In the INRED process, the
two-stages of reductionthe first stage reduction of iron oxide to FeO, followed by the second
stage comprising final reduction of FeO to Fewere performed in a single reactor. The ore
concentrate (in fine form) was pre-reduced to wustite by flash smelting using coal along with
a large amount of oxygen. This step consumed about 90% of the total process energy. Final
reduction was carried out in an electrically-heated furnace that formed the lower part of the
reactor, in which the balance of the required energy was supplied in the form of electricity.
The products from the INRED furnace were hot metal, slag, and waste gas. The waste gas
was relatively small in volume owing to the extensive usage of oxygen. The exit gas was
completely burnt to produce steam that was used to drive a steam turbine generator for producing
electrical energy required for the oxygen plant, the electric furnace, and other auxiliaries.
Despite considerable global interest in this technology in the early years (Indian raw
materials were also tested at Mefos at considerable cost), it was finally not found to be ready
for commercial exploitation. The pilot plant work showed that precise control of a rapid process
like flash smelting was virtually impossible. Further, development was abandoned in the late
1970s. However, it needs to be emphasised that many of the features of INRED, such as the use
of fine ore, non-coking coal, oxygen, quick reaction time, ability to stop and start at short notice,
use of the export gas for power generation, etc. became an integral part of all subsequent SR
developments.
INRED was followed by ELRED, another Swedish development. The only major difference
was that pre-reduction was carried out under pressure in a circulating fluidised bed. The ELRED
process was also abandoned later, for more or less the same reasons as INRED.
Many SR processes have since been suggested and tried, but only 34 have reached
commercial scale. This clearly shows that SR involving high temperature liquid iron oxide
reduction by CO gas is not always easy to control, at least in reactors other than the blast furnace.
Hind sight clearly shows what a versatile process the blast furnace actually is, although it was
developed centuries ago. Usage of high-quality coke and iron oxide are, of course, the major
deficiencies of blast furnaces, which triggered the development of SR.
Single-stage processes
This group of processes, in which both reduction and smelting take place in the same reactor,
is the simplest. A schematic flow sheet of the single-stage process concept is given in
Figure 14.3(a). Since the reactor is fed with wet iron ore without any pre-reduction, the energy
requirement in these processes is higher. The total energy is supplied by the combustion of coal
in the presence of oxygen. It is also necessary to ensure that the degree of post-combustion of
246 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Ore Gas
Reduction
the reducing gas leaving the bath is also high (about 70%). Obviously, the oxygen and coal
requirements in these processes are high on account of the limited opportunity to utilise the
reducing gas. Consequently, single-stage SR processes are often inefficient and economically
unattractive, unless adequate credits are obtained from the large amount of high value (high
temperature and high reduction potential) off-gases produced. Proper control of the foamy slag
produced in the reactor and erosion of the reactor refractories are the two other problems
associated with single-stage processes. On the other hand, the main advantages are low capital
cost, use of ore and coal without any pre-treatment, and the ability to accept low-grade ore and
coal.
The only single-stage SR process on which considerable demonstration scale work has been
carried out is Romelt. However, the development work has now been suspended, and thus the
future of this process is uncertain.
Two-stage processes
The concept involves two separate reactorsone for pre-reduction and a second for smelting
reduction as depicted in Figure 14.3(b). The off-gases from the smelting stage are utilised for
pre-reduction, thereby reducing the energy requirement for final reduction and melting.
However, this automatically means that for any two-stage process to work efficiently, it is
necessary to ensure a close match between these two independent operations.
Depending upon the degree of pre-reduction and post-combustion, such processes can be
further classified into two subgroups. The first group consists of processes showing a high
degree of pre-reduction and a very low degree of post-combustion. Processes like Corex belong
to this group. In such processes, smelting has to be controlled by partial combustion of coal in
such a way that the composition and the amount of the off-gases generated are just sufficient to
meet the requirements of producing highly-metallised DRI in the preceding step. Such a
stipulation automatically demands careful selection of coal.
Smelting Reduction 247
The second subgroup contains those two-stage processes that are based on a low degree of
pre-reduction and a high degree of post-combustion. They are superior to the first subgroup
insofar as making use of the degree of metallisation as a control parameter for guaranteeing
balanced operation between the two process stages. The net result is that such processes can
operate in a self-balancing manneras the metallisation decreases, the extent of reduction in the
smelter increases, thereby generating more off-gases for pre-reduction.
Processes like Hismelt, Dios, AISI, etc. belong to this category.
The efficiency of two-stage processes can be improved by separating the gas reaction zone
from the smelting zone. Heat loss in a normal two-stage process occurs because the melter off-
gas has to be cooled from around 1600C to 800C (representing an energy loss of 1.8 GJ/thm)
before it can be used for reduction. However, if carbon is present in the gas reaction zone, it can
help in reducing the temperature of the melter off-gases, without loss of energy because of the
following endothermic reactions:
C + CO2 = 2CO (14.5)
H2O + C = H2 + CO (14.6)
It is obvious that for these reactions to occur, the gas must contain an oxidised species (like
carbon dioxide). The thermodynamics of the carbonoxygen system is such that below 1000C,
the equilibrium gas mixture in contact with carbon, contains increasing quantities of CO2 with
decreasing temperature; for example, it contains 5% CO2 at 900C and 15% CO2 at 800C. The
incorporation of this step can help in controlling the gas temperature to that required for gaseous
direct reduction, thereby resulting in minimum energy losses. This has so far been incorporated
in some SR processes and as a result, the energy consumption in SR processes varies compared
with that in blast furnaces (Figure 14.4).
Gas credit
Net energy
35
30
25
Energy, GJ/thm
20
15
10
0
Fastmelt HiSmelt Corex Redsmelt Blast Furnace
Figure 14.4 Net energy consumption and gas credit in smelting reduction processes vis--vis
those in blast furnaces.
248 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Table 14.2 Smelting reduction processes classified in terms of the type of furnace utilised
Process Classification
Corex (earlier KR) BOF
Finex BOF
Hismelt BOF
AISI Direct Steelmaking BOF
Dios BOF
Ausmelt OH
Romelt (earlier FLPR) OH
Combismelt BOF
Coin BOF
Sumitomo SC BFH
Hoogovens BOF
BSC Continuous Melter BOF
Plasmasmelt BFH
INRED EAF
ELRED EAF
Pirogas BFE
IDI BOF
Kawasaki SR BFH
CIG BOF
Tecnored BFH
IT Mark 3 BFH
BSC Oxy-Coal BFE
Kobe BOF
injected into the bed and the heat liberated is used to smelt DRI (or pre-reduced ore) produced
in a separate reactor, using the smelter off-gases. The processes in this category, therefore, aim
at partially utilising the principles of a blast furnace, while minimising the consumption of coke.
For instance, the Sumitomo SC process, which is based on this concept, needs a coke input of
about 3040% of the total fuel requirement. The Kawasaki SR process is similar. The Corex
process may also be included in this category, with the difference that it uitilises a very high
degree of pre-reduction (above 90%), unlike the other processes mentioned in this group.
Table 14.3 Details of important smelting reduction processes developed till date
Corex Korf Stahl, Germany Pre-reduction in shaft furnace The first SR process to
and Voest Alpine, followed by melting in melter- be commercialised.
Austria gasifier. Commercial plants now
operating in India, South
Africa, South Korea.
Romelt Moscow Alloy and Only example of single reactor, 0.3 Mtpa demonstration
Steel Institute, single-stage process. plant at Novolipetsk Steel
Russia Works operated for many
years beginning 1986.
Now closed. Commercial
plants (1000 tpd) planned
in many places (including
India) but not constructed.
AISI American Iron and Pre-reduction (up to FeO stage) Trials with cold pre-
Steel Institute, USA in shaft furnace followed by reduced FeO pellets
in collaboration with molten iron bath reactor. conducted in a 120 tpd
HYL, Mexico. pilot plant near Pittsburgh,
USA. Now abandoned.
Dios Japanese national Fluidised bed pre-heating and 500 tpd plant was to be
project involving 8 pre-reduction in converter type installed at Keihin Works
steelmaking vessel. of Nippon Steel, Japan but
companies. later given up.
Hismelt Klockner, Germany; Pre-reduction up to FeO stage 0.1 Mtpa demonstration
CRA, Australia and in circulating fluidised bed plant operated successfully
Midrex, USA were followed by melter-gasifier. at Kwinana, Australia led to
originally involved. installation of a commercial
Now RTZ, Australia. plant at the same site
(capacity 0.8 Mtpa).
ELRED Stora Kopperberg Fluidised bed pre-reduction and Pilot plant trials conducted
and Asea, Sweden. smelting in DC arc furnace. for pre-reduction. No
further development.
INRED Boliden, Sweden Partial reduction by flash 8 tpd pilot plant trials
smelting followed by final conducted at Mefos,
reduction and melting in EAF. Sweden with various
inputs (including from
India). Later abandoned.
Combismelt Lurgi and Pre-reduction in coal fired 0.3 Mtpa plant operating
Mannesmann rotary kiln and then smelting in in New Zealand.
Demag, Germany submerged arc furnace (SAF).
Plasmasmelt SKF Steel, Sweden Pre-reduction in fluidised bed or 50,000 tpa plant installed
shaft furnace followed by in 1981 by SKF Steel at
plasma smelting. Hofors, Sweden.
(Contd.)
Smelting Reduction 251
Table 14.3 Details of important smelting reduction processes developed till date (Contd.)
plant. It should be noted that the use of the export gas, accomplished in three totally different
ways in the three commercial plants, is part-and-parcel of hot metal production using this
process. The reasons for the same have already been elaborated (Section 14.3).
It has also been mentioned in Section 14.1 that SR processes aim to use fine ore and non-
coking coal along with oxygen, so that quick reaction rates can be achieved in a reactor(s) that
can be stopped and started as and when required. As far as the Corex process is concerned, it
fulfils these objectives except that the iron oxide feed is a mixture of pellets (620 mm) and
closely-sized and carefully-screened lump ore (630 mm). Some of the other unique features of
this process are as follows:
The process is designed to operate at a pressure of up to 5 bars.
The process can accept high alkali containing ores without any build-up inside the
reactor.
The specific melting capacity is very highat least twice that of blast furnaces so that
productivities of the order of 3.03.5 t/m3/d can be achieved.
As in a blast furnace, almost 100% of the phosphorus input reports to hot metal, thereby
restricting the maximum phosphorus content acceptable in the oxide feed.
The flow sheet of the Corex process is given in Figure 14.5. Reduction of iron ore and
subsequent melting take place in two separate reactors, viz. (i) the reduction furnace and (ii) the
melter-gasifier. The process utilises essentially the same quality of iron-bearing raw materials as
a blast furnace. However, as far as the reductant is concerned, coke is largely replaced by coal.
Ore
Screw conveyor
Cooling gas
scrubber
Cooling
gas
Screw conveyor fan
cyclone
Dust
O2 Transport gas
Hot metal/slag O2 compressor Clarifier
Sludge
Water
Figure 14.5 Basic flow sheet of the Corex process.
Smelting Reduction 253
In the reduction shaft, iron oxide is reduced to sponge iron by the countercurrent flow of
reducing gas generated in the melter-gasifier. The hot sponge iron produced is directly
discharged into the melter-gasifier, for further heating and melting. Liquid iron at a temperature
of 14001500C and slag are the final products.
Coal (650 mm in size with 50% above 10 mm) is charged into the gasifier section of the
melter-gasifier, where it comes in immediate contact with hot reducing gases (at approximately
900 to 1300C) and gets dried and devolatilised. The Corex process requires 500700 kg fixed
carbon per tonne of hot metal to be supplied through coal, in order to generate the large amount
of gas/heat required by the process (reasons for the same have been given in Section 14.3).
Around 600 to 800 Nm3 of oxygen per tonne of hot metal is also required to oxidise the fixed
carbon to carbon dioxide and carbon monoxide. The velocity of the gases flowing in the lower
part of the gasifier has to be adjusted in such a way that stable fluidised bed conditions are
maintained at a temperature of 1500 1800C.
Under these conditions, optimum transfer of heat plays a crucial role in determining the
overall process efficiency. An important parameter is known as the post combustion ratio (PCR),
which is the volumetric ratio of (CO2 + H2)/(CO2 + H2O + CO + H2) in the exit gas from the
melter-gasifier. For the process to be energy efficient, it is essential to optimise the partial
combustion of CO and H2 generated in the melter, by the injection of oxygen above the bath,
at the rate required to yield the desired degree of pre-reduction (PRD). In any Corex unit, the
gas from the melter-gasifier predominantly contains CO and H2, with very little or no post-
combustion. Under these conditions, high PRD is possible provided the appropriate conditions
are maintained. Use of oxygen in the melter, generates sufficient volume of combustion products
as well as heat. This provides the conditions required to melt the DRI produced in the upstream
reduction unit, which in turn, calls for high heat transfer efficiency (HTE).
The reducing gas exiting from the melter-gasifier in the Corex process contains about 85%
carbon monoxide. The gas is cooled to 800900C, dedusted in a hot dust cyclone, and then,
introduced into the reduction shaft for pre-reducing the oxide feed. Limestone, dolomite, and
silica sand are used as additives for adjusting the basicity of the slag, depending on the ore
chemistry and the analysis of the coal ash.
Experience has proven that the Corex process can accept various types of oxides, but a
minimum amount of pellets is required for efficient operation (60% as per the experience of
JSW). Further, JSW has been found that all-coal operation is normally not possible, and at least
1015% of coke is required as the reductant along with non-coking coalthe typical
consumption figures are: 120150 kg/thm coke plus 800 kg/thm coal. When a minimum quantity
of pellets and coke are required in the Corex process, there is all the more reason that unless
the export gas (extent of generation: 1650 Nm3/thm; calorific value: 7500 kJ/Nm3) is profitably
utilised, the cost of hot metal production cannot compare with that of the blast furnace hot metal.
Thus, in order to make operations economical, the installation of a power plant or a direct
reduction shaft along with the Corex facilities becomes a must. This makes the total cost of a
complete Corex plant plus auxiliaries fairly high. A capacity of 20003000 tpd of hot metal is
at present the optimum size of any individual Corex unit (a 3000 tpd unit is being installed by
Baosteel in China). Considering the necessity of a large oxygen plant, a power plant or a DRI
shaft furnace, the total capital cost can, in many cases, become prohibitive. This may have
contributed towards JSW Steels decision to augment hot metal production using blast furnaces,
although the two Corex units in JSW have been setting international benchmarks. Essar has
254 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
recently purchased the Hanbo (Korea) Corex units. The Corex units produced as much as
700,000 to 800,000 tonnes of hot metal in 20042005. The increase in hot metal production in
JSW Steel since 1999 using the Corex modules in the initial years followed by the installation
of two blast furnaces is illustrated in Figure 14.6.
4.5
BF I
4 Corex II commissioning,
3.5 commissioning, Aug. 2004
Production, Mtpa
April. 1999
3
Corex I
2.5 commissioning,
2 Aug. 1999
1.5 BF II
1 commissioning,
Aug. 2006
0.5
0
1999 2001 2003 2005 2007
Year
Blended fines
Recycled SRV Sludge 7.8% water
20.0% water Steam
LV PCI type coal 146.4 t/h feed drum
4.9 t/h feed
8.0% water 135.0 t/h dry basis
3.9 t/h dry basis
70.0 t/h feed CO gas To power station/boiler
Fuel gas
Coal mill Ore dryer 151.2 kNm3/h AVG
SRV fuel gas
Dried feed 65.7 t/h Dried feed 30C
140.4 t/h 1000C 0.10 bar g
Water content 2.0% 2.83 MJ/Nm3
Water content
Lime 4.4 t/h 1.0% Gas SRV sludge 18.5% CO
direct to (dry basis) 24.1% CO2
Calcined dolomite 2.0 t/h scrubber 4.64 t/h total make 4.4% H 2
0.70 t/h to disposal 3.9% H 2O
Hood cooling 49.0% N2
51.3 MW to 0.0% CH 4
MP steam 939 ppm H 2S
48 ppm SO2
5.0 g/Nm3 Mist
Conveying gas
13.8 kNm3/h Hot blast
140 kNm3/h
1200C
35.0% O2
SRV hearth ID SRV offgas
6.0 m 224 kNm3/h
SRV Pressure 1450C
0.80 (bar g) 59.1% PC
4.5 t/h dust Hot blast
stoves
28C
Slag Tap metal 325C
21.8 t/h 90.9 t/h
1450C 1450C
CO gas Stoves air
5.0% FeO 4.0% C
70.7 kNm3/h AVG
1.25 B2 0.144% S
0.032% P Process air
0.81 B4 113 kNm3/h Oxygen plant
0.000% Si
8.0% MgO 0.018% Mn Drive: Steam 887 tonne/day
5.0% Prills 30.1 t/h
Main blower: steam 47.2 t/h ZLPO
Figure 14.7 Flow sheet of the Hismelt process, along with consumption figures (0.6 Mtpa unit).
dissolved in the bath itself. For this reason, the export gas from Hismelt is not as rich as it is
in the Corex process. Whatever gas is generated can, if necessary, be used to pre-heat the feed
in a fluidised bed reactor. Furthermore, pure oxygen is not required, and air, or oxygen-enriched
air (containing 30% oxygen) is used. Hismelt has also claimed that it is a green technology since
reduction in emissions of CO2 by at least 20%, SOx by 90% and NOx by 40% over the blast
furnace process is possible.
Perhaps the most noteworthy feature of the Hismelt process is that, amongst all the SR
processes, it is the most akin, in many ways, to the blast furnace, e.g. in the pre-heating of the
blast in hot blast stoves, etc. It has some unique advantages in terms of the composition of hot
metal made. Hismelt hot metal contains no silicon whatsoever. Further, partition of 90 95% of
the input phosphorus into the slag is possible, thereby allowing low phosphorus metal to be
produced even from high phosphorus ore fines. In addition, it uses iron ore fines rather than
lump ore/agglomerates, and 100% coal (no coke).
256 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Taking all these features into account, Hismelt appears to be a highly-promising SR process
for making 20003000 tpd of hot metal, both in green field mini-steel plants as well as in
existing integrated plants. The capital cost per unit capacity, however, may still stand in the way
of widespread application of this technology.
The Romelt process is based on a relatively simple concept. It is also likely to be extremely
environment-friendly, since it operates under a slight negative pressure (2 mm water column).
However, the process also has a few intrinsic weaknesses because it is a single-stage process
it uses large amounts of coal (10201050 kg/thm for coal with 20 25% ash, and as much as
1300 kg/thm for 30% ash coal) as well as oxygen (1060 1080 Nm3/thm). The process generates
very high value, rich exit gas (volume: 2800 Nm3/thm; calorific value: 7100 kJ/Nm3) at an exit
temperature as high as 1600C. This large amount of gas, with appreciable sensible and chemical
heat content, has to be utilised effectively (e.g. for power generation to meet the demand of the
oxygen plant), for hot metal production by this process to be economical.
Though several attempts have been made (including in India), no commercial Romelt plant
is operating anywhere in the world today. This may perhaps be a result of the large coal and
oxygen consumption, as well as problems in controlling a process in which all the reactions
occur simultaneously in a single-stage reactor.
Smelting Reduction 257
Non-coking coal
R1
R2
R3 Coal briquette
press
HCI
R4
CO2 Power
removal plant
Fluidised bed
reactors
Hot briquetting
press Melter-gasifier
Hot metal
Oxygen
plant
Gas recycling
The discharge from R1 is in the form of fines and before charging to the melter-gasifier of
the Finex unit, this material is compacted in a hot briquetting press to make hot compacted iron
(HCI). This step of agglomeration is necessary to ensure permeability of the bed in the Corex
melter-gasifier. Fine non-coking coal is also briquetted before it is fed to the melter-gasifier of
the Finex process where it is gasified with oxygen. This gas is used to reduce the fine ore
particles in the reactors preceding the melter-gasifier. The hot compacted iron charged in the
melter-gasifier is further reduced to 100% metallic iron, melted, carburised to hot metal, and the
impurities removed in the form of slag. By introducing a step of agglomeration of the DRI, one
of the limitations of Corex, i.e. inability to accept either ore fines/coal fines is completely
circumvented. Further, using the Finex configuration, it is possible to get around another intrinsic
limitation in the Corex process, which is that the residence times in the melter-gasifier and the
reduction shaft are necessarily closely interdependent.
In order to test the Finex concept, Posco installed a 0.2 Mtpa demonstration plant in 1997.
A number of trials were carried out during which the process was debugged. During the trials,
the coal consumption, which was initially 1050 kg/thm, was gradually reduced to 890 kg/thm.
Very importantly (unlike Corex), no coke was found to be necessary for ensuring the
permeability of the bed in the lower regions of the melter-gasifier. The hot metal composition
obtained was: C 4.34.5%, Si 0.80.9% and S 0.0170.020%.
Successful operation of the demonstration Finex unit encouraged Posco to install a
commercial plant of 1.5 Mtpa, which has become operational in December 2006, marking the
commercialisation of yet another SR process.
14.6.6 ITmk3
One way of not encountering problems with refractories in any electric ironmaking furnace, used
for melting FeO containing pre-reduced material with high gangue contents, is to separate the
gangue prior to melting. This is the concept used in ITmk3. Kobe Steel, who developed this
process, views ITmk3 as a third generation ironmaking technology: Mark 1, the first generation,
being blast furnace ironmaking; gas-based direct reduction being Mark 2.
In this new ironmaking technology, iron of similar quality as blast furnace hot metal is the
end product from a reactor charged with iron oxide and a solid reductant, but the iron is in the
form of solid nuggets. In the ITmk3 process (flow sheet shown in Figure 14.10) green composite
pellets of fine ore and pulverised coal are charged into a rotary hearth furnace (RHF) where they
are heated to a temperature ranging between 1350C and 1500C. The temperature range is
much higher than in other RHF-based processes (like Fastmet). The residence time continues to
be very short (like in Fastmet) owing to the fast rate of reduction of the composite orecoal
pellets.
Oxide, reductant
and binder Flue gas
hoppers Air fan
Flue gas
Dryer conditioner
Slag
Slag
Rotary hearth
separator
furnace
Shot iron
Because of the higher temperature, the composite pellets not only get reduced to iron
rapidly, but they become partially molten. This enables iron to get cleanly separated from the
liquid slag formed within the pellets, which oozes to surface of the nuggets (cluster of pellets).
The slag can then be separated to leave behind the ITmk3 iron nuggets containing 9698% iron,
2.5 4.5% carbon, 0.2% silicon, 0.1% manganese and 0.0500.060% each of sulphur and
phosphorus. These nuggets can be directly fed into an EAF or BOF for steelmaking.
The ingenious method of removing gangue from low-grade ores and the use of composite
pellets made from iron ore fines and coal fines are the two distinctive features of the ITmk3
process. Some of the other unique features of ITmk3 are given below.
The one-step process produces iron nuggets in a very short timereduction, melting,
and slag removal are completed in only about 10 minutes.
260 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
The process is flexible as far as the type of iron ore that can be used. Magnetite,
haematite as well as pellets made of taconite (low-grade iron ore found in the USA) have
been processed.
The process emits at least 20% less carbon dioxide than that emitted by blast furnaces.
Further, since ITmk3 does not require either coke ovens or sintering plants, there would
be less NOx, SOx and particulate matter emissions.
If the ITmk3 facility is located within a steel plant, iron nuggets can be fed in the hot
condition, directly into an EAF or BOF, thereby contributing to improved productivity
and superior energy efficiency.
Work on this process began in 1986 and a pilot plant scale RHF of 4 metre diameter with
a production capacity of 3000 tpa was built at Kobe Steels Kakogawa Works in Japan. In March
2002, Kobe Steel, along with some partners, began operations of a demonstration plant with an
annual capacity of 25,000 tonnes in Silver Bay, USA. The first lot of nuggets from this unit that
were melted in the EAF shop of Steel Dyanmics in Butler, USA, produced encouraging results.
Based on the success achieved, Steel Dynamics and its partners have recently decided to
build two commercial ITMark3 plants (one in Indiana and another in Minnesota, USA) each of
0.5 Mtpa capacity to produce pellet-sized iron nuggets (scheduled by 2006). This would herald
the commercialisation of another two-step SR process.
Cold blast
Solid fuels
Hot blast
Slag
Metal
The process consists of pelletising iron ore fines (below 140 mesh) and coke fines (below
200 mesh) along with a flux like hydrated lime (below 140 mesh) using cement as the binder.
The pellets are cured and dried at 200C, before they are fed to the top of the FAR furnace, the
internal pressure of which is maintained at about 3.5 to 5.2 psig. The total residence time of the
charge in the furnace is 30 to 40 minutes, compared with 6 to 8 hours in blast furnaces. This
is possible because of the intimate mixing of ore and reductant fines during pellet making. Lump
coke (3060 mm in size, containing upto 30% ash and 25% VM) is fed in the furnace below
the hot pellet area, using side feeders. A blast of hot air at about 1150C is blown through
tuyeres located at the periphery of the furnace, to allow the combustion of coke. Cold blast air
is also blown in a region higher in the furnace, to promote post combustion of CO in the upper
shaft. The specific consumption figures (per tonne of hot metal) are: 250 kg coal and 310 kg
coke to produce hot metal containing carbon 3.0 4.5% and silicon 0.21.0%, at a temperature
of 1380 1430C.
The Tecnored process appears to be flexible with regard to the type of iron- and carbon-
bearing raw-materials that it can process. The ability of the process to smelt either pellets or
briquettes, or even mixed charges of both, can provide means of using a wide range of
alternative feed materials. Efforts are being made to commercialise the Tecnored process in the
proximity of iron ore mine sites in Brazil, and other countries may follow. It has also been
claimed that the process is suitable for producing ferro-alloys like ferro-manganese.
of pig iron that are already in operation in India, and more are being considered. These MBFs
either use metallic blast pre-heaters to heat the blast to 800C, or small conventional stoves to
give hot blast temperatures of 1020 1050C. The MBFs normally use 100% lump ore
(10 40 mm in size) and coke (imported from neighbouring countries) with low ash (12%) to
give productivities as high as 2.2 t/m3/day, with coke rates of 650 725 kg/thm.
In China, around 55 Mtpa of hot metal is at present produced in 250 275 MBFs. Several
innovations have been made in the Chinese MBFs, like injection of pulverised anthracite to the
extent of 60 kg/thm, to bring down the coke rate by about 40 50 kg/thm to 500 630 kg/thm.
Such innovations, along with continuous improvements in refractories to increase the plant
availability, have made MBFs a well-accepted, risk-free ironmaking option for small scale
production.
The MBF technology today is certainly a competitor to SR processes, in situations where
limited tonnages of hot metal are required.
REFERENCE
Amit Chatterjee, Ramesh Singh, and Banshidhar Pandey, Metallics for SteelmakingProduction
and Use, Allied Publishers, 2001.
Part D
Steelmaking
Physical Chemistry of Primary Steelmaking
BOF Plant Practice
Metallurgical Features of Oxygen Steelmaking
Process Control for Basic Oxygen Steelmaking
Basic Open Hearth and Electric Arc Furnace Steelmaking
Secondary Steelmaking
Stainless Steelmaking
15
Physical Chemistry of
Primary Steelmaking
15.1 INTRODUCTION
Chapter 1 contained a broad overview of ironmaking and steelmaking. Chapter 3 presented an
outline of modern steelmaking. From those chapters, the following can be noted.
A modern steel melting shop has three broad groups of facilities, viz. primary
steelmaking, secondary steelmaking, and casting of liquid steel.
Primary steelmaking is dominantly carried out in top-blown Basic Oxygen Furnaces
(BOFs). The process has several variants, as already enumerated in Chapter 3. Another
category of oxygen-based steelmaking processes rely on bottom-blowing of oxygen
through special tuyeres. All these latter processes can be clubbed together under the
generic category of Basic Oxygen Steelmaking (BOS) processes.
Electric Arc Furnace (EAF) steelmaking is in addition to BOF and BOS, i.e. there are three
broad methods of making steel. These three groups of processes together account for almost the
entire liquid steel production in the world today.
Chapters 16 to 18 will cover various aspects of BOF steelmaking, along with a very brief
discussion of BOS processes like OBM, etc. (in Chapter 17) while Chapter 19 will deal with
EAF steelmaking. Since the open-hearth process of steelmaking has been phased out and is
virtually non-existent today, only a very brief discussion of open-hearth steelmaking is included
in Chapter 19.
The present chapter is concerned with some relevant physicochemical aspects of
steelmaking, that are applicable to all the primary steelmaking processes. These fundamentals
also constitute the basics of secondary steelmaking processes. However, BOF/BOS is the
principal focus of this chapter.
Primary steelmaking is a process of oxidation. The principal oxidising agent is gaseous
oxygen, along with iron oxide (added as iron ore). The extent of refining in oxygen steelmaking
processes is substantial since the principal metallic feed is blast furnace hot metal containing
265
266 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
high percentages of carbon, silicon, phosphorus and manganese. In EAF steelmaking, the extent
of refining is far less since a large proportion of the metallic feed is in the form of steel scrap
containing low levels of impurities.
The oxidation reactions are exothermic and constitute the source of heat in BOF and BOS
processes, leading to an increase in the bath temperature to 1600 1650C at the end of refining,
from an initial temperature of 1250 1300C. On the other hand, in EAF steelmaking the major
heat source is electrical power.
Oxidation of Si, Fe, Mn, P (and sometimes small amounts of Ti) leads to the formation of
SiO2, FeO, MnO, P2O5 (and TiO2). These oxides combine with the fluxing agents added
(principally lime, sometimes along with fluorspar, ilmenite, dolomite, etc.) to form a basic
molten slag, which helps in refining. Carbon is oxidised in the form of gaseous carbon
monoxide.
A comparison of Eq. (15.3) and Eq. (4.22) shows that A = DH 0f and B = - DS0f, and these
have been assumed to be independent of temperature. Table 4.1 has presented the values of A
and B for the formation of some oxides. Hence, A is to be taken as DH 0f.
Table 4.2 contained values of the free energy of mixing of some elements at 1 wt% standard
state in liquid iron ( Gim ) as a function of temperature as
Gim = C + DT (15.4)
Again, from the above analysis, it is possible to take C = Him and D = Sim.
Primary steelmaking is concerned with the oxidation of solutes dissolved in liquid iron. For
example, the oxidation of silicon may be written as
[Si]dissolved in iron + O2(g) = SiO2(s) (15.5)
At 1 wt. % standard state, it may be written as
[Si]1 wt% ss in Fe + O2(g) = SiO2(s); DH 0f (wt. %) (15.6)
From Tables 4.1 and 4.2,
Si(1) + O2(g) = SiO2(s); DH 0f = 947676 J mol1 (15.7)
m
Si(1) = [Si]1 wt% std. state; HSi = 131500 J mol1 (15.8)
Subtracting Eq. (15.8) from Eq. (15.7), Eq. (15.6) is obtained. Hence,
m
DH 0f (wt%) = DH 0f HSi = 816176 J mol1 (15.9)
On the basis of the above, the DH 0f (wt. %) values (except for Fe, because it is the solvent)
have been listed in Table 15.1. For convenience, these have been reported as DH 0f in
kilojoules per mole with the values rounded-off to 4 digits. The table also includes values of DS0f
in J mol1 K1.
Table 15.1 Standard enthalpies and entropies of formation of some oxides from elements dissolved
in liquid iron
Note: For Fe, pure iron is the standard state; for others, values correspond to those for 1 wt. % standard state
in liquid iron.
268 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
All these reactions involving the oxidation of metalloids are highly exothermic. Among them
in BOF/BOS steelmaking, the major heat producing reactions are oxidation of Si, C, and Fe,
since large quantities of these species are present. The endothermic steps include heating-up of
the inputs and the additions made during the blow to steelmaking temperatures. The principal
inputs are: molten hot metal at around 12501300C, and scrap, lime (and other fluxes), iron
ore, pig iron all at room temperature. Sometimes, other minor additions are made depending on
the practice adopted; however, they can be ignored in this general analysis.
Equation (6.5) of Section 6.1.1, gives the general equations for sensible heat (HT H298) of
a substance as a function of temperature. As a simplification, hot metal, pig iron and scrap may
all be assumed to be pure iron. Similarly, iron ore may be assumed to be either pure F2O3 or
pure Fe3O4. Table 15.2 (Kelley 1960) lists the (HT H298) values on this basis. The range of
temperature at which they are valid are also shown.
Other thermochemical data required for thermal calculations are enthalpies of dissolution
(i.e. heats of mixing) in liquid metal and slag. These are smaller quantities in comparison with
the exothermic oxidation reactions and sensible heats, and may be ignored for approximate
calculations.
As discussed earlier, for liquid iron solution, data have already been provided in Table 4.2.
Steelmaking slag may be considered as a mixture of dicalcium ferrite, dicalcium silicate and
calcium phosphates, for which the heats of formation data are noted in Table 15.3 ((1) Ward
1962; (2) Bogdandy and Engells, 1971).
Table 15.3 Heats of formation of some double compounds of oxides at steelmaking temperatures
(approximate values)
EXAMPLE 15.1
For a BOF heat, the following data are given.
(i) Hot metal contains 1% Si, 0.15% P, 0.25% Mn and 3.5% C.
(ii) Weight of scrap is 10% of hot metal.
(iii) Steel at tap contains 0.2% C.
(iv) Slag has 54% CaO, 18% FeO, 2.5% MgO, 2.5% MnO, and CaO/SiO2 ratio = 3.2.
Calculate the following per tonne (i.e. 1000 kg) of steel.
(a) Weight of hot metal charge
(b) Weight of slag produced
(c) Quantity of lime required.
EXAMPLE 15.2
For the heat in Example 15.1, calculate the quantity of oxygen required per tonne of steel.
Assume that the exit gas of the converter contains 10% CO2 and 90% CO as average of the entire
heat.
Solution: Noting atomic masses of C, O, Si, P, Mn, Fe as 12, 16, 28, 31, 55 and 56
respectively,
270 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Oxygen required = Oxygen to form (CO + CO2 + SiO2 + FeO + MnO + P2O5)
Wsteel 16 32
= wt.% C oxidised 0.9 + 0.1
100 12 12
32 16 80
+ WHM wt. % Si + wt. % Mn + wt. % P
28 55 62
16
+ W slag wt. % FeO in slag (Ex. 15.3)
72
Noting that Wsteel = 1000 kg, wt. % C oxidised = (WHM 3.5 Wsteel 0.2)/Wsteel = 3.205,
WHM = 975 kg, wt. % Si = 1, wt. % Mn = 0.25, wt. % P = 0.15, Wslag = 130 kg, and wt. % FeO
in slag = 18.
Calculations yield quantity of oxygen required = 59.5 kg = 59.5 22.4/32 = 41.7 Nm3.
Figure 4.1 has presented the variation in DG 0f as a function of temperature for some oxides.
It may be seen that the chemical potentials of oxygen follow the following order at steelmaking
temperatures: mO2 (Fe FeO) > mO2 (Si SiO2) > mO2 (Ca CaO).
Since FeFeO has highest mO2, its concentration determines the chemical potential of O2 in
slag. Again, Fe is present as Fe2+ and Fe 3+ ions in slag. Actually, mO2 in the slag is governed
by the equilibrium of the reaction:
4 (FeO) + O2(g) = 2(Fe2O3) (15.10)
The Fe3+/Fe2+ ratio varies to a very major extent during steelmaking. It is also not measured for
all heats on a regular basis because of difficulties in taking representative samples. Therefore,
the standard practice is to determine the metallic Fe concentration in the slag and report it as
FeO. This is represented as either FeO (total) or FeO.
The ternary CaOSiO2FeO (or Fe2O3) constitutes the basic phase diagram in primary
steelmaking. Figure 15.1 (Muan and Osborn, 1965) shows the isothermal sections at 1600C, in
contact with metallic iron, as well as in contact with air. The liquid fields are shown along with
the solid compounds at equilibrium with various liquid field boundaries. The solid circle
corresponds to the nominal turndown slag composition (assuming CaO + SiO2 + FeO (or Fe2O3)
= 100%). Of course, the actual compositions lie over a range around this region. It may be noted
that the solids, which are likely to coexist with the primary steelmaking slag are 2CaO SiO2,
3CaO SiO2 and CaO.
SiO 2 SiO 2
10 90 10 90
Cristobalite Cristobalite
30 + 30
L 70 + 70
L
40 60 40 60
50 50 50 50
Liquid Liquid
40 40
2CaO SiO 2 2CaO SiO 2
C
C C2 S + L C 3S
+ L2 S + 30 + L2 S + + 30
3CaO SiO 2
3CaO SiO 2 C C L
3S 3S
20 20
C3 S + L C3 S + L
Lime + C3 S + L 10 Lime + C 3S + L 10
Lime + L Lime + L
CaO 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 FeO CaO 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 Fe 2 O 3
Weight % Weight %
(a) (b)
Figure 15.1 Isothermal sections at 1600C (i.e. 1873 K) in the system CaOiron oxideSiO2, in
contact with (left) metallic iron, (right) air.
272 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
However, it has been demonstrated that the effects of other slag components cannot be
completely ignored. For this reason, a wider liquid region exists in commercial slags at 1600C,
than what can be inferred from the ternary diagram for pure compounds. The total concentration
of CaO, SiO2 and FeO(t) is in the range of 8090%, and if the sum of CaO + SiO2 + FeO(t)
is taken as 100% and the phase diagram recalculated, it does not make a major difference. Of
course, such recalculations lead to some errors (Walker and Anderson, 1972). Figure 15.2
(Bardenheuer et al. 1968) shows such a diagram.
(SiO2)
0 100
10 90
20 80
30 70
%
),
40 60
aO
Temperature in C
(S
(C
50 50
iO 2
1300
),
60 1400 40
%
(2CaOSiO2) 1500
70 1550 30
(3CaO SiO2) 1650 1600
80 1700 20
90 10
100 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
(CaO) (FeO)
(FeO), %
Figure 15.2 Pseudoternary system CaOSiO2FeO; average CaO + SiO2 + FeO = 80 wt% in
actual slag.
Figure 15.3 (Taylor and Chipman, 1943) presents activity vs. composition diagrams for the
CaOSiO2FeO system at 1550C. Standard state for FeO is liquid and its activity was measured
experimentally. Activities of SiO2 and CaO with respect to the pure solid oxides as standard
states were calculated by GibbsDuhem integration. If other oxides are to be included in the
ternary diagram, an alternative approach would be to lump the other basic oxides (MgO, MnO)
with the CaO-corner, SiO2 + P2O5 + Al2O3 at the top corner of the triangle.
Physical Chemistry of Primary Steelmaking 273
SiO2
0.1
0.4 0.2 0.6
0.3
O
X SiO
Ca
0.4
X
0.4
2
0.6 0.5
0.6
0.7
C2S + liq.
0.8 0.2
0.8
0.9
aSiO2(s)
0.4 0.8
aCaO(s)
(0.9)
0.0 0.0 (0.7)
0.6 6
0.02 8
O
0.6 (0.6)
Ca
X SiO
X
(0.4)
2
0.1
(0.2)
0.8
0.2
0.4
0.4 (0.1)
(0.05)
(0.001)
(0.0005)
CaO 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 FeO
XFeO
(b)
Figure 15.3 Activities of FeO, CaO, SiO2 in CaOFeOSiO2 melts in equilibrium with liquid iron at
1550C (i.e. 1823 K).
EXAMPLE 15.3
Calculate the oxygen potential of liquid steel at equilibrium with a molten slag at 1600C.
Given:
(i) Slag contains CaO, SiO2 and FeO with 0.45, 0.4 and 0.15 mole fractions respectively,
(ii) [O]wt% + Fe(l) = FeO (l); K1 = 4.78 at 1600C from Eq. (15.13),
(iii) O2(g) = 2[O]wt%; K2 = 6.89 106 at 1600C.
274 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
15.4.1 Introduction
1. SiO2, TiO2 are very stable compounds (see Figure 4.1). Therefore, Si and Ti in hot metal
are removed as oxides in the early part of steelmaking, and are of no concern thereafter.
2. Desulphurisation of hot metal occurs to some extent within the blast furnace and
subsequently, during hot metal pretreatment. As discussed in Chapter 5, Section 5.4.3,
sulphur can be transferred efficiently from metal to slag, only under reducing conditions.
Since primary steelmaking slags are highly oxidising in nature, very little sulphur
transfer to slag can be achieved in primary steelmaking. Low levels of sulphur required
in most steel today and ultra-low sulphur levels in some special steel grades can only be
attained through further refining in secondary steelmaking processes. Hence, it is not
discussed here.
Physical Chemistry of Primary Steelmaking 275
0.20
0.12
CO equilibrium at 1600C
0.8 ([WC] [WO] = 0.0024)
0.4
0.0
0.04 0.12 0.20 0.28 0.36
Carbon in bath, wt. %
Figure 15.4 Dissolved oxygen content of liquid iron as a function of bath carbon at 1600C
(1873 K) in a 100 kVA induction furnace.
Carbon also reacts with FeO and MnO in slag. The reaction with FeO is
(FeO) + [C] = [Fe] + CO(g) (15.17)
for which the equilibrium constant is
[ a ] pCO pCO
K FC = Fe @ (15.18)
[ hC ]( aFeO ) eq. [ wC ](aFeO ) eq.
Combining Eqs. (15.13) and (15.16),
4990
+ 4.607 log K FC = - (15.19)
T
Turkdogan (1996) has proposed several simplified correlations for reactions in steelmaking for
the convenience of users. He assumed a slag basicity of 3.2 and the average pressure of CO in
BOF vessels as 1.5 atm. Noting that g FeO = 1.3 at this basicity, at 1600C his equilibrium
correlation turns out to be
(wFeO)[wC] @ 1.0 (15.20)
Similarly, for the reaction:
(MnO) + [C] = [Mn] + CO(g) (15.21)
[ w ] pCO
KMC = Mn (15.22)
[ wC ]( aMnO ) eq.
13182
and log KMC = - + 8.574 (15.23)
T
Again simplification, assuming gMnO in slag = 2.05, leads to the equilibrium correlation:
[ wMn ]
= 0.4 [ wC ] at 1600C (15.24)
(wMnO )
Physical Chemistry of Primary Steelmaking 277
1
DG 035 = DG 029 5DG 031 2DG 33
0
2
= 740375 + 535.365T J mol1 (15.36)
( aP2O5 )
for reaction (15.35), Kp = 2 5
(15.37)
[hP ] [hO ]
eq.
0
DG35 38668
log KP = - = - 27.96 (15.38)
2.303 RT T
Assuming hP = wP and hO = wO, at 1600C (i.e. 1873 K), and at equilibrium
(aP2O5 )
= 4.0 10 -8 (15.39)
[wP ]2 [wO ]5
Assuming wt. % P and wt. % O in steel at turndown to be 0.01 and 0.08% respectively, aP2O5
in slag at equilibrium (with respect to gaseous P2O5 as standard state) is 1.57 1017. If
wt. % P2O5 = 2, then mole fraction of P2O5 in slag (XP2O5) is about 0.01. Since, aP2O5 = XP2O5 gP2O5,
gP2O5 (i.e. activity coefficient of P2O5) in slag at equilibrium should be 1.31 1015.
This is indeed a very low value. Such a low g P2O5 is possible only in a highly basic slag since
P2O5 is an acidic oxide. Correlations based on experimental data have been proposed. One of
the earliest by Turkdogan and Pearson (1953) is reproduced below:
42000
log g P2O5 = -1.12[22 X CaO + 15 X MgO + 13 X MnO + 12 X FeO - 2 XSiO2 ] - + 23.58 (15.40)
T
where X is mole fraction in slag.
Figure 15.5 (Turkdogan and Pearson, 1953) presents this relationship. It may be noted from
Eq. (15.40) that CaO is the most powerful dephosphoriser. Of course, Na2O, BaO are more
powerful than CaO, but they cannot be used in steelmaking owing to their tendency to attack
the lining of the furnace. The approximate dephosphorisation power ratio for some cations in
slag has been estimated as (Ward 1962):
Ca2+ Mg2+ Mn2+ Fe2+
30,000 : 1000 : 3 : 1
Coming back to the issue of g P2O5, from Eq. (15.40) at XCaO = 0.6 and T = 1873 K,
g P2O5 = 2.36 1014. Ward proposed a temperature correction for Eq. (15.40), which was
44600/T + 23.80. Accepting this suggestion, g P2O5 = 1.6 1015. This shows that for highly
basic, limey slags it is possible to obtain sufficiently low g P2O5 for effective dephosphorisation.
Physical Chemistry of Primary Steelmaking 279
14
1550 10C
1585 10C
1635 10C
15 1660 10C
log g P2O5
16
17
18
13 14 15 16 17 18
S AiXi = 22XCaO + 15XMgO + 13XMnO + 12XFeO 2XSiO2
Again, the dissolved oxygen content of steel is approximately proportional to aFeO in slag.
Therefore, an alternative way of writing the phosphorus reaction is
2[P] + 5(FeO) = (P2O5) + 5[Fe] (15.41)
Hence, removal of phosphorus also requires a high concentration of FeO in the slag, besides high
CaO. However, higher is the wt. % FeO, lower will be the wt. % CaO, and this will adversely
affect the dephosphorsing ability of the slag. Balajiva et al. (1946), in their pioneering study
found that extensive dephosphorisation requires an optimum FeO content in steelmaking slags
as shown in Figure 15.6.
This leads to the concept of phosphate capacity of slags (Eq. (4.54), Chapter 4). It was first
employed by Healy (1970). Turkdogan (1996) has recently critically analysed and assessed the
phosphorus reaction. He expressed the reaction as:
5 3
[P] + [O] + (O2 - ) = (PO34- ) (15.42)
2 2
and the phosphate capacity of slag as:
(w P )
KPO = [ wO ]-2.5
[ wP ]
= LP,e [wO]2.5 (15.43)
where LP,e is the slagmetal phosphorus partition ratio at equilibrium.
280 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
400
2 ~4.0
/SiO
(wt. % P2 O5)/[wt. % P]
CaO
300
2 ~2. 8
2 ~3.5
200 iO
CaO/S
iO
CaO/S
100 CaO/SiO2~2.4
0
4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32
wt. % FeO
Figure 15.6 Dependence of the ratio, (wt. % P2O5)/[wt. % P], on the iron oxide content of slags at
different CaO/SiO2 ratios in laboratory experiments at 1685C.
Figure 15.7 (Turkdogan 1996) shows the dependence of KPO on slag composition for BOF
type slags. The correlation is based on data for widely differing slag compositions. The master
correlation including temperature variation can be written as
21740
log LP,e = 9.87 + 0.071BO + 2.5 log [wO] (15.44)
T
The relationship of [wO] with wt. % FeO in slag was estimated as:
[ wO ]
= (0.1T - 155.3) 10 -4 (15.45)
(wFeO )
In a recent study (Choudhary et al. 2005), the important correlations proposed in literature
were critically examined, and the semi-empirical correlation of Turkdogan (Eq. (15.44)) was
accepted as the most reliable. However, not all the lime added dissolves in slag; some of it
remains undissolved as free CaO particles or free calcium disilicate in slag. These particles do
not, by and large, absorb P2O5 owing to the slow kinetics. Therefore, they should be subtracted,
and the overall slag composition should be corrected for the calculation of equilibrium LP,e. Since
free lime is not determined during routine slag analysis, it poses some uncertainty. Choudhary
et al. assumed 0% and 10% free lime in their calculations.
Physical Chemistry of Primary Steelmaking 281
7 7
10 10
1600C
6 with CaF2 6 1500C
10 10
4 4
K PO
10 10
1550C
1600C
3 3
10 10
2 2
10 10 1700C
1 1
10 10
0 20 40 60 0 20 40 60
BO = %CaO + %CaF2+ 0.3 %MgO BO = %CaO + %CaF2+ 0.3 %MgO
Figure 15.7 Equilibrium data from several investigations showing the decisive effects of CaO, CaF2
and MgO on phosphate capacities of simple and complex slags.
The best conditions for phosphorus removal from liquid steel from a thermodynamic
viewpoint can be summarised as:
A highly basic, lime-rich slag
A satisfactorily high level of oxidation of iron
The lowest possible temperature
The lowest possible amount of undissolved free lime in slag.
EXAMPLE 15.4
For the BOF heat, as in Examples 15.1 and 15.2,
(a) Calculate the equilibrium slagmetal phosphorus partition coefficient (LP,e) at 1650C.
Assume 0% and 10% free lime in slag.
(b) Calculate the activity coefficient of P2O5 (i.e. g P2O5) in slag at 0% free lime.
(c) Calculate the wt. % P in metal and slag at slagmetal equilibrium as well as for
RP = 0.4. RP is the ratio of actual LP and equilibrium LP (see Eq. (17.4)).
Solution: (a) LP,e can be calculated by using Eqs. (15.44) and (15.45).
From Figure 15.7,
BO = wt. % CaO + wt. % CaF2 + 0.3 wt. % MgO, in slag (Ex. 15.6)
= 54 + 0 + 0.3 2.5 = 54.75
From Eq. (15.45), [WO] = 0.0666%.
Noting that wt. % FeO in slag = 18 wt. % and T = 1923 K,
From Eq. (15.44), Log LP,e = 2.385, giving LP,e = 242.7 at 0% free lime.
282 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Since, free lime does not appreciably react with P2O5 owing to very slow kinetics, it is
assumed that only the liquid part of the slag participates in the phosphorus reaction at 10% free
lime. This requires calculation of the liquid slag composition in the following manner.
Since, liquid slag is 90% of total slag, wt. % FeO = 18 100/90 = 20%, wt. %
MgO = 2.5 100/90 = 2.78%, wt. % CaO = (54 10) 100/90 = 48.9%, and [WO] = 0.074%.
Substituting these values in Eqs. (Ex 15.4) and (15.44), log LP,e = 2.14, giving LP,e = 138.
(b) Equation (15.40) provides the relationship of g P2O5 with mole fractions of slag
components and temperature. This requires conversion of weight percent into mole
fraction (X ). It can be done on the basis of Eq. (4.26) in Chapter 4. Calculation gives
mole fractions of CaO, MgO, MnO, FeO, SiO2 as 0.577, 0.0374, 0.022 , 0.15 and 0.169
respectively.
At 1923 K, putting in values in Eq. (15.40) gives log g P2O5 = 15.06, i.e.
g P2O5 = 8.6 1016.
(c) Pbalance: Initial P in HM = (P in steel + P in slag) at tap (Ex. 15.7)
WHM wt. % P in HM 1
i.e. = [WP] (Wsteel + Wslag LP,e)
100 100
where [WP] is wt. % P in steel at tapping.
0.15 1
i.e. 973 = [WP ] (1000 + 242.7 130)
100 100
This gives [WP] = 0.00448%.
(WP) = LP,e [WP] = 242.7 0.00448 = 1.088%
If RP = 0.4, then LP = 0.4 242.7 = 97.08.
Calculations in a similar manner give [WP] = 0.0107%, and (WP) = 1.040%.
Table 15.4(a) Viscosity (h), density (r), kinematic viscosity (n) and interfacial tension (s) of some
steel and slag melts
Interfacial tensions of some slags with liquid iron at 1850 to 1950 K (approximate)from Slage Atlas, 1981
Table 15.4(b) Some diffusion coefficient values in liquid iron and iron alloys
REFERENCES
Balajiva, K., A.G. Quarrell and P. Vajragupta, J. Iron Steel Inst., Vol. 153 (1946), p. 115.
Bardenheuer, F. et al., Arch Eisenh, Vol. 39 (1968), p. 571.
Bogdandy, L. Von. and H.J. Engells, The Reduction of Iron Ores, Springer Verlag, Berlin,
1971.
Choudhary, S.K., S.N. Lenka and A. Ghosh, Tata Search, 2005, pp. 117124.
Elliott, J.F., M. Gleiser and V. Ramakrishna, Thermochemistry for Steelmaking,
Vo1. 2, Addison-Wesley, Reading, Mass., USA, 1963.
Healy, G.W., J. Iron and Steel Inst., Vol. 208 (1970), pp. 664668.
Kelley, K.K., Contributions to the Data on Theoretical Metallurgy, Bulletin 584, Bureau of
Mines, Washington D.C., USA, 1960.
Muan, A. and E.F. Osborn, Phase Equilibria Among Oxides in Steelmaking, AddisonWesley,
Reading, Mass., USA, 1965.
Saeki, T. et al., Trans ISIJ, Vol. 18 (1978), p. 501.
Slag Atlas, Committee for Fundamental Metallurgy, Verlag Stahleisen, Dusseldorf, 1981.
Taylor, C.R. and J. Chipman, Trans AIME, Vol. 159 (1943), p. 228.
Timucin, M. and A.E. Morris, Met. Trans., Vol. 1 (1970), p. 3193.
Turkdogan, E.T. and J. Pearson, J. Iron Steel Inst., Vol. 175 (1953), p. 398.
Turkdogan, E.T., Fundamentals of Steelmaking, Institute of Materials, London (1996), p. 188.
Walker, R.D. and D. Anderson, Reaction Mechanisms in Basic Oxygen Steelmaking, Part I, Iron
and Steel, June 1972, pp. 271276.
Ward, R.G., An Introduction to the Physical Chemistry of Iron & SteelMaking, Edwin Arnold,
London, 1962; Appendix.
16
BOF Plant Practice
16.1 INTRODUCTION
The modern, high-performance BOF converter is the outcome of continuous developments over
the past fifty years. Ever since Voest-Alpine commissioned the first LD converter in 1952 in
Linz, Austria (Chapter 3), several improvements have been made to make the process more
versatile. The physicochemical principles governing the chemical reactions in BOF and other
processes of primary steelmaking have been introduced in Chapter 15. The metallurgical features
of BOF steelmaking will be covered in greater detail in Chapter 17. This chapter will discuss
some practical aspects of BOF steelmaking, including pre-treatment of hot metal.
285
286 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Tapping the vessel by rotating it to the opposite side so that steel flows through the tap
hole in the nose portion of the vessel into a ladle kept below the converter floor
(48 minutes).
During tapping of steel, simultaneous outflow of slag is prevented to the maximum possible
extent, by using a pneumatic slag stopper arrangement at the tap hole, or by introducing suitable
slag arresting devices into the converter like refractory darts, that are heavier than slag but lighter
than steel. Once steel is tapped, the vessel is turned further (almost to 180 from the upright
position) so that most of the slag within the converter flows into a slag ladle that is subsequently
sent by rail road for cooling. Some slag is often retained for slag splashing (details given later
in Section 16.3.1). BOF slags containing 1822% iron and with high basicity (sometimes, even
free lime) are used in sintermaking, or as a soil conditioner for acidic soil.
The exit gas generated during blowing [120 130 Nm3/tonne liquid steel (tls)], which is rich
in CO for up to 90% of the duration of the blow, and contains dust to the extent of 20 kg/tonne
liquid steel, is sent to the gas-cleaning plant before it is stored.
Mouth
Top ring
Nose ring
Top cone
Shaft mounted Safety lining
drive unit Fixed Working lining
Tap
(bull gear) bearing Upper
hole
Slag knuckle
Furnace shield
position
Expansion
indicator
bearing
Gear head Trunnion ring Trunnion shaft
unit (pinion) (idle side)
Torque Support
Motor and Barrel section
brake arm brackets
Concrete
foundation Lower knuckle
Trunnion shaft Spherical bottom section
(drive side)
Since the early 1980s, dramatic improvements have taken place in the length of converter
campaigns because of process developments as well as developments in refractory lining
technology. This has not only resulted in considerable reduction in the refractory cost per tonne
of steel, but has also reduced the downtime. One of the most innovative process improvements
288 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
that have been made to increase the lining life is slag splashing. Slag splashing, as the name
implies, utilises the residual slag from the previous heat to provide a coating on the refractory
lining, before the next heat is charged. This is carried out by forcing molten slag by means of
high pressure gas into the upper regions of the vessel, where it becomes viscous and gets
attached to the converter working lining. This automatically decreases the amount of refractories
that are exposed to the refining reactions, and reduces the refractory consumption. The upper
sidewalls of the converter where molten slag cannot be deposited are subjected to slag attack in
the subsequent heat, as well as to extremes of temperature variations between two heats.
Despite the fact that all BOF vessels have a very large inner volume (0.650.70 m3/tls for
0.4 0.5% silicon hot metal and even more for high silicon hot metal), the converter contents
often overflow through the tap hole or get ejected through the mouth opening. This is referred
to as spitting (for metal droplets) or slopping (for slagmetal emulsion). The bath depth is an
important parameter that influences the empty space available within any converter to contain
spitting/slopping. In such a situation, for a given specific volume of the vessel, the diameter
becomes the controlling factor that determines the inner contours of a BOF. However, with
increasing wear of the lining, the bath depth can also vary substantially. Therefore, in most BOF
shops, the bath depth is measured using the lance assembly at least once every 8 hours.
In combined blown BOF vessels, bottom blowing through tuyeres/canned elements and the
resultant bath agitation, contribute to localised wear of the refractory components at the converter
bottom. The wear is attributable to turbulent flow of molten metal giving rise to erosion of the
refractories as well as to thermal stress caused by the passage of cold gases. High density and
low porosity pitch bonded, impregnated magnesite carbon based upon fused magnesia, is the
preferred refractory material for lining this portion of the vessel.
BOF at temperatures close to 1600C and contains dust particles comprising iron oxides and
lime, mainly below 200 mesh size. This gas has to be cooled before it can be cleaned in the gas
cleaning plant. The load on the gas cleaning plant is the highest when iron ore is added as a
coolant during the blow since the exit gas flow automatically increases owing to the extra
oxygen. At such times, the generation of dust also increases, varying between 20 and 30 kg/tls.
However, when scrap alone is the coolant, the amount of dust is restricted to 1025 kg/tls. In
some cases, hazardous pollutants like cadmium, chromium, lead, manganese, and nickel may
also be present. Zinc compounds are present in BOF fume in varying amounts, if process scrap
containing zinc is charged.
Carbon monoxide in the gas is partly burnt to CO2 at the converter mouth. The remainder
of the combustible gases is extracted at a largely constant air ratio, by using a hood pressure
control device. Positive gas routing to avoid explosions then becomes a basic requirement for
any gas-cleaning equipment. If the proper system is chosen and operated efficiently, it is possible
to recover about 9600 kJ of energy per tonne of liquid steel from the waste gas. Through heat
recovery in the waste gas cooling system, 210215 kJ of additional energy per tonne of liquid
steel can be recovered, i.e. 90% of the total energy content in the waste gas is recoverable.
The equipment used for gas cleaning and dust collection include: a quencher for cooling,
venturi-type washer and cooling tower in series for dust extraction, and a clarifier or thickening
basin for handling water containing dust that settles as sludge. Clean water leaving the clarifier
contains less than 0.25 g solids per litre of water, and the clean gas stored in the gas holder
contains a maximum of 1.6 g of solids per cubic metre.
16.4 REFINING
In Chapters 17 and 18, the details of the metallurgical features and process control in basic
oxygen steelmaking will be presented. Hence in this section, only a brief outline is given.
During refining, controlled oxidation of the impurities in hot metal (with the exception of
sulphur) takes place once oxygen is blown at supersonic speeds (Appendix II contains more
details of supersonic jets and their relevance to BOF steelmaking) onto the liquid bath. The
interaction of the oxygen jet(s) with the bath produces crater(s) on the surface, from the outer
lip(s) of which, a large number of tiny metal droplets get splashed. These droplets reside for a
short time in the slag above the bath. Therefore, the existence of a metalslaggas emulsion
within the vessel, virtually during the entire blowing/refining period is an integral part of BOF
steelmaking. This is the reason why the slagmetal reactions like dephosphorisation and gas
metal reactions like decarburisation proceed so rapidly in the BOF process (earlier, it was
erroneously believed that the existence of a high temperature, 25002600C, zone on the bath
surface was responsible for the high rates of reactions). The droplets ultimately return to the
metal bath. The extent of emulsification varies at different stages of the blowing period, as
depicted schematically in Figure 16.3.
Lance
Oxygen jet
Lining
Metallic bath
Gasslagmetal emulsion
Figure 16.3 Schematic representation of the bath conditions within a BOF at various stages of the
blow.
A minimum amount of slag, with the desired characteristics, is necessary for ensuring that
the emulsion is stable, i.e. the slag should not be too viscous, or too watery. Only in this way
can the kinetics of the removal of the impurities be enhanced. For encouraging quick formation
of the appropriate type of slag, lime/dolomite/other fluxing agents with adequate reactivity are
added right from the beginning of the blow. The reactivity of the fluxing agents, primarily lime
(consumption 60100 kg/tls), determines how quickly slag is formed (typically within
45 minutes after the commencement of the blow). The rate at which oxygen is blown through
the lance, the number of openings (holes) on the lance tip, the distance between the lance tip
and the bath surface (lance height), the characteristics of the oxygen jets as they impinge on the
bath surface, the volume, basicity and fluidity of the slag, the temperature conditions in the bath,
BOF Plant Practice 291
and many other operational variables influence the rate of refining. In most cases, to encourage
slag formation a high lance height (1.5 2.0 m) is used at the beginning of the blow, and then
the lance is lowered (0.8 1.2 m) for decarburisation.
The basic design of the converter, the extent of combustion of waste gases, the total blowing
time, characteristics of the slag during the entire blowing period, post-blow operations (if any),
etc. have a profound influence on the composition and the temperature of the bath at the end of
refining. If the desired end-point, in terms of composition and/or temperature, is not reached (i.e.
the hit rate is suboptimal), oxygen has to be blown againthis is referred as reblowing. Hit rates
of 8892% can be achieved if adequate process control measures are adopted.
In order to withdraw a sample to check the bath composition/temperature, the blow has to
be temporarily suspended, the lance withdrawn, and then a spoon inserted after inclining the
converter in such a way that the bath becomes horizontal. Once the sample is taken, the vessel
is made upright before resuming blowing. This is a time-taking procedure. To avoid such delays,
most modern BOF shops are equipped with a sublance. The sublance is an inclined lance
positioned next to the oxygen lance, which can be mechanically lowered into the bath to collect
metal/slag sample and measure the bath temperature, keeping the converter in the vertical
position. Solid probes attached to the sublance tip are used for this purpose. They have to be
renewed after each dip, and can add to costs since they are quite expensive.
16.5.2 Coolants
In determining the amount of solid charge used in a BOF at any point of time, the primary
factors are cost/availability of hot metal, cost/availability of scrap or iron oxide (both are
coolants) and the amount of fluxes required. The physical condition of all these solids is also
important, since it influences their melting rate during the progress of the blow.
The quality and the composition of scrap are of particular significance in achieving the final
composition of the steel tapped. If the scrap charged contains elements like copper, tin and
nickel, these elements do not get removed as oxides, and the metals report to steel, resulting even
in off-grade products. Another area of concern is the degree of oxidation of the scrap, which may
have a significant influence on the charge balance (proportion of liquid to solid charge), since
292 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Fe2O3 contents as high as 15% may be introduced in this way. A virgin alternative iron source
is direct reduced iron (DRI) and with increasing availability of DRI, its usage in the appropriate
size (315 mm) in BOF steelmaking is also increasing. When calculating the amount of the
coolant required, it is important to note that DRI cools 10% more efficiently than scrap for the
same weight; whereas, the cooling factor of iron ore is 3.0 3.5 times greater. Usage of large
amounts of iron ore is often precluded by extensive slopping from the vessel mouth, since the
iron ore added is not immediately in equilibrium with the bath. Slopping can be reduced by
decreasing the rate of iron ore addition and/or altering the blowing strategy so that the emulsion
collapses.
16.5.4 Oxygen
This is an important input material whose quality is often not adequately highlighted. The
minimum purity of oxygen to allow the production of the full range of carbon steel products
should be 99.9%. The final turndown nitrogen and hydrogen contents of steel are dependent not
only on the amounts of these elements present in hot metal/fluxes, but also on oxygen.
During the early stages of the oxygen blow, when the rate of carbon monoxide evolution
is high, the nitrogen content of the bath decreases, i.e. de-nitrogenisation occurs. However, when
the decarburisation rate begins to fall (after 1215 minutes) the nitrogen content can increase
substantially if oxygen of adequate purity is not used.
blowing in another converter to produce highly siliceous slag (in the presence of lime) before
the desiliconised hot metal is transferred to a second converter, for the other reactions to proceed.
This type of two-slag BOF operation gives rise to the following advantages:
Improved dephosphorisation during steelmaking since highly basic slags can be formed
early in the blow
Reduction in the converter slag volume accompanied by an increase in the iron yield
(less iron loss in the slag), longer converter campaigns (less attack on the lining from
siliceous compounds in the primary slag), etc.
Lower consumption of ferro alloys because of higher recovery arising on account of the
lower levels of dissolved oxygen in liquid steel
Easier dynamic control of the process to arrive at the desired end point.
Despite these advantages, desiliconisation is not normally practiced essentially because of
problems in handling the highly siliceous slag that is produced. Such slags have high temperature
and are extremely fluid, thereby causing aggressive attack on most refractories. Instead, efforts
have been made to produce low silicon (0.30.6%) hot metal directly in blast furnaces to the
maximum possible extent, as discussed in Chapter 11.
16.6.3 Desulphurisation
Desulphurisation is better at the hot metal stage rather than at the steel stage because of the
reasons given in Table 16.1 (Gupta and Chatterjee, 1995). Desulphurisation of hot metal in blast
furnace ladles en route to the steel melting shop has become a standard practice because:
The productivity of blast furnaces can be improved by 68% when sulphur control
within the blast furnace is not required, and a leaner slag chemistry as well as lower slag
volume can be chosen
The consumption of coke as well as fluxes decreases, thereby reducing the total energy
consumption per tonne of hot metal
Build-up of alkalis in the blast furnace gets restricted, and
The production of low silicon hot metal becomes easier.
16.6.4 Dephosphorisation
Theoretically speaking, dephosphorisation of hot metal allows:
Increased recycling of BOF slag to the blast furnace, thereby reducing the cost of hot
metal
Steel for continuous casting to be tapped at higher temperature without the risk of
rephosphorisation
Control on the extent of segregation of phosphorus during continuous casting
Lower final sulphur and phosphorus contents in steel, particularly high alloy steel.
However, dephosphorisation is normally not carried out during the production of bulk steels,
since from free energy considerations, it can only be done under oxidising conditions, and in the
presence of a highly basic slag. This is possible only after the total removal of silicon (dictated
by thermodynamics). At the same time, while phosphorus is best removed at low temperature,
desiliconisation automatically increases the temperature (the reaction of oxygen with silicon is
highly exothermic). The dichotomy of the situation is evident. Therefore, alternative strategies
for controlling the phosphorus content of hot metal by choosing appropriate raw materials, or by
adopting a modified BOF process (e.g. concurrent injection of lime and oxygen in the converter)
to process high phosphorus (12%) hot metal, have found favour. However, some Japanese steel
plants, which produce very low silicon hot metal (less than 0.3%) in their blast furnaces, have
been able to practice simultaneous desulphurisation and dephosphorisation of hot metal.
16.7.1 Soda-ash
When soda-ash (sodium carbonate) is added to hot metal, dense fumes are generated, which can
create environmental problems. Disposal of soda-bearing slags gives rise to ground water
contamination. This is the primary reason why the use of soda-ash has been restricted in recent
times, though it is an effective reagent for both desiliconisation and desulphurisation.
Sodium carbonate is comparatively stable up to 1200C, above which it decomposes:
Na2CO3(l) = Na2O(l) + CO2(g) (16.1)
A portion of the Na2O produced dissolves in liquid Na2CO3 (m.p. = 851C) while the remainder
decomposes:
Na2O(l) = 2Na(g) + O2(g) (16.2)
In hot metal containing carbon and silicon, the following reactions take place:
Na2CO3(l) + 2[C] = 2Na(g) + 3CO(g) (16.3)
Na2CO3(l) + [Si] = Na2O.SiO2 + [C] (16.4)
Na2CO3(l) + 2[C] + [S] = Na2S + 3CO(g) (16.5)
296 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Since the reactions related to the decomposition of Na2O and Na2CO3 to Na (g) proceed rapidly
at high temperature, lower temperatures are preferable for desulphurisation (reaction 16.5). Soda-
ash is a very effective reagent for desulphurisation and dephosphorisation in the case of low
silicon hot metal.
Lime contributes towards enhancement of the basicity of the micro-slags that are formed,
while dissociation of limestone provides carbon dioxide that is beneficial for agitation. On the
other hand, carbon in the mixture helps in maintaining the necessary atmosphere at the reaction
sites. These mixtures are injected using nitrogen (in some special cases argon) as the carrier gas.
Co-injection of carbide and magnesium metal granules (in the ratio of 2.57.0 : 1) at injection
rates of typically 2025 kg/min. and 1012 kg/min. is also resorted to when extremely low
levels of sulphur in hot metal (circa 0.010%) are required. The use of magnesium granules helps
to reduce the injection time as well as the slag volume. Addition of lime/soda ash during
injection is also practised, when it is necessary to bring down the slag raking time or to reduce
the metal loss in the slag. External desulphurisation with such mixtures produces very dry slags,
in which substantial amount of metal as granules (below 3 mm) tend to get entrapped.
15
10 18
6
11
3
16 17
13
12
When a powder like calcium carbide is injected, using a carrier gas (nitrogen/argon), the gas
and calcium particles penetrate into the liquid hot metal as a gas particle jet until their
momentum is dissipated, which has been confirmed by water model studies. At the bottom of
the jet, a plume (photograph taken in room temperature model studies shown in Figure 16.7) is
created, where the gas forms spherical-cap bubbles, 20 to 100 mm in diameter. The physical and
chemical phenomena in the plume are shown schematically in Figure 16.8.
Lance S
Surface Product
layer control
dp S
H
Gas powder
Contact Pumping
liquid plume control
Dz Plume
boundary
S
Di
Figure 16.8 Physical representation of bubble formation and powder dispersion following injection.
300 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Owing to buoyancy the gas rapidly accelerates and the drag force between the gas and the
liquid causes the liquid to be accelerated as well. The carbide particles which are also buoyant
then start to risea fraction of the particles rise on the bubble interfaces, while the remainder
rises, dispersed in the melt. The particles and gas are heated as they rise, and the particles react,
resulting in the removal of sulphur. The rate of mass transfer is governed by the rate at which
sulphur-rich liquid is pumped into the plume by entrainment (normally termed pumping control)
as well as the rate at which sulphur diffuses through the boundary layers to the particles
(normally called contact control). The rate of desulphurisation with respect to time follows first
order reaction kinetics, and the rate of desulphurisation in the plume is determined by the
reduction of the sulphur content and the flow rate of liquid at the top of the plume.
Some typical results obtained in an operating unit are presented in Figure 16.9
(Pandey et al. 1996). It is clear that following calcium carbide injection, the kinetics of
desulphurisation can be described as first order, with respect to the sulphur content in the hot
metal. The first order rate constant is approximately proportional to the square root of the gas
flow rate, and the cube of the slag weight. Therefore, removal of slag to the maximum possible
extent prior to external desulphurisation, is extremely important.
100
90
80
Desulphurisation, %
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Reagent consumption, kg/thm
Reaction mechanism
When calcium carbide is injected into hot metal, it first decomposes to form calcium vapour and
a layer of graphite. The calcium vapour reacts with the sulphur in hot metal to form a layer of
calcium sulphide over the graphite layer. The effective diffusivity of calcium vapour through the
product layers is approximately 7 107 m2/s, which results in calcium fluxes much greater than
BOF Plant Practice 301
fluxes of sulphur through the boundary layers, around each particle. Therefore, the step of
calcium diffusion through the product layers does not contribute any significant resistance to the
overall rate of desulphurisation. The layers of graphite and calcium sulphide progressively
thicken so that the calcium vapour has to diffuse through them. These two layers are formed
topo-chemically on the surface of the particles, and the mass transfer resistance offered by the
chemical reaction rate is negligible. As a result, the rate of desulphurisation is relatively fast.
16.8.1 Desiliconisation
The blast furnace runner, transfer ladle or torpedo car can be used as the place for
desiliconisation as shown in Figure 16.10. The desiliconisation agent is added using one of the
following methods:
Top charging with nitrogen bubbling
Blasting
Injection.
*
Both blasting (very high rate of addition) or normal feeding can be applied
In Japan, desiliconisation of hot metal is carried out in the blast furnace runner because of
advantages, such as adequate mixing of the reagents owing to the energy of the flowing molten
iron stream, saving in time, and increased ladle availability compared with separate
302 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
desiliconisation in a ladle. Figure 16.11 shows a typical set-up that is often used for runner
desiliconisation, along with the results obtained (Gupta and Chatterjee, 1995). It needs to be
stressed that hot metal from blast furnace has to be separated from slag using a slag skimmer
in the main runner before desiliconising agents such as mill scale and calcined lime are added
Main runner
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6
Si before disiliconising, %
continuously. Only in this way can the reagent efficiency be increased. Normally, about 20 kg
mill scale per tonne of metal is needed to reduce the silicon level from 0.5% to less than 0.2%.
On the other hand, for reducing silicon from 1.5% to 0.6%, 3540 kg/thm is required. The heat
balance for runner desiliconisation, given in Table 16.3, indicates that there is no temperature
drop during this treatment even though it is carried out in an open runner (Gupta and Chatterjee,
1995). This is because of the heat generated by the oxidation of silicon to silica.
16.8.2 Desulphurisation
Previously, desulphurisation used to be carried out by injecting the desulphurising agent in
powder form into blast furnace ladles, en route from blast furnaces to steelmelting shops.
BOF Plant Practice 303
Nowadays desulphurisation stations normally form a part of the BOF shop. In a typical case of
reducing the initial sulphur content of hot metal from 0.070% to a level of 0.020%, i.e. a
desulphurisation efficiency of 70 75%, the operating parameters would be:
Reagent consumption: 5 kg/thm
Reagent rate: 45 kg/minute
Hot metal temperature: 1300C and more.
It is possible to complete the treatment in around 1520 minutes in most cases by adjusting the
reagent addition rate. For this purpose, sometimes even two lances are used as shown in
Figure 16.12 (Frithjof et al. 1980).
(b)
0
0.040 0.060 0.080
Initial sulphur cotnent, %
Figure 16.12 Consumption of calcium carbide as a function of the initial sulphur content in hot metal
using single-hole and multi-hole injection lances (final sulphur 0.015 %).
REFERENCES
Dutta, M., A. Ramu, M. Venkatraghavan and S. Roy, Tata Search, 1996, pp. 4346.
Frithjof, T., Eichinger, and Reinhold. K. Grosz, Scanjet II, 2nd International Conference on
Injection Metallurgy, Lulea, Sweden, Preprints, Jernkontoret, June, 1980.
Gupta, S.S. and Amit Chatterjee, Blast Furnace Ironmaking, SBA Publication, 1995.
Pandey, B.D., U.S. Yadav and R.V. Ramna, Tata Search, 1996, pp. 3642.
17
Metallurgical Features of
Oxygen Steelmaking
17.1 INTRODUCTION
Chapter 3 contained an outline of modern steelmaking processes as an introduction. Chapter 15
presented some important physicochemical aspects of primary steelmaking processes including
basic oxygen steelmaking (BOS). The description of BOF plant practices has been given in
Chapter 16. This chapter will deal with the metallurgical features of oxygen steelmaking
processes only. For the sake of logical presentation of this chapter, some important points from
the earlier chapters are reproduced below.
1. In the 1950s, the size of the LD converters was a maximum of 50 tonnes of liquid steel
and oxygen was top blown through a single-hole lance. With the passage of time, the
vessel size kept on increasing. Converters above 150 tonnes are very common now, and
many above 250 tonnes in capacity are in operation. This has necessitated increasing the
number of holes in the lance for better distribution of the total oxygen required for
refining. 5 6 hole lances are common nowadays and even 8 hole lances are in use.
2. Through extensive investigations in the 1960s, it was found that the molten metal bath
was not homogeneous with respect to temperature and composition during oxygen
blowing in BOFs, despite stirring by the top jet as well as vigorous evolution of CO gas
owing to the reaction of carbon in the bath with oxygen. It was also found that this
inhomogeneity was resulting in serious process control problems. Interestingly, it was
also found that simultaneous bottom gas injection, even at a very low flow rate, was
capable of homogenising the bath.
3. In continental Europe (France, Germany, Luxembourg, etc.), a significant fraction of hot
metal contains high phosphorus (1.52 wt. %). The classical BOF process was not found
suitable. Instead, variants of the original LD process (like, LDAC) were innovated to
refine high phosphorus hot metal by simultaneous blowing of lime powder and oxygen.
This resulted in engineering/environmental problems connected with lime fines and was
306
Metallurgical Features of Oxygen Steelmaking 307
not an acceptable long-term solution. The problem was resolved in late 1970s by the
introduction of specially designed bottom tuyeres through which oxygen could be
introduced directly into the bath. To take care of the heat generated in the tuyere area,
the inner oxygen tube had to be protected by shielding it with hydrocarbons. This
innovation gave rise to the OBM process in Germany, LWS in France and Q-BOP in the
USA.
In the decade of 1970s, several commercial processes were patented where oxygen was
blown through a top lance, but mixing in the bath was simultaneously enhanced by blowing inert
gas at a low flow rate through several bottom tuyeres. These processes, under the generic name
of combined blown processes/bath agitated processes, are the most widely used oxygen
steelmaking processes in the world today.
In this chapter, the metallurgical features of all oxygen steelmaking processes exclusive
top blowing, combined blowing and bottom blowing will be taken up.
Lance nozzle
Characteristic
supersonic core
Jet
Molten metal
Figure 17.1 Mechanical interaction of oxygen jet with the molten metal bath causing circulation in
the bath outwards on the surface and upwards along the axis (schematic).
308 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
The jet ultimately impinges on the liquid metal bath surface to form a cavity. The
impingement of the jet and the dissipation of the jet momentum causes circulation of the liquid
bath in the upward direction at the vessel central axis. The intensity of jet-bath interaction is
expressed in terms of the Jet Force Number (JFN) defined as:
Gas pressure (Pd ) Nozzle diameter (d n )
JFN = (17.1)
Lance height (L )
where L, the height of the lance tip above the bath surface, is a key operating variable in the
BOF process. With changing JFN (say, by changing L), the following behaviour of the liquid
bath at the impact zone has been observed.
At low JFN, dimpling with a slight surface depression (as in Figure 17.1)
At medium to high JFN, splashing with a shallow depression
At high JFN, penetrating mode of cavity with reduction in splashing.
Only the last two types of behaviour are usually encountered in BOF steelmaking. Metal
droplets are formed on the lip of the cavity and get ejected (i.e. splashed) above the bath in both
modes. Several empirical relations have been proposed co-relating the depth of jet penetration
into the bath with the variables Pd, dn, L, etc. They give somewhat different predictions and more
importantly, since they are generally for single-hole lance, and nowadays multi-hole lances are
employed, these relations cannot be directly applied to current oxygen steelmaking.
As stated earlier, for the larger size BOFs in use today, in order to distribute the oxygen over
a larger surface of the bath, multi-hole lances are employed. The axes of each of the nozzles in
a multi-hole lance are typically inclined at around 10 with respect to the lance axis. Figure 17.2
shows schematically the increase in jet impact area on the bath by switching over from a single-
hole to a three-hole lance.
Jet impact area
Three-hole
lance
Single-hole
lance
Lance height
Figure 17.2 Comparison of jet impact areas for single-hole and three-hole lance.
Metallurgical Features of Oxygen Steelmaking 309
dissolved in metal with oxygen. This leads to the formation of some CO2, particularly in regions
well above the bath. The exit gas from the BOF contains about 20 volume percent CO2 initially,
and about 5% towards the end of the blow.
This is known as post-combustion inside the converter. It is beneficial since oxidation of CO
to CO2 is also exothermic and supplies heat for the endothermic steps (see Chapter 15,
Section 15.2 for details). The jet also physically entrains the gases from the surrounding
atmosphere. As a result, by the time the oxygen jet reaches the impact zone, it contains some
amount of CO and CO2 and its temperature becomes higher.
4
wt. % C, Mn, Si
C
wt. % S wt. % P
3
0.02 2 0.2
S
P
0.01 1 0.1
Mn
Si
20 40 60 80 100
Blowing time, %
Figure 17.3 Change of bath composition with blowing time for 300 tonne BOF.
bottom stirring by inert gas using four symmetric bottom tuyeres. It was found that the
temperature of the bath gradually rises from 12501450C initially to about 16001680C at the
end of the blow essentially because of exothermic oxidation of Si, C and Fe. Silicon dissolved
in iron gets eliminated in the form of silica right from the start of the blow. Silicon is the first
element to get oxidised owing to the much higher stability of SiO2 as compared to the other
oxides. To make sure that this silica is assimilated in the slag as soon as it is formed (otherwise,
Metallurgical Features of Oxygen Steelmaking 311
it would attack the basic vessel lining), lime addition is also begun right from the start of the
blow. Once silicon is removed, oxidation of carbon dissolved in the bath to CO starts and
continues almost throughout the blow. Significant removal of phosphorus occurs primarily
towards the end of the blow.
Figure 17.4 (Deo and Boom, 1993) shows the change in slag composition during the blow
for the same converter. The temperature of the slag is always slightly higher than that of the
metalin the initial stages, the difference can be as high as 100C, but as the blow progresses,
50
CaO
40
FeO
Oxide in wt. %
30
SiO2
20 MnO
10
0
0 20 40 60 80 100
Blowing time, %
Figure 17.4 Change of slag composition with blowing time (for the same converter as in
Figure 17.3).
the difference decreases, till at the end of the blow, the slag temperature is around 3050C
higher. Often at the end of the oxygen blowing period in combined blown converters (like in
Hoogovens), about two minutes of argon stirring is carried out to bring down the temperature
difference. Post-blow stirring not only helps in temperature/composition homogenisation, but can
contribute significantly towards dephosphorisation since the slag at this stage is rich in FeO and
has high basicity. Figure 17.4 also depicts how the concentration of CaO in the slag increases
continuously during the blow because of progressive dissolution of lime. The FeO concentration
in the slag is initially high when the slag volume is limited, but as the blow progresses and more
and more slag is formed, the FeO concentration goes down. Towards the end of the blow, the
CO reaction subsides and oxygen begins to react with iron in the bath (rather than carbon)
leading once again to higher concentration of FeO in the slag.
It is to be understood that the quantity of slag, which is nil at the beginning, keeps increasing
during the blow as lime dissolution continues. The total amount of lime used depends primarily
on the silicon content in hot metal so that a CaO/SiO2 ratio of at least 3.0 is maintained in the
final slag to ensure adequate refining of the metalloids. The extent of lime added can be
60 70 kg/tls for 0.5 0.7% silicon hot metal and as high as 100 kg/tls for hot metal with around
1.2% silicon.
312 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
40 50 40 50
50 40 50 40
II A
60 60 30
30
I B B
70 70 20
20
A
Figure 17.5 Changes in composition of slag during oxygen blowing for various BOF steelmaking
practices.
Lime particles having a larger volume fraction of pores are more reactive, and dissolve
faster than less porous lime, since the slag is able to penetrate into the pores with
consequent increase in the surface area for reaction, and the particles tend to disintegrate
into smaller sizes owing to such penetration as well as the lower strength of porous lime.
If CaCO3 is calcined at a lower temperature for a longer time it is more porous. However,
too low a temperature and/or too short a time of calcining results in a lime containing
unacceptable percentage of undissociated CaCO3.
The commonly accepted test for lime reactivity is the standard slaking test in which
water is added at room temperature and the rise in temperature is measured.
During dissolution of lime, a solid impervious high melting outer coating of dicalcium
silicate tends to form (see Figure 15.1). It is important to break this layer by fluxing
agents. FeO is a powerful agent. It reacts with dicalcium silicate and forms a low melting
CaO-FeO-SiO2 liquid. MnO has a similar effect.
Higher temperatures are expected to increase rate of dissolution as a general rule of
kinetics. However, it has been reported that lime sinters rapidly at 1600C and above,
making it dense and thus slowing down the rate.
The final BOF slags have been found to contain some undissolved CaO particles, both
free as well as with a coating of dicalcium silicate. The content of free CaO can range
between 5% and 10% of the slag weight, in some cases.
0.3
0.1
0
0 5 10 15 20 25
Oxygen blowing time, min
Figure 17.6 Change of decarburisation rate during oxygen blowing in BOF steelmaking (schematic).
0.5
dt
0
100 200 300
Specific oxygen rate, nft3/min/net ton hot metal
Figure 17.7 Peak (steady state) decarburisation rate as a function of specific oxygen blowing rate.
The emulsion in basic oxygen converters also contains a significant proportion of liquid
metal droplets. The impingement of the jet on to the bath surface causes splashing of metal
droplets as already mentioned in Section 17.2.1. It is further enhanced by the ejection of droplets
following vigorous evolution of CO. Though estimates vary over a wide range, it is generally
agreed that the slagmetalgas emulsion may contain as much as 80 weight per cent metal.
Therefore, in reality, the oxygen jet in BOFs is surrounded by the emulsion during a major part
of the blow. This is schematically shown in Figure 17.8.
Oxygen
Gas
Slag
Metal droplet
Slagmetalgas
Gas bubble
Metalslag
Metal Metaloxygen
As Figure 17.6 shows, towards the end of the blow, the decarburisation rate decreases
continuously and becomes almost zero. The emulsion collapses. It has been concluded that it
happens below a critical carbon concentration in the bath (may be taken as 0.3 wt. % as an
average), and mass transfer of carbon in the bath becomes rate controlling. Since,
d [WC]/dt is proportional to [WC] in such a situation, the rate becomes almost zero at very low
carbon levels.
EXAMPLE 17.1
Calculate the total interfacial area of metal droplets in the slagmetal emulsion at steady state
(i.e. peak) decarburisation period of a BOF blow. Do the calculation for 1 tonne of liquid steel
in the bath.
Assume:
(i) The emulsion contains 7% of bath metal as droplets.
(ii) The droplets of metal are spherical.
(iii) The size distribution of the droplets are as follows.
Diameter (d) , mm 0.2 1 2 5 10
Fraction of total number (N) of droplets 0.05 0.2 0.5 0.2 0.05
(Note: Actually droplet size distribution is governed by probability; the above distribution data
is for simplification.)
17.5.1 General
As mentioned in the Introduction (see Section 17.1), in the BOF process, the molten bath is not
homogeneous with respect to composition and temperature owing to inadequate mixing, and it
was found that simultaneous gas injection through the bottom tuyeres even at a low flow rate
was capable of satisfactory bath homogenisation. It was also mentioned there that several
commercial basic oxygen processes were developed by various steel companies around the
world in the decade of 1970, all of which had provisions for some gas blowing through tuyeres/
canned elements/porous plugs fitted at the bottom of the BOF vessels.
Metallurgical Features of Oxygen Steelmaking 317
Better mixing and homogeneity in the bath offer the following advantages:
1. More reliable temperature measurement and sampling of metal and slag, and thus better
process control
2. Less slopping, since non-homogeneity causes formation of regions with high
supersaturation and consequent violent reactions and ejections
3. Faster dissolution of the scrap added into the metal bath
4. Better mixing and mass transfer in the metal bath with closer approach to equilibrium
for [C][O]CO reaction, and consequently, lower bath oxygen content at the same
carbon content
5. Better slagmetal mixing and mass transfer and consequently, closer approach to slag
metal equilibrium, leading to:
lower FeO in slag and hence higher Fe yield
transfer of more phosphorus from the metal to the slag (i.e. better bath
dephosphorisation)
transfer of more Mn from the slag to the metal, and thus better Mn recovery
lower nitrogen and hydrogen contents of the bath.
Items (4) and (5) above assume greater importance for end-point control of composition and
temperature, since the emulsion collapses and bath stirring by CO evolution becomes less
towards the end of the blow. Then, stirring from the bottom makes significant contribution
towards enhancing the rates of reactions. In modern steelmaking practice, after the oxygen blow
is stopped, the vessel is tilted for temperature measurement and sampling (this is known as
turndown or first turndown). Then the vessel is made vertical again for about two minutes with
only argon flow through the bottom tuyeres. This assists in further homogenisation and closer
attainment of equilibria.
Chapter 4, Section 4.5 has briefly reviewed the relevant concepts of kinetics, mass transfer,
mixing and mixing time (tmix). From there it may be noted that:
more stirring more bath turbulence faster mixing and mass transfer lower tmix.
In general,
tmix = BP mf (geometry, vessel size) (4.63)
where P is specific stirring power. B and m are empirical constants. For a given vessel, therefore,
tmix P m (17.2)
Since P is proportional to the bottom gas flow rate Q,
tmix Qm (17.3)
where m has been found to range between 1/3 and 1/2.
Figure 17.9 (Baker et al. 1980) shows the variation of tmix with bottom gas flow rate per
tonne of metal for several bath agitated processes. The results are in conformity with the
variation expected from Eq. (17.3).
318 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
100
Chiba
Mizushima
75
Mixing time, sec
Arbed
50
Sumitomo Irsid
British Steel Corpn.
25
Q-BOP
0
.01 .05 0.1 0.5 1.0 5.0 10.0
3
Inert gas consumption, Nm /min/t
Figure 17.9 Mixing time as function of the bottom gas flow rate for some bath agitated processes.
The most common choice are processes where only inert gas (N2, Ar) are employed at
volumetric flow rates equal to 24% of the oxygen flow rate through the top lance. Indian steel
plants have also opted for such processes of combined blowing. The bottom gas is introduced
through the bottom tuyeres, ranging in number from 6 to 16, depending on converter size, and
Metallurgical Features of Oxygen Steelmaking 319
are generally arranged symmetrically around the central axis of the converter. Figure 17.10
shows some designs of the tuyere arrangements. In these processes, the operational features are
similar to classical LD steelmaking as detailed in Chapter 16. The additional features include:
Bottom gas flow schedule during oxygen blow
Post stirring by argon after turndown.
CO 8 mm < 4 mm 4 mm
Propane Propane
NG NG
O2 , CO2 ,
CO2, Ar, N2 O2 O2 + lime
Ar, N2
Figure 17.10 Some designs of tuyere channels for bath agitated steelmaking processes (schematic).
Since argon is relatively expensive, nitrogen is used as much as possible. However, the use
of nitrogen tends to increase the nitrogen content of steel, and this may adversely affect the
eventual steel quality. During the initial stages, large-scale generation and evolution of CO has
a flushing action because of which not much nitrogen is absorbed by the metal bath. However,
towards the end of the blow, the flushing action is less. It is at this stage that argon has to be
employed in the case of low nitrogen steels. Figure 17.11 (Tupkary and Tupkary, 1998) shows
the blow profiles for the combined blown BOF vessel at Tata Steel for hot metal silicon below
0.8% and above 0.8%.
4000 2400
Bottom gas 400 Bottom gas 400
3 3
1.5 flow rate Nm /h flow rate Nm /h
320 320
10 240 10 240
% %
90% 90%
1.0
1 4 8 12 16 1 4 8 12 15
Blow time, min. Blow time, min.
Figure 17.11 Blow profiles of BAP vessel at Tata Steel using six-hole lance.
1. The steel contained inordinately high levels of dissolved nitrogen, which adversely
affected the ductility, toughness and formability of the product.
2. Large volume of nitrogen in the converter exit gas resulted in considerable loss of heat.
This adversely affected the thermal balance in the converter and did not allow the
addition of large quantities of scrap.
Attempts were made to enrich the air with oxygen and raise its volume percent to as high
as 40%. However, this had disastrous adverse effects on the bottom refractory life, requiring
more frequent bottom repair/replacement. This occurred because the oxygen reacted with molten
iron at the tuyere tip forming liquid FeO, which raised the local temperature. Liquid FeO is also
very corrosive towards the refractory lining since it encourages the formation of low melting
compounds. Both these factors contributed to bottom failure.
Finally, through collaborative R&D efforts essentially in Germany, a novel design of tuyeres
was invented. It consisted of two co-axial stainless steel pipes, embedded in the magnesite
bottom. Oxygen was blown through the central pipe and some hydrocarbon gas (such as
propane) through the annular space between the inner and the outer pipe. The hydrocarbons
decomposed into carbon and hydrogen as soon as they came in contact with molten metal. Since
the process is endothermic, it cooled the region around the oxygen plume at the tuyere mouth,
thus providing protection to the tuyeres and the refractory bottom. This is known as thermal
shielding. Some local reduction of FeO by carbon and hydrogen provided additional protection
resulting in decreased lining wear by corrosion/erosion phenomena. This is chemical shielding.
The process was first commissioned at the Maximillianshutte Iron and Steel Co., Germany
in 1967, and hence, became known as the OBM process [Oxygen Bodenblasen (bottom blown)
Maximillianshutte]. In France, the LWS process was invented in 1969 where liquid hydrocarbon
was employed. Figure 17.12 shows the original OBM converter design along with its tuyere
arrangements. Asymmetric layout of the bottom turyeres as well as the converter conical top
Metallurgical Features of Oxygen Steelmaking 321
Tuyeres
Arrangement
of tuyeres
Shielding gas
or
Hydrocarbon
Oxygen mains
Figure 17.12 Original OBM converter and its tuyere arrangements, bath circulation indicated
(schematic).
section made charging and tapping convenient, when the converter is tilted. The operation is
similar to that of any normal LD, except that at end of the blow, nitrogen is bubbled through
the tuyeres for a few minutes for final bath homogenisation and better approach to reaction
equilibria.
As noted in Section 17.5.1, bottom blowing gives several advantages that were confirmed
when data from the OBM process were obtained. Therefore, this process generated worldwide
interest even for refining low phosphorus hot metal. US Steel Corporation and some other
companies installed OBM converters in their modernisation and expansion programmes. The
traditional Thomas converter shops in Europe also switched over to OBM or LWS.
Although hydrocarbon shielding considerably improved the bottom life, it was still
unsatisfactory compared with the LD process, where the life was much higher. Bottom
maintainance with so many pipes was also problematic. On the other hand, the commercial
hybrid refining processes developed in the decade of 1970s retained all the advantages of the LD
process and brought in significant improvements in terms of better bath mixing. Hence, from the
late 1970s/early 1980s, steel plants did not install any more bottom blown units and went for the
bath agitated refining processes.
Figure 17.13 (R. Baker et al. 1980) compares scrap dissolution rates with and without bath
agitation. Agitation speeds up dissolution. Table 17.2 (Baker et al. 1980) compares some key
Bath agitation
100
Scrap dissolved, %
80
60
Conventional
40
20
4 8 12 16 20
Process time, min
Figure 17.13 Scrap dissolution rates with and without bath agitation.
Table 17.2 Metallurgical parameters of some basic oxygen steelmaking processes (approximate
values)
metallurgical performance indices of LD, LBE and OBM processes. Figures 17.14(a), (b)
and (c) also show this comparison regarding variation of Fe (total) in slag, pct. [O] and pct. [Mn]
in bath as function of pct. [C] in bath.
It may be noted from Table 17.2 that out of the above, performance of the OBM is best,
followed by LBE. Superior performance of LBE over LD is due to bottom gas stirring. So far
as comparison of OBM with LBE is concerned, the explanation is more complex, since OBM
differs from LBE in two major respects, given below.
In OBM, bottom gas flow rate is much higher than that in LBE
LBE uses Ar/N2 as bottom gas, whereas OBM employs oxygen + hydrocarbon during
blow, and then N2 in post-blow.
Experiments at Hoogovens IJmuiden (Mink et al. 1993) have demonstrated beneficial effects
of increasing bottom inert gas flow rate on metallurgical performance. These are demonstrated
in Figure 17.15 (Mink et al. 1993) for Fe (total) in slag, Mn and P in metal. The figure shows
percent changes of values over the practice with only top oxygen blow.
Metallurgical Features of Oxygen Steelmaking 323
25 150
125
20
% Fe (total) in slag
100
3
% [O] 10
15 LD 75
LBE
50 LD
LD-OB (1) LBE
10
LB-OB (1)
LD-OB (2) 25
OBM OBM LD-OB (2)
0
0.04 0.08 0.12 0.16 0.20 0 25 50 75 100 125 150
3
[% C] [% C] 10
(a) (b)
35
LD-OB (1)
30 OBM
LD-OB (2)
25 LBE
2
[% Mn] 10
LD
20
15
10
5
0
20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160
3
[% C] 10
(c)
Figure 17.14 Variation of Fe (total) in slag, [O] and [Mn] content of bath as function of bath carbon
at turndown for some basic oxygen steelmaking processes.
Mink et al. obtained the following [C][O] relationship in molten steel before tapping from
the furnace:
Without bottom stirring, [WC] [WO] = 35 104
With efficient bottom stirring, [WC] [WO] = 20.5 104
At the LD-1 shop of Tata Steel, bottom stirring in converters was initiated in early 1980s
by four symmetric tuyeres and later by six symmetric tuyeres. In the decade of 1990s, when
LD-2 shop was commissioned, both LD-1 and LD-2 shops got fitted with eight symmetric
tuyeres. Water model studies found decrease in mixing time with each of these changes. Thus
eight bottom tuyeres had more efficient mixing than six tuyeres, and six tuyeres arrangement had
more efficient mixing than four tuyeres.
324 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
18
Fe -norm, wt. %
16
14
2+
12
0 0.01 0.02 0.03 0.04
(a)
3
Mn -norm, wt. % 10
260
240
220
200
2+
180
0 0.01 0.02 0.03 0.04
(b)
3
15
P-norm, wt. % 10
10
0
0 0.01 0.02 0.03 0.04
3 1 1
Bottom gas flow rate, Nm min t
(c)
Figure 17.15 Variation of Fe (total) in slag, [O] and [Mn] contents of bath as a function of bottom
inert gas flow rate.
Choudhary et al. (2005) evaluated phosphorus partition (L P) between slag and metal at
converter turndown for large number of heats at Tata Steel for each tuyere arrangement. The
ratio RP, as defined below, was employed for assessment.
LP
RP = (17.4)
LP (at equilibrium)
It may be noted that RP is a kinetic parameter.
At slagmetal phosphorus equilibrium, LP = LP (at equilibrium), and RP = 1. If kinetic
limitations do not allow attainment of equilibrium, then RP is lower than 1.
Figures 17.16 and 17.17 (Choudhary et al. 2005) show RP as function of turndown
temperature for various tuyere arrangements. Since the turndown slag contains some undissolved
lime particles and this is not determined in routine slag analysis data, two values of free lime,
viz. 0% and 10%, were assumed. Figures 17.16 and 17.17 show that with better mixing by
change of tuyere arrangements, RP values increased, i.e. dephosphorisation was more efficient.
These findings also are in conformity with evidences cited earlier.
Metallurgical Features of Oxygen Steelmaking 325
1
0.9 LD-2
1
0.9 LD-2
RP = (LP) actual/(LP) equilibrium
Figure 17.17 Comparison of dephosphorisation as in Figure 17.16 except that 10% free lime in slag
assumed.
Turkdogan (1996) has attempted to find out some relationships for various reactions at
converter turndown both for the bath agitated processes and OBM converters at US Steel
Corporation. These are respectively known as BOF and Q-BOP at US Steel Corp. These are
empirical relations and are related to some of the reactions discussed in Chapter 15, Section 15.4.
Some of them are noted below as useful guides for quantitative estimates.
1. For reaction: [C] + [O] = CO(g) (15.14)
EXAMPLE 17.2
For refining of steel in a bath agitated process, compare the statistical average plant data of
[WC] [WO] before tapping, with the equilibrium value of the same for a tapping temperature
of 1625C.
REFERENCES
Baker, R. et al., Ironmaking and Steelmaking, Vol. 7 (1980), p. 227.
Choudhary, S.K., S.N. Lenka and A. Ghosh, Tata Search, 2005, pp. 117124.
Deo, B. and R. Boom, Fundamentals of Steelmaking Metallurgy, Prentice-Hall International
(1993), p. 162.
Meyer, H.W., J. Iron & Steel Inst., June 1969, pp. 781789.
Mink, P. et al., Proc. European Oxygen Steelmaking Congress, VDEH, Dusseldorf (1993),
p. 65.
Tupkary, R.H. and V.R. Tupkary, An Introduction to Modern Steelmaking, 6th ed.,
Khanna Publishers, New Delhi (1998), p. 336.
Turkdogan, E.T., Fundamentals of Steelmaking, The Institute of Materials, London (1996),
p. 218.
18
Process Control for Basic
Oxygen Steelmaking
18.1 INTRODUCTION
Steel is made in the BOF process at a very fast rate and a key concern is, therefore, the exact
determination of the blowing endpoint. Rapid changes in the temperature and chemical
composition of the steel bath during oxygen blowing complicate predictions, and direct
continuous measurements that are reliable are not possible in many cases even today. In
conventional BOF steelmaking, the steel temperature and composition are measured at the end
of the heat on the basis of steel samples withdrawn from the bath. This involves an interruption
in the steel production process and a corrective oxygen re-blow is usually required leading to
a loss in production and disruption in production scheduling. Today, process optimisation
systems (Level 2) are available and can be applied to supervise and control BOF operations,
starting from the ordering of hot metal and scrap to the alloying during tapping. Process tracking
modules and the generations of set points are based on predefined production practices, and on
the results from different process models that are activated according to the ongoing treatment
phase. The required material quantities and compositions, the time when they are to be charged
into the converter, as well as the exact volume of oxygen to be blown are calculated to produce
a heat in accordance with the production plan, and which satisfies the specific steel grade
requirements.
before tapping. During the blow, the vessel would have to be similarly tilted to check the actual
progress of the blow, in terms of the prevailing bath temperature and composition at that instant
of time. Corrections in temperature would be carried out by either making additions of iron ore
or scrap to cool the bath, or heat it by further re-blowing, which would also be the method of
adjusting the bath composition. The latter was more time consuming since chemical analysis of
the samples by spectroscopy in a separate laboratory meant the loss of several minutes. Re-blows
to adjust temperature/composition thus caused loss of production and had other adverse effects
like lower lining life. Despite intermediate sampling/temperature check (s), often the temperature
and/or the composition of the steel at the end of the blow would finish outside the desirable
tolerance limits. This resulted in off-grade heats.
Following the advent of digital computers, it became possible to carry out fast quantitative
calculations before/during the blow for a given set of endpoint conditions. Mathematical models
were developed for calculating the initial charge mix, quantities of flux additions during the blow
and the total oxygen that had to be blown. Such attempts were initially based exclusively on
mass and heat balances. Later, further refinement became possible by incorporating statistically
fitted process parameters, as well as slagmetal equilibrium relationships. A large variety of such
mathematical models is in use in steel plants and is known as Static Models.
In such an approach, the aim is to make all the predictions before the commencement of the
blow. How well it is followed during the progress of the blow is left to the operator and his
judgement. This type of control is known as Static Control; the specific objective of which is
to control the endpoint (i.e. at blow-end) temperature and carbon content of the bath. If it is
carried out correctly, there is no need for further re-blowing or for any additions. Although other
elements such as phosphorus, nitrogen, etc. are important, quantitywise they are very small,
particularly in proportion to carbon. Therefore, elimination of carbon essentially determines the
process time.
Static control by using computers improved the hit-rate of endpoint temperature and carbon
significantly. As a result, static models have become an integral part of all basic oxygen
steelmaking shops. How accurate an estimate such models can provide of the conditions of the
bath at the end of the oxygen blow depends on the following factors:
Accuracy of the model
Accuracy of inputs to the computer system
Consistency of steelmaking practices and quality of materials used
Reliability of the sensors/measuring devices.
It needs to be emphasised that there are many variables which influence the rates of reactions
in BOFs and some of these variables are difficult to control. Consequently, two heats with
apparently identical inputs and blowing conditions may not finish with the same carbon and
temperature. In scientific terminology, therefore, BOF steelmaking is a Stochastic Process. Some
important sources of irreproducibility from heat-to-heat are:
(a) Errors in weighing the charge and assessing the oxygen flow rate; for example, for a
300 tonne converter, it has been estimated that a small error in hot metal weighing can
affect the final output appreciably:
Process Control for Basic Oxygen Steelmaking 329
carrying pipe, lance vibrations during the blow, etc. The intensity of these variations is
influenced by the volume of the emulsion formed, the rate of decarburisation, slopping tendency,
etc. Many modern converter shops use the trend in these variations as a means of controlling the
entire blow; for example, sonic meters are used to gauge the extent and height of the slagmetal
emulsion during the blow to get an idea of the rate of decarburisation and the amount of residual
carbon in the bath along with the slag characteristics. The other methods can also provide similar
information.
These are general features of the strategy and practice used for BOF process control, some
specific details of which are given later. For general review, the book by Williams (1983) may
be consulted.
EXAMPLE 18.1
Using the data and calculations of the BOF heat in Examples 15.1 and 15.2 of Chapter 15, carry
out heat balance calculations to determine the temperature of liquid steel at the end of the blow.
Make further assumptions as follows:
(i) Basis of calculation: 1 tonne of steel as in Examples 15.1 and 15.2
(ii) Reference temperature = 298 K
(iii) Hot metal temperature = 1275C = 1548 K; scrap, lime and oxygen inputs are at
298 K
(iv) Final temperatures of liquid steel and slag are equal; also slag contains 2 wt% P2O5
(v) Heat loss by radiation, conduction and exit gas is 10% of the heat input.
Solution: Process heat balance calculations are long. They require extensive data and can be
properly solved only by computer-oriented numerical method and iterative procedure. Therefore,
many simplifying assumptions need to be made. Some have been listed already and the rest will
be mentioned as they come.
From material balance calculations of Examples 15.1 and 15.2, it can be noted that per tonne
of steel:
WHM = 975 kg, Wscrap = 97.5 kg, Wslag = 130 kg, O2 required = 41.7 Nm3
Heat Balance: Heat Input = Heat Output + Heat Loss (Ex. 18.1)
Sensible heat input by (HM + scrap + CaO + O2) + Heats of oxidation of (C + Si + Mn +
Fe + P) Endothermic heats of melting of scrap and CaO = Sensible heats of liquid steel and
slag at final temperature T + Heat loss. (Ex. 18.2)
332 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Since heat loss is 10% of heat input, Eq. (Ex. 18.1) may be rewritten as:
0.9 heat input = heat output (Ex. 18.3)
Since, scrap, CaO and O2 inputs are at 298 K, sensible heat input is only through hot metal.
Table 15.2 gives some sensible heat data. Assuming that the sensible heat of HM is the same
as liquid Fe,
Sensible heat of HM = 975 (1/56) 103 [40.95T + 0.837 103 T 2 2805] joules
= 109 107 J = 109 104 kJ
Sensible heat of liquid = (1/56) 103 [1000(40.95T + 0.837 103 T 2 2805)
steel and slag + 130 (48.85T + 2.26 103 T 2 + 6.73 105 T 1 16957)]
= 843.8T + 20.2 103 T 2 + 15.1 105 T 1 8.945 104 kJ
(Ex. 18.4)
[Note: Sensible heat of slag has been assumed to be equal to that of CaO in the above equation]
Endothermic heats of melting = (1/56) {Wscrap 13807 + WCaO 79534} = 12.37 104 kJ,
where the values of heats of melting are in J/mol.
Exothermic heats of oxidation of elements
On the basis of Example 15.2, it is possible to calculate the number of kg moles of elements
oxidized (ni). Values of standard heats of formation of these oxides(DHf0) are available in
Table 15.1.
For C CO reaction, n = (1000 0.033 0.9)/12 = 2.475 kg mol.
Calculations for other reactions with similar procedure give 0.275, 0.348, 0.325, 0.044,
0.034 kg mol for C CO2, Si SiO2, Fe FeO, Mn MnO, P 1/2 P2O5.
Total heat evolved = Sni (DHf0)i = 85.68 104 kJ (Ex. 18.5)
Estimation of final temperature (T) of steel and slag
0.9[109 + 85.68 12.37] 104 = 843.8T + 20.2 103 T 2 + 15.1 105T 1 8.945 104
As first approximation, ignore the T2 and T1 terms. Then, from the above equation, T = 2046 K.
In the next approximation, including the T 2 term too, the trial and error solution gives
T = 1960 K = 1687C.
Dynamic models contain all the features of static models; and in addition have terms for
reaction kinetics and process dynamics. The possible approaches include the following.
(i) Instantaneous equilibria amongst the reacting phases may be assumed, i.e. the process is
treated as being thermodynamically reversible. However, this is not very commonly
followed, since the BOF reactions are far away from equilibrium, except at the end of
the blow.
(ii) Reactions are assumed to be mass transfer controlled. Having made this assumption, it
is possible to adopt different levels of sophistication. This has been attempted in the past,
but it has been found that in view of the complexity of the BOF process, it is not
worthwhile to go in for a very high degree of sophistication. Instead, it is preferable to
treat the reactions as first order, and adjust the coefficients obtained by statistical fitting
of plant data.
(iii) After silicon is oxidised, the major oxidation reactions are those of carbon and iron. In
the case of fully dynamic control, the rate of decarburisation as well as the amount of
oxygen consumed by carbon is continuously determined from the exit gas data. This
allows computation of the rate of iron oxidation as well.
DC drive
Counter weight
H2O + N2 hoses
Lance guide
Manipulator
Magazine
Probe
Slag scratcher
Lance
seal gate
Lance socket
Oxygen
lance
Sublance in
measuring position
4 wire connector
Aperture
(protected by steel cap)
Pt/Pt Rh thermocouple
in quartz tube for steel
temperature measurement Aluminium protection cap
1 h
O (18.4)
O 2 (g) = [O]wt% ; KO = 1/2
2 ( pO2 ) eq.
h
So, mO2 (steel) = RT ln pO2 (steel) = 2RT ln O (18.5)
KO
Here, hO is the activity of dissolved oxygen in one wt. per cent standard state, and KO is the
equilibrium constant. Since mO2 (reference), and KO are known as a function of temperature, from
measurements of T and EMF, mO2 (steel) and hO are determined. From hO, the wt. % O is
determined.
Cook et al. (1993), have presented a comprehensive coverage of the semi-dynamic control
of the BOF adopted at Armco Steel Corporation, USA.
EXAMPLE 18.2
(a) Upon immersion of a CELOX oxygen sensor into a bath of molten steel at 1600C, the
EMF (after correction of thermo-EMF) was 0.10 volt. Calculate wt. % dissolved
oxygen in the melt.
(b) Assuming [Al] [O] Al2O3 equilibrium, calculate wt. % dissolved aluminium in the
bath.
Ignore all interactions.
Solution: From Eq. (18.1), mO2 (liquid steel) mO2 (reference) = ZFE = 4FE
In Chapter 4, Table 4.1 gives the value of DG 0f for formation of Cr2O3(s). Noting that DG0f
per mole of O2 is 2/3 of that, and at 1873 K, from Eq. (18.3),
mO2 (ref) = 434.13 103 joules per mole of O2.
For reaction 18.4, Table 4.2 gives the value of DG0 = 117150 2.89T J/mol.
Process Control for Basic Oxygen Steelmaking 337
(a) Inserting the above values in Eq. (18.1), and solving, it is possible to get
[WO] = 0.008 wt. %, [WAL] = 2.2 104 wt %.
(b) From Chapter 20, Table 20.2, different values at 1873 K can be obtained.
For the reaction, 2[Al]wt. % + 3[O]wt. % = Al2O3(s), KAl ={[WAl]2. [WO]3}eq. = 2.51 1014.
This gives the wt. % dissolved Al in liquid steel as 8.94 104 wt. % (i.e. 8.94 ppm).
t
DmC
DmC = rC dt; DWC =
msteel
100 (18.8)
0
where t is the time from the start of the blow. In a similar way, the oxygen going out with carbon
can be computed.
It needs to be recognised that precise determination of DmC and DmO pose several difficulties
owing to the following reasons:
Dust laden and hot gas
Non-uniformity in gas composition and temperature across the duct
Leakages to and from the surrounding atmosphere.
Suppose, WC,i = 3.2%, DWC = 3.0%. Then, WC = 0.2% from Eq. (18.6). If the measurement has
5% error in DWC, which is 0.15%, then actual WC = 0.2 0.15%, which is a significant error
band. That is the reason why sub-lance based measurements towards the blow-end are a must.
Tani et al. (1993) have discussed the dynamic control of BOF at the Kashima Steel Works,
Japan.
100
140
90 Lance height (cm + 100)
3
80 120 Oxygen flow rate (Nm /min*10)
3
Bottom flow rate (Nm /h*10)
70
100
Sonic meter, %
Sonic meter, %
60 Lmax
80
50
40 60
Lance height
30
40
20 Lmin Oxygen flow rate
20
10 Bottom flow rate
0 0
0 2000 4000 6000 0 2000 4000 6000
3 3
Oxygen, Nm Oxygen, Nm
It is important to mention here that automation and control systems require capital
investment that is best made at an opportune time. The facilities provided require regular
maintenance and their operation also calls for meticulous attention to the adoption of proper
procedures in order to limit the operating expenditure (carbon/temperature/oxygen probe
cassettes are fairly expensive). The extent of utilisation of these tools in a BOF shop also
depends on factors like the consistency of input materials, state of standardisation of operating
practices, etc.
REFERENCES
Beneini, C. et al., Proc. European Oxygen Steelmaking Congress, VDEH, Dusseldorf (1993),
p. 137.
Bosworth, C.J.A., in Determination of Chemical Composition, Iron & Steel Inst., London,
Special Report 131 (1971), p. 81.
Cook, S.R., J. Mori and R. Savson, Proc. European Oxygen Steelmaking Congress, VDEH,
Dusseldorf (1993), p. 80.
Kostersitz, F. et al., Steelmaking Conference Proceedings, Iron and Steel Soc., Washington D.C.
(1986), pp. 579586.
Tani, J.I. et al., Proc. European Oxygen Steelmaking Congress, VDEH, Dusseldorf (1993),
p. 89.
Turkdogan, E.T., Fundamentals of Steelmaking, The Institute of Materials, London (1996).
Williams, R.V., Control and Analysis in Iron and Steelmaking, Butterworths Publishers, London
(1983), Chapter 7.
19
Basic Open Hearth and Electric
Arc Furnace Steelmaking
341
342 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Silica sand
Slag breaker
tunnel Steel support
Insulating Grain
Silica brick magnesite
block
may be tilted (for tilting the furnace during tapping of liquid steel). The hearth of the furnace
is made of steel plates (typically 25 mm thick). Different layers of refractories are laid on the
steel shell to form the hearth bottomfirst fireclay bricks, then magnesite bricks, and finally a
layer of fritted burnt magnesite (1030 mm). The main roof of BOH furnaces is made of basic
bricks like chrome-magnesite or magnesite-chromite, while in acid furnaces, silica bricks are
used.
Charging, observations of the bath during heat making as well as sampling are carried out
through the doors provided on the front wall of the furnace, which can be opened or closed by
lifting vertically, whenever required. These front doors, located over the entire length of the
furnace are also used for fettling the hearth (adding fresh granules of refractory materials like
magnesite) at the end of each heat as well as for furnace maintenance. Tapping of molten steel
is done through a tap hole located on the back wall of the furnace (opposite side of the doors).
The back wall also contains one or two holes that can be used for flushing out the slag during
the course of heat making. This facility is particularly useful in large capacity furnaces so that
slags can be tailor-made, as per refining requirements (for example, dephosphorisation). This is
a unique advantage of open hearth steelmakingtime consuming, but essential for producing
high-quality steels even from inferior inputs.
The furnace operating temperature is around 1650 1700C, which cannot be obtained by
combusting the fuel with cold air. Therefore, pre-heated air is normally used in the burners for
the combustion of the fuel (fuel oil/coke oven gas/blast furnace gas/producer gas). Preheating of
air to about 1000C is carried out in regenerators containing a checker work (mesh) of
firebricks. The regenerator consists of fire bricks arranged in such a way that the bricks fill about
75% of the total volume and gas flows through the empty regenerator space around the bricks.
The brick lattice, i.e. the checkerwork, absorbs heat from the outgoing gases, and this heat is
used to pre-heat cold air to 1200 1300C. Figure 19.2 shows the regenerator arrangement. In
the first cycle, air and fuel flow through the right-hand side. The hot products of combustion at
about 1600C pass through the regenerators on the left-hand side, thus heating up the refractory
checkerwork. The direction of flow is reversed in the second cycle; each cycle lasting about
30 minutes.
First cycle Second cycle
Checkers Checkers
(a) (b)
Figure 19.2 Heat regeneration system in an open hearth furnace: First cycle: checkers on left being
heated by hot flue gas; checkers on right giving heat to incoming air, Second cycle:
reverse of first cycle.
344 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
It may be noted that an open hearth shop is a fairly huge engineering structure equipped with
many furnaces, regenerators, waste heat boilers (to recover heat from the exit gases) and
instrument panels essentially for thermal control.
tapping, some deoxidisers are added into the bath in order to lower the bath oxygen content as
well as for minor alloying. Tapping is carried out by physically opening the tap hole at the centre
of the back wall of the furnace by oxygen lancing.
Slag
Metal
CO
[O] + [C]
Bubble
CO
Hearth
Figure 19.3 Mechanism of oxygen transfer from the gaseous atmosphere to the liquid metal bath
in open hearth furnaces.
Dissolved carbon in the metal bath reacts with dissolved oxygen to generate carbon
monoxide bubbles. The passage of these bubbles through the bath provides the stirring necessary
for enhancing heat and mass transfer rates required for speeding-up all the reactions, as well as
for guaranteeing adequate mixing/homogenisation. The formation of bubbles requires nucleation
and growth. While growth does not require much supersaturation, theoretical calculations
indicate that a pressure of CO as high as 104 atmospheres is required for homogeneous
nucleation of the gas bubbles. Since such high thermodynamic super saturation simply does not
exist in the bath of open hearth furnaces, at first there was considerable debate with regard to
the reaction mechanism. The puzzle was resolved when it was demonstrated that the tiny
crevices/pores in the hearth refractory lining serve as growth sites, which allows the nucleation
346 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
stage to be bypassed completely. This phenomenon also restricts the depth of the metal bath in
BOH furnaces, both from the point of view of rapid heat transfer and acceptable rates of
reactions.
19.2.1 General
There are basically two types of electrically-heated melting furnaces:
Electric arc furnace (EAF)
Induction furnace (IF).
Induction furnaces are employed for steelmaking only on a relatively very small scale since the
furnace size varies from 0.5 t to maximum of 20/25 t per heat, with most furnaces below 5 t.
Hence, IFs are used to a limited extent. On the other hand, arc furnace steelmaking is widely
used and about 35% of worlds steel is produced by EAFs at present (the rest by basic oxygen
steelmaking), which is expected to become 50% in the next 1015 years. The history of EAF
steelmaking is marked by continuous improvements in efficiency and productivity. A method
that was started in a small way about 100 years back principally for the production of alloy
steels, later found widespread application in the production of all types of steels. While earlier
EAFs were mostly between 10 t and 50 t, today 200 250 t EAFs are common and 400 500 t
EAFs are available.
The advantages of EAFs for alloy steelmaking include:
Relatively small size
Cleaner environment
Flexibility to produce a variety of grades
Precise control.
Basic Open Hearth and Electric Arc Furnace Steelmaking 347
Initially, for the bulk production of plain carbon steels, open hearth furnaces were less expensive
because of their large size as well as the higher cost of electricity. All these started to change
from around 1970, because of the following.
(i) While the cost of liquid fuels started increasing, electricity generation costs became
lower and electricity became comparatively cheaper.
(ii) Larger and higher power EAFs could be installed because of the progress in electrical
engineering and control systems.
(iii) EAF steelmaking is intrinsically cleaner than open hearth steelmaking.
(iv) Since EAF steelmaking is predominantly scrap based, smaller plants with lower capital
investment and faster attainment of rated capacity could be set up, even compared to BF-
BOF based plants.
Therefore, EAFs started gradually replacing BOHs for producing plain carbon steels as well.
With EAFs ranging in size from 100 t to 250 t (and even 500 t), there are some plants around
the world which are producing 1.5 to 2 Mtpa of steel from 23 large electric arc furnaces. This
type of growth in EAF steelmaking has resulted in scrap shortage. This has been taken care of
by partial substitution of scrap by sponge iron (DRI/HBI) and, in some plants with additional
charging of cold pig and hot metal.
This chapter will cover the production of plain carbon steel in EAFs. Chapter 21 will
separately deal with the production of stainless steel. Many books are available on EAF
steelmaking: Electric Furnace Steelmaking, ISS; Making Shaping and Treating Steel, 11th ed.,
Vol. 2; book by Tupkary et al.
Electrodes
Burned
magnesite bricks
Silica bricks
Rammed magnesite
layer Rammed silica
Fireclay layer
(a) bricks
Figure 19.4 Cross section of an electric arc furnace (both acid and basic lining shown for illustration).
Shop roof
Crane
Cabin
Electrode for
joining
Electrode raised
Tapping position
Furnace Charging basket
(drop-bottom)
Slag
Broad best
operating range
A
kV
Powe
r fact
or
kVA, kW and power factor
Arc
volt
age
Voltage
Circu
it kW
Ar
ck
W
Current, amp
It should be mentioned here that whatever has been described above pertains to a
conventional furnace set up. Modern EAFs have retained most of the basic design with some
additional features that will be taken up later.
Through decades of efforts till about 1970, electric furnace steelmaking practices got
significantly standardised. This is what is denoted by the term conventionalit is practised even
now in smaller and relatively older units.
Section 19.1.2 has described the stages in heat making in basic open hearth furnaces. EAF
steelmaking involves most of those stages, with the exception of the following:
Hot metal is not used in conventional practice
The refining and finishing practices differ widely.
The basic purpose of refining in EAFs is two-fold:
Removal of undesirable impurities (C, Si, P, S, N, H, etc.)
Finishing the bath so as to ensure maximum alloy recovery.
Chapter 15 has discussed the reactions in primary steelmaking and their physicochemical
aspects. Chapter 5 focused on the reactions of silicon and sulphur, and hence need not be
repeated. EAFs produce a wide variety of steels. Therefore, depending on the type of the solid
metallic charge and the grade of steel to be produced, the refining practice differs considerably.
The type of refining employed may be broadly classified into the following.
Oxidising single slag practice: It is employed to produce tonnage grades of carbon and low
alloy steels, as well as non-deoxidised, semi-deoxidised and deoxidised steel. The physical and
chemical specifications are not very stringent, i.e. the quality of steel is similar to what is
attainable in open hearths using a basic oxidising slag as the medium of refining.
Double slag practice: In this case, after refining using an oxidising slag, further refining is
carried out under a reducing slag. The reducing slag allows attainment of lower sulphur levels
and also assists in higher alloy recovery after tapping. In this practice, the original oxidising slag
can be modified by the addition of reducing agents; however, it gives rise to danger of reversion
of phosphorus from the slag back into the metal (see Chapter 15). To preclude this possibility,
generally the oxidising slag is completely removed and fresh reducing slag is made by charging
lime, fluorspar and silica. The reducing agent may be graphite or coke breeze. This type of slag
is commonly referred to as carbide slag, since the carbon added reacts with CaO to form some
amount of CaC2. Carbide slags do not allow very low carbon contents to be attained in the bath;
in such cases, ferrosilicon is used as the reducing agent instead of carbon. The typical
compositions of slag are shown in Table 19.1.
At this stage, it is worth noting some salient differences in the metallurgical features of basic
open hearth and EAF steelmaking. These are noted below.
Basic Open Hearth and Electric Arc Furnace Steelmaking 351
1. Since EAF steelmaking is primarily scrap/DRI based and both these materials have
relatively low levels of residual impurities, the extent of refining is much less than in
BOH steelmaking.
2. As a process, EAF is far more versatile than BOH and can make a wide range of steel
grades.
3. Sorting out of scrap and choosing the proper scrap grade are important for EAF
steelmaking, since the extent of refining has to be managed accordingly. For this
purpose, scrap may be classified into the following categories:
(a) scrap containing clements that cannot be removed by oxidation during refining,
such as Cu, Ni, Sn, Mo, W, etc.
(b) scrap containing partially oxidisable elements, such as P, Mn , Cr, etc.
(c) scrap containing completely oxidisable elements, such as Al, Si, Ti, V, Zr, etc.
(d) scrap containing volatile elements, such as Zn, Cd, Pb, etc.
Scrap of type (b) and (c) can be tackled easily during refining. Type (d) scrap would
require some special attention. However, type (a) scrap gives rise to problems like
undesirable residuals in the final steel. This is where DRI scores over scrapit is totally
free from all the above undesirable elements.
4. In BOH steelmaking, refining begins with the bath containing about 1% excess carbon
(often referred to as the opening carbon) in order that evolution of CO following the
oxidation of carbon provides the necessary agitation for homogenisation of the bath as
well as for enhancing the reaction rates. In EAF steelmaking also, the initial bath carbon
is maintained at about 0.3% above the final carbon specification during oxidising
refining. However, stirring is absent during refining under a reducing slag, and some
other stirring technique (use of mechanical stirrers called rabbles) is required.
Introductory comments
Recent developments in EAF steelmaking have taken place primarily in the context of large-
scale production of plain carbon and low alloy steels. Of course, some of these developments
have also been implemented in smaller scale of operation as well as for the production of high
alloy steels, such as stainless steels. Besides a distinct trend towards increase in furnace size, the
important developments may be summarised as follows.
Ultra high power supply (UHP)
DC arc furnace
Oxygen lancing (in some cases along with carbon/coke breeze)
Use of water-cooled elements in the furnace shell, water-cooled electrodes, etc.
Foamy slag practice
Bath stirring by argon
Auxilliary secondary steelmaking facility
Use of sponge iron (DRI/HBI) to substitute scrap
352 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Specific developments
For the sake of concise presentation, the modern developments in specific areas are being
divided into the following groups.
(a) GROUP 1First six items of Section 19.2.4, i.e. UHP to foamy slag and argon stirring
(b) GROUP 2The next three items covering alternative charge materials.
(c) GROUP 3Other items like charge pre-heating, eccentric bottom tapping, emission
control and automation.
(a) GROUP 1
1. Transformers supplying power to electric arc furnaces have been classified as given
below.
Capacity in kVA per tonne steel
(i) Regular power, i.e. for old furnaces 100 400
(ii) High power 400 700
(iii) Ultra high power (UHP) above 700
Use of UHP enables faster melting of the solid charge, thereby decreasing the tap-to-tap
time with consequent increase in the production of steel. An EAF of 100 tonne capacity
will require a transformer capacity of above 70 MVA for UHP operations. It has been
possible to achieve such figures owing to major advances in electrical engineering in the
last few decades.
Another important development is the use of DC (direct current) in the furnaces. This
requires conversion of three-phase AC into single-phase AC supply, and after the step-
down transformer conversion of AC into DC. A DC arc has one electrode and the circuit
is completed through the conducting electrodes embedded in the furnace bottom. It offers
certain distinct advantages over three-phase AC arc, such as smoother arc operation, less
noise, etc.
Basic Open Hearth and Electric Arc Furnace Steelmaking 353
2. Oxygen lancing through a top lance gives certain advantages that include: oxidation of
carbon and some iron from the bath releasing chemical energy with consequent saving
of electrical energy as shown in Figure 19.7 (Kohle 2000); faster removal of carbon and
other impurities following faster slag formation and the generation of a foamy slag.
500
AC
DC TS
450
TS
400
BP SS
BP
DS
BP
TS
350
BP
SS
SS
300
10 20 30 40 50
Total oxygen consumption, Nm3/t
In large EAFs the top lance is supersonic, as in BOFs. For greater saving of electrical
energy, coke or carbon breeze is also injected along with oxygen in some plants.
Coherent jet lance design makes these injections more efficient and has been adopted in
some EAF shops.
3. Ultra high power input and oxygen/oxy fuel injection, with consequent higher
temperature in the arc zone, causes more heat losses. This tends to heat up the furnace
shell, the graphite electrodes as well as the connecting electrical cables, etc. thereby
causing damage to these parts. The concurrent use of a foamy slag helps in insulating
some areas thereby lowering the heat loss and providing protection to the electrodes and
other parts of the furnace.
Use of water-cooled shell panels and water cooling of electrodes, cables, etc. decrease the
consumption of refractories/electrodes.
Chapter 17, Section 17.4 introduced the concept of foams and emulsions in the context of
BOF steelmaking. These are applicable to the foaming of slags in EAFs as well. To summarise,
a slag foam is transient and is basically sustained by vigorous evolution of CO following the
reaction of bath carbon with oxygen. A foamy slag is actually an emulsion of metal droplets and
gas bubbles in slag. Higher slag viscosity and the presence of undissolved solid particles assist
foaming, which speeds-up slagmetal reactions, such as dephosphorisation. All modern EAF
shops have adopted foamy slag practice.
354 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
The subject of mixing and homogenisation of the bath in BOFs has been elaborately
discussed in Chapter 17. To help bath mixing, concurrent top and bottom blowing has been
adopted by all modern BOF shops. In large EAFs also the problem of mixing exists, to some
extent. Oxygen lancing and flow of current through the metal bath in DC arc furnaces induce
some amount of bath motion, which is sometimes insufficient. Better mixing in the bath is
desirable for all the advantages described in Chapter 17. Therefore, many modern EAFs are
equipped with bottom tuyeres for injection of argon, etc. (McIntyre and Landry, 1993).
(b) GROUP 2
For the production of plain carbon steels in electric arc furnaces, steel scrap constitutes the
principal metallic iron feed. With the growth of EAF steelmaking, the following problems were
faced with all scrap charge in EAFs.
(i) Technologically advanced countries, such as the USA originally had plenty of obsolete
scrap, the stock of which has gradually been coming down. Developing countries like
India and Brazil do not either have much obsolete scrap nor do they generate large
amounts of scrap. For charging into EAFs import of scrap at high cost to supplement
home scrap is necessary. Therefore, DRI usage as a substitute for scrap became
popular.
(ii) As mentioned earlier, some alloying elements are more difficult to oxidise than Fe,
such as Cu, Ni, Sn, Mo, W, etc. Hence, they cannot be satisfactorily removed during
steelmaking and are also known as tramp elements. One way of getting around this
problem is not to use scrap containing these tramp elements, but this is not always
economically viable. Substitution of scrap, partly or fully, by alternative iron sources
(AIS) is a solution, since these inputs do not contain tramp elements.
Many publications deal with the use of AIS, for example, Jones (2000) and Millman (1999).
Besides DRI, the other alternative iron sources are:
Hot briquetted iron (HBI), which is a dense, compacted form of DRI
Solid pig iron
Hot metal (i.e. molten pig iron).
Use of AIS is gaining popularity in EAF steelmaking. DRI/HBI is now the principal feed stock
next to scrap. In 2005, the worldwide DRI/HBI production was just over 56 million tonnes,
which was slightly more than 15% of the scrap consumption.
Solid pig iron and hot metal are also important AIS, constituting about 58% of the total
feed. In the case of EAF shops located inside an integrated steel plant, blast furnace hot metal
is available. Otherwise, hot metal can be produced either in a mini blast furnace or in a smelting
reduction unit. Both these have been used in EAF steelmaking, since hot metal charging
is advantageous from a thermal point of view being already molten and the oxidation of
its impurities provides chemical energy; 1 kg hot metal charge per tonne of steel saves
electricity by about 0.5 kWh/t
promotes foaming by the evolution of CO and gives all the advantages of a foamy slag.
Basic Open Hearth and Electric Arc Furnace Steelmaking 355
However, excess hot metal usage can prolong the refining time and give rise to uncontrolled
foaming. Therefore, it is recommended that hot metal charge is restricted to a maximum of
40 45% of the total charge and the best method of usage is to charge it continuously through
a side launder.
DRI/HBI has very low impurity content (i.e. P, Si, S, and, of course, the tramp elements)
[see Chapter 13, Sections 13.3 and 13.4] and hence does not require any additional refining time.
However, it is a porous material that tends to get severely oxidised in contact with moist air at
high temperature. Up to about 30% DRI (of the total charge) can be charged along with scrap
in buckets, if bucket charging is practised. First a layer of scrap, then DRI and then another layer
of scrap are used in each bucket. If continuous charging facilities for charging DRI throughout
the heat in small amounts are available, the proportion can be increased to 50 60% and
sometimes, even more. In all cases, HBI is preferred since it is dense and does not get oxidised
very readily.
With the use of DRI/HBI, melting and refining can proceed simultaneously. In some EAF
shop even up to 100% DRI is used by adopting what is known as the hot heel practice. Here,
molten steel from a previous heat is not tapped out completely and is allowed to remain in the
EAF to provide a liquid metal bath for DRI charging right from the beginning of the next heat.
Figure 19.8 shows the typical change of weight of metal in the furnace as a function of time
during an EAF heat for hot heel practice.
40
Melting complete
30
Charge wt., t
20
TAP
10 Continuous
Charging + Refining
Heal
Figure 19.8 Arc furnace operation with high percentage of DRI in the charge using hot heel practice.
The gangue in DRI consists principally of silica and alumina associated with the iron oxide
feedstock. For optimum usage in steelmaking, the gangue content should be as low as possible;
otherwise, large slag volumes and hence more lime addition are required. This has an adverse
effect on the consumption of energy. The percentage metallisation (i.e. the percentage of
metallic iron in the DRI as a percentage of total ironthe remaining iron is present as wustite)
should also be high to keep the energy consumption low. Typically, steelmakers prefer
metallisations between 92% and 96% (too high metallisation lowers the turbulence that is
induced in the bath when FeO in DRI reacts with the bath carbon).
During the production of DRI (particularly gas-based DRI) carbon in the form of iron
carbide gets absorbed in the final product. The carbon percentage in DRI depends on the process
of sponge ironmakingin coal-based processes it is about 0.10 0.15%, while in gaseous
reduction processes it can be varied anywhere from 1.5 to 4% depending on the customer
demand. Carbon in DRI lowers its melting point and when it reacts readily with any unreduced
iron oxide, CO is evolved, which contributes towards the formation of a foamy slag. This is
required for efficient steelmaking and hence, steelmakers prefer higher carbon containing DRI,
say above 1%. In case this amount of carbon is not available in DRI, additional carbon input
by injection of coke breeze along with oxygen becomes necessary. The addition of hot metal can
also provide a source of carbon.
(c) GROUP 3
Charge pre-heating: If the solid charge can be pre-heated, it can obviously reduce electricity
consumption. The economics would depend on the cost of pre-heating. Under normal
circumstances, scrap is charged into the furnace in cold condition and during the progress of the
EAF heat, vigorous evolution of CO and some amount of hydrogen takes place. This gas can
be an additional heat source by post-combustion of CO and H2, either in the furnace atmosphere
or above the furnace in a separate pre-heating chamber. The oxygen required can be supplied
by injecting pure oxygen at the appropriate location. Several systems of pre-heating within the
furnace chamber or in a separate vessel have been used in EAF steelmaking.
Separate pre-heating of DRI/HBI is difficult since it would oxidise. At the same time, since
it is at high temperature when it comes out of the reduction reactor, it is a matter of retaining
this temperature during the transport of DRI/HBI to the electric furnace. Several systems have
been reported in literature. One of the latest that has been developed by Midrex Corporation,
USA consists of conveying hot DRI through an insulated pipeline directly into the EAF shop and
then charging it with the aid of gravity. Essar Steel, India, has developed refractory lined
containers for transport. Using such techniques, it is possible to charge hot DRI at a temperature
of 600 700C, resulting in 10 15% power saving. As a result, use of pre-heated DRI/HBI has
become a standard practice in many EAF plants.
Eccentric bottom tapping: The primary steelmaking slag has iron oxide as well as P2O5. This
slag is undesirable for subsequent secondary steelmaking. In the case of basic oxygen furnaces,
most of the slag is retained in the vessel and not allowed to flow into the ladle during tapping
by the use of slag arresting devices (see Chapter 20). In modern EAFs, the bottom has been
made eccentric to achieve the same result. The eccentric part of the bottom is suitably covered
and insulated. During tapping, when the furnace is tilted, liquid steel primarily flows out it with
Basic Open Hearth and Electric Arc Furnace Steelmaking 357
very little slag and this metal can be tapped through a nozzle at the bottom of the eccentric
portion. Some liquid steel is retained in the furnace (hot heel practice). Therefore; the top slag
gets very little chance to escape into the ladle during tapping.
Noise control and emission: Day-by-day stricter norms are being formulated for noise control.
EAF steelmaking is prone to noisethe arc struck between the electrode and the solid charge
right at the beginning of each heat is the principal source of noise. Through improved circuit
design, arc control and use of DC arc, noise levels have been brought down significantly.
As far as emissions are concerned, the objectionable emissions from EAFs are:
Poisonous CO gas
Toxic NOx gas
Dust.
Post combustion of CO into CO2 is the solution as far as carbon monoxide is concerned. NOx
denotes a group of air pollutants that include: nitric oxide (NO), nitrogen dioxide (NO2) and
nitrous oxide (N2O). The principal component is NO, typically comprising 90% of the total NOx
emission. NOx gases are formed primarily by the reaction of atmospheric nitrogen with oxygen
at the high temperatures prevailing in the arc zone of EAFs. The most effective means of control
is to reduce the formation of NOx gases by preventing the ingress of air near the arc zone. This
can be achieved by using the foamy slag as a shield. The other options are to seal the furnace
as much as possible by keeping the doors etc. closed, and maintaining a slightly positive pressure
inside the furnace.
Huber et al. (2000) have elaborately discussed dust formation in EAFs. EAFs generate 15
to 25 kg of dust per tonne of steel. The dust comprises mostly spinel-type metal oxide (Fe, Zn,
Mn) O.Fe2O3, some vitreous phases (FexO + SiO2 + CaO glass) and ZnO. It is, therefore,
composed of elements/compounds coming from the steel bath as well as from the slag layer and
from volatiles. Zinc, for example, comes from scrap containing galvanised steel. Moreover, the
dust also contains small quantities of elements like lead, chromium and cadmium, which are
volatile as well as toxic. Although earlier steelmaking dust used to be considered as a process
waste, in recent times the higher cost of waste disposal and stricter environmental regulations
are leading steelmakers to switch to a co-product recycling strategy.
The mechanism of dust formation in EAFs is shown in Figure 19.9 (Huber et al. 2000). It
consists of:
Localised volatilisation in the arc zone (1) and oxygen zone (1)
Ejection of large droplets by CO bubbles and oxygen jet in the arc zone (2) and jet
zone (2)
Ejection of fine droplets by bursting of CO bubbles (3)
Fast decarburisation of fine particles in zone (4)
Direct fly-off of solid particles from the charge (5).
Literature has dealt comprehensively with the subject of emission control in EAF shops. The
emissions during the progress of any heat are known as primary emissions, which are the most
important. These emissions are taken out through a duct attached to an opening in the furnace
roof as shown in Figure 19.9. The dust-laden gases are cooled by mixing with cold air before
358 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Fume
extraction Graphite
system electrodes
4
5
1
1 Oxygen
lance
2 2
3 2
Steel bath
being passed through dust catchers, scrubbers, and electrostatic precipitators for the removal of
dust before the gas is let off into the atmosphere. The dust is collected in a pond as sludge, then
separated and used as a by-product for various purposes in a similar way as is done in blast
furnaces and BOF shops.
Secondary emissions are defined as those that are emitted during activities other than melting
or refiningi.e. during the periods of charging, tapping and slagging, and a result of leakages
through the furnace doors, etc. In order to handle these emissions, two systems are available:
installation of large canopy hoods above the furnace where these emissions can be
collected by suction
sealing the entire building and sucking the emissions out through the roof.
Process automation and control: In Chapter 18, various features of process control in basic
oxygen furnaces were presented. Elaborate control measures are used including systems such as
sub-lance, exit gas monitoring, sonic meter, dynamic and semi-dynamic control with feedback,
sensors like carbon sensor, oxygen, sensor, etc. The principal objective of process control in
BOFs is to attain the correct end-point, in terms of both carbon and temperature. The additional
objectives are to reduce phosphorus, oxygen and nitrogen in molten steel and iron oxide in the
slag to as low levels as possible. These objectives have to be achieved in the minimum possible
time and without the need for additional steps like reblowing, which has an adverse effect on
the final yield and converter lining life.
The same objectives are applicable to electric arc furnaces as well. However, the situation
is different, to some extent, as noted below.
(i) The EAF bath is accessible through the doors; hence, gadgets like sub-lance, etc. are not
required.
(ii) The extent of refining in EAF is relatively less in comparison to BOF because the former
is primarily a melting unit.
(iii) EAF steelmaking is not as fast as BOF.
Therefore, the metallurgical process control features in EAFs are far less elaborate.
Automation and control in EAFs are primarily restricted to:
Basic Open Hearth and Electric Arc Furnace Steelmaking 359
Table 19.2 Comparison of performance of AC EAFs between 1990 and 1999 (values are medians)
1990 were taken from a report prepared by the International Iron and Steel Institute, and the
corresponding 1999 data collected from several sources. Significant improvements may be noted
in all the key performance indices between 1990 and 1999. The data reveal that in this period:
Tap-to-tap time decreased from 105 to 70 min
Electrical energy consumption decreased from 450 to 392 kWh per tonne of steel
Graphite electrode consumption decreased from 2.9 to 1.9 kg per tonne of steel
Refractory consumption decreased from 6.9 to 3.1 kg per tonne of steel
Productivity increased from 61 to 94 t/h.
360 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
REFERENCES
Huber, J.C. et al., 58th Elec. Furnace Conf. Proc., ISS (2000), p. 172.
Jones, J.A.T., 58th Electric Furnace Conf. Proc., ISS (2000), pp. 691718.
Kohle, S., 58th Elec. Furnace Conf. Proc., ISS, Pittsburgh (2000), p. 5.
McIntyre, E.H. and E.R. Landry, Iron and Steelmaker, Vol. 20, May 1993, pp. 6166.
Millman, S., 57th Electric Furnace Conf. Proc. (1999), pp. 1525.
Trubin, K.G. and K.N. Oiks, Steelmaking Open Hearth and Combined Process, MIR Publishers,
1974.
Tupkary, R.H. and V.R. Tupkary, An Introduction to Modern Ironmaking, 3rd ed., Khanna
Publishers, Delhi, 1998.
20
Secondary Steelmaking
20.1 INTRODUCTION
Primary steelmaking is aimed at fast scrap melting and rapid refining. It is capable of refining
at a macro level to arrive at broad steel specifications, but is not designed to meet the stringent
demands on steel quality, and consistency of composition and temperature that is required for
various grades of steel. In order to achieve such requirements, liquid steel from primary
steelmaking units has to be further refined in the ladle after tapping. This is known as Secondary
Steelmaking.
Secondary steelmaking has become an integral feature of virtually all modern steel plants.
The advent of the continuous casting process, which requires stringent quality control is one of
the main reasons for the growth of secondary steelmaking.
The harmful impurities in steel include: sulphur, phosphorus, oxygen, nitrogen and
hydrogen. The latter three elements occupy interstitial sites in the iron lattice and hence, are
known as interstitials. The principal effect of these impurities in steel is loss of ductility, lower
impact strength and poorer corrosion resistance.
Oxygen and sulphur are also constituents of non-metallic particles in steel, known as
inclusions. These particles are also harmful for steel properties and should be removed to as low
levels as possible. Carbon is also present as an interstitial in the iron lattice as well as in the form
of Cementite (Fe3C). Unlike the other interstitials, some carbon is always required in steel and
hence, the content of carbon forms a part of steel specifications. However, in recent times, in
some special sophisticated grades like Interstitial Free (IF) steels, carbon is considered as an
impurity and has to be removed to very low levels (Ultra-low Carbon steels).
Normally the temperature drop of molten steel during tapping from the primary steelmaking
furnace is around 20 40C. An additional temperature drop of about 3050C occurs during
secondary steelmaking. Continuous casting involving pouring into a tundish causes additional
drop of 10 15C in liquid steel temperature. Therefore, provisions for heating and temperature
adjustment are very desirable, which has led to the development of liquid steel treatment in
ladles in special units, such as Ladle Furnace (LF), Vacuum Arc Degasser (VAD), CAS-OB
unit, etc.
362
Secondary Steelmaking 363
Table 20.1 presents a list of various secondary steelmaking units and their capabilities
(Ghosh Ahindra 2001). Degassing refers to the removal of nitrogen and hydrogen from liquid
steel. In common terminology, the abbreviations used and their full forms are:
VDvacuum degassing
VODvacuum-oxygen decarburisation
IGPinert gas purging in a ladle through bottom porous and slit plugs; or, by lance
immersed from the top, i.e. Overhead Lance Purging (OLP)
IMinjection metallurgy, where some solid agents are injected into liquid steel in a
ladle; or, nowadays also by wire feeding.
Item Processes
VD VOD IGP IM VAD LF ASEA-SKF
Desulphurisation minor minor minor yes yes yes yes
Deoxidation yes yes yes yes yes yes yes
Decarburisation minor yes no no no no yes
Heating no/yes yes* no no yes yes yes
Alloying minor yes minor minor yes yes yes
Degassing yes yes no no yes no yes
Homogenisation yes yes yes yes yes yes yes
Achieving more yes yes yes yes yes yes yes
cleanliness (i.e.
less inclusions)
Inclusion modification no no minor yes yes yes yes
*
Chemical heating only
With the passage of time, customers are demanding higher quality steels, which requires:
Lower impurity contents
Better cleanliness (i.e. lower inclusion contents)
Stringent quality control (i.e. less variation from heat-to-heat)
Microalloying to impart superior properties
Better surface quality and homogeneity in the cast product.
Figure 20.1 shows the trends in residuals attained so far as well as those projected for future in
Japanese steel plants (Adachi 1990).
This chapter will present a brief outline of secondary steelmaking. For detailed treatment of
the subject, the readers may refer to (Ghosh Ahindra 2001).
364 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
80
1970
60 1980
1990
Content, ppm
2000
40
20
0
C P S N O H
Random pore Directed pore structure Random and directed pore structure
structure
High porosity Separated Crosslinked Continuous
slots channels slot
r=0 z
Two-phase plume
r
Vessel
utp
Liquid
z=0
H0
Gas
where T is the temperature of the bath in kelvin, M is the mass of steel in tonne, H is the bath
height in metre and P0 is the atmospheric pressure in bar.
Figure 20.4 presents some tmix vs. Q curves from a water model experiment (Mietz and
Oeters, 1988). tmix is determined by injecting a tracer (KCI solution is commonly used) into
water as a pulse and then measuring the concentration of the tracer at some other appropriately
selected location.
50
20
10 2 Position
1
3
1 2
3
0
0 500 1000 1500
3 1 3
Gas flow rate, Nm s 10
Figure 20.4 Mixing time vs. gas flow rate (centric nozzle, tracer addition in dead zone); 1, 2, 3 are
locations of concentration measurements.
Figure 20.4 shows that tmix in a large-size vessel depends on the location of the concentration
measurement. In steelmaking ladles, the purging plug is eccentrically located at half radius at the
bottom. Small ladles are fitted with one plug while large ladles have two plugs (Mazumdar and
Guthrie, 1995).
EXAMPLE 20.1
(a) Calculate the specific stirring power (P) in watts/tonne of steel due to gas
purging through bottom tuyere in a ladle. Given that Q = 0.1 Nm3/min/t, T = 1900 K,
H = 1 m.
(b) If the mixing time for the above condition is 60 s, what would be its value if Q is
doubled? Assume m = 1/2.
Secondary Steelmaking 367
Solution:
340QT 0.707 H
(a) From Eq. (20.2), P= ln 1 +
M P0
Q 1
Here, = 0.1 , T = 1900 K, H = 1 m, P0 = 1 bar (assumed).
M 60
Inserting these values in Eq. (20.2), P = 576 watts/tonne of steel.
1 (tmix ) at 0.2 Nm 3
(b) tmix Pm Qm. Noting that m = , 3
= 21/2.
2 (tmix ) at 0.1 Nm
3 1/2
Hence, tmix at 0.2 Nm /min/t = 60 2 = 42.4 s.
If the deoxidation product is a pure oxide (SiO2, Al2O3, etc.), then aMxOy = 1. Since wt. %
M and O in steel are generally very low, hM and hO may be taken as their wt. percentages
respectively (i.e. WM and WO). [Note: If this assumption is not made, then hM and hO are to be
related to WM and WO through interaction coefficients as per the procedure given in Chapter 4,
Section 4.3.4.] Then, Eq. (20.4) may be simplified as:
{[W M]
x
[WO ]y } eq.
=
1
K M
= KM (20.5)
where KM is known as the Deoxidation Constant. Variation of KM with temperature has the form:
A
log K M = - +B (20.6)
T
where A and B are constants, which can be calculated from data available in literature.
Table 20.2 presents typical KM values for some common deoxidisers. The wt. % [O] in
equilibrium with 0.1 wt. % M at 1600C (1873 K) are respectively 0.413, 0.0145, 1.35 103
and 9.84 1010 for Mn, Si, Al and Ca. According to this, calcium is the strongest and
manganese the weakest amongst the deoxidisers. Si is stronger than Mn and Al is stronger than
Si. This follows directly from the Ellingham Diagram for oxides (Figure 4.1) showing the
relative stabilities of some oxides.
When only one deoxidiser is added, it is known as a Simple Deoxidation. Mostly, a single
oxide is formed as the product, except for mild deoxidisers, such as Cr and Mn, where the
product is typically a slag FeOCr2O3 or FeO MnO. For example, for deoxidation by Mn, the
more appropriate equation is:
(MnO) + [Fe] = [Mn] + (FeO) (20.7)
where X is mole fraction, since, both FeMn and FeO MnO solutions are ideal.
If more than one deoxidiser is added to molten steel simultaneously, it is known as Complex
Deoxidation. Some important complex deoxidisers are Si + Mn, Si + Mn + Al, Ca + Si, Ca +
Si + Al. For this, the deoxidation product is a slag consisting of more than one oxide. Therefore,
for thermodynamic analysis, activity vs. composition relationships in oxide solutions (for
example, CaOSiO2 Al2O3 system, as shown in Figure 4.3) has to be considered. Generally,
this requires the development of elaborate computer programmes with the aid of numerical
techniques. Commercial packages (e.g. FACTSAGE) are available. For details, readers may
refer to the paper (Choudhary et al. 2005).
EXAMPLE 20.2
Calculate the dissolved oxygen content of liquid steel containing 0.1% Si at equilibrium with
solid SiO2 at 1600C.
Si O
Given: eSi = 0.103, eSi = - 0.113, eOO = - 0.20, eOSi = - 0.066
370 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Solution: For the deoxidation reaction: [Si]wt. % + 2[O]wt. % = SiO2(s), from Table 20.2,
KSi = [hSi] [hO]2 = 2.11 105 (Ex. 20.1)
2 5
i.e. [ fSi WSi] [ fOWO] = 2.11 10
or log fSi + log WSi + 2(log fO + log WO) = log (2.11 105) (Ex. 20.2)
Si O
log fSi = eSi WSi + eSi WO = 0.103 0.1 0.113 WO
0.06
Oxygen and inclusions, wt. %
0.04
[O]total
[O]liquid steel
0.02
0
Furnace Cast in Held in the ladle Teemed
the ladle into ingot Solidification
Processing stages
Figure 20.5 Change of oxygen and inclusion content of steel between tapping and solidification.
Since vt d2, the larger particles float-up much faster than the smaller particles. Deoxidation
products grow by collision and agglomeration. Collision of small particles is speeded up by
turbulence. Agglomeration is better if the particles are liquid. This is where complex deoxidation
has a significant advantage, since the product can be a liquid slag particle.
Turbulence also speeds up flotation of the solid particles. Inert gas purging in the ladle is,
therefore, very beneficial as an aid to produce clean steel. This has been well-established through
both laboratory and plant-scale experiments. The total oxygen content [WO(T)] at any time after
deoxidiser addition may be approximately related to time by:
WO(T) = [WO(T)]initial exp (kOt) (20.10)
where kO is an empirical constant.
It increases with the increase in bottom gas flow rate, i.e. specific stirring power (P) as
kO Pn, where n < 1 (20.11)
However, trials in industrial ladles have established that there is an optimum stirring
intensity beyond which, the effectiveness of deoxidation decreases, as shown in Figure 20.6
(Suzuki et al. 1982). This is because the flow in ladles is re-circulatory (see Figure 20.3), and
excessive stirring causes re-entrainment of the floated oxides back into the melt. It also causes
more oxidation by air. Actually, from a more rigorous point of view, the final degree of
deoxidation achieved is a dynamic balance between the rate of elimination of the oxide particles
on one hand, and the rate of atmospheric oxidation on the other.
372 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
100
Al fully killed steel
Si killed steel
Low Si steel
Total oxygen = 20 ppm
80
Degree of deoxidation, %
60
40
20
0
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140
1
Stirring work (Emt), Jkg
Graphite
electrodes
Gas outlet
Furnace hood
Ingressing air
Slag
Molten steel
Ladle
lining
Another device that is useful in reducing slag carryover is an electromagnetic sensor, which
is placed around the tap hole. When the slag starts flowing out through the tap hole nozzle, the
nature of the signal changes significantly because of the differences in electromagnetic induction
of slag and metal. This device is considered to be very effective. In plant trials with 130/140 t
BOF converters at Linz, the following average slag rates (in kg of slag per tonne steel) were
obtained:
Without slag stopper 10 15
With slag stopper 4.45
With slag stopper and slag indication 3.5
Porous plug
Ar
N2 Gas
Sl. No. Reaction Equilibrium relation Unit of h K vs. T relation Value at 1600C
and 1 mm Hg
1 1905
1. [H] = H (g) [h H] = KH pH1/2 ppm log KH = - + 2.409 0.77
2 2 2
T
1 518
2. [N] = N (g) [h N] = KN pN1/2 ppm log KN = - + 2.937 14.1
2 2 2
T
1160
3. [C]+[O] = CO(g) [h C][h O] = KCO pCO wt. % log KCO = - 2.00 4.7 104
T
1160
ppm log KCO = - + 6.00 0.47
T
1 matmosphere = 103 atm; for [C] [O] reaction, h C = 0.05 wt. %, i.e. 500 ppm.
As noted in Table 20.3 (Ghosh Ahindra 2001), a pressure of 1 torr (= 1 mm Hg) in a vacuum
chamber is thermodynamically capable of lowering H, N and O to very low levels. This is in
contrast to steels not treated under vacuum, where the H and N values can be as high as 5 ppm
and 50 ppm respectively. In actual degassing operations, removal of hydrogen is fast and it often
attains equilibrium, but nitrogen removal is more difficult because of kinetic reasons. The
[C][O] reaction is utilised for removal of carbon to very low levels (ultra-low carbon steels)
for special applications, such as sheets for automobile bodies. Besides the main reactions during
vacuum degassing, there are some minor side reactions such as volatilisation, decomposition of
inclusions and melt-refractory interactions, but these are being omitted here for the sake of
brevity of this text.
3. kN was found to decrease with increasing wt. % of oxygen dissolved in the melt as shown
in Figure 20.9 (Pehlke and Elliot, 1963). It was subsequently found that sulphur has a
similar effect. It is well-established that O and S are surface active solutes in molten iron,
copper, etc. Thus they tend to block the surface sites and thus retard the rate.
Apparent rate constant 103, s1 10
0
0 0.04 0.08 0.12 0.16
[O], wt. %
Figure 20.9 Influence of oxygen content on the absorption rate of nitrogen by liquid iron at
1823 K.
Figure 20.10 taken from a comprehensive kinetic study by Harada and Janke (1989), shows
the variation of the second-order chemical rate constant (kc) with oxygen and sulphur contents
of the iron melt. Curve 1 and data points correspond to experiments under vacuum. These do
not agree with experiments under normal pressure (curves 3, 4, 5). The authors did not provide
any satisfactory explanation for the same. The retarding influence of O and S dissolved in molten
steel is very well-established for vacuum degassing in steel plants as well. Therefore, the melt
should be well-deoxidised and well-desulphurised first for efficient removal of nitrogen from
steel.
40
[S] ppm
20 FeC 1020
FeAl 2
10 FeAl 20
FeCS 30300
6
kc, cm s1 (%)
4 4
2 2
5 1
1.0
3
0.4
0.2
10 20 40 60 100 200 400
[O] + 0.39[S], ppm
Figure 20.10 Variation of the second order rate constant for nitrogen desorption with dissolved
oxygen and sulphur content of molten steel at 1873 K.
Since, an additional temperature drop of 20 40C occurs during secondary steelmaking and
temperature control of the steel melt is important for proper casting, provisions for heating and
temperature adjustment have been made in RH, as well as in ladle degassing [vacuum arc
degassing (VAD)]. Vacuum-oxygen decarburisation (VOD) where oxygen lancing is done under
vacuum was originally developed for stainless steel refining, but is now used for the production
of ultra-low carbon steels (ULC) as well. Similarly, RHOB, where oxygen is blown into the
RH chamber, is used for the production of ULC steels.
Besides degassing and decarburisation, modern vacuum degassers are used to carry out
various other functions such as desulphurisation, heating, alloying and melt homogenisation.
Injection of argon below the melt is a must for good homogenisation, fast processing and
inclusion removal. The carry over slag from steelmaking converters has to be modified by the
addition of deoxidisers and CaO.
Figure 20.11 shows the RH process schematically. Molten steel is contained in the ladle. The
two legs of the vacuum chamber (known as Snorkels) are immersed into the melt. Argon is
injected into the upleg. Rising and expanding argon bubbles provide pumping action and lift the
liquid into the vacuum chamber, where it disintegrates into fine droplets, gets degassed and
comes down through the downleg snorkel, causing melt circulation. The entire vacuum chamber
is refractory lined. There is provision for argon injection from the bottom, heating, alloy
additions, sampling and sighting as well as video display of the interior of the vacuum chamber.
Secondary Steelmaking 379
Viewing port
Vacuum line
Heating
rod
Rising
bubbles
Flow direction of steel
Lifting gas
(argon) Snorkel
Molten steel
Ladle
Figure 20.12 shows the VAD process schematically. Heating is done by the arc with graphite
electrodes, as in a ladle furnace. Heating, degassing, slag treatment and alloy adjustment are
carried out without interrupting the vacuum.
As far as the vacuum generating system is concerned, mechanical vacuum pumps remove
the bulk of air and gas from the chamber. However, they are not capable of lowering the vacuum
chamber pressure to very low values of about 1 torr, which is required by the process. This is
achieved by the use of steam ejector pumps in conjunction with mechanical pumps. A jet of
steam issues through a nozzle at high velocity and drags the surrounding gases along with it (i.e.
jet entrainment). Steam also helps in condensing the dust and volatiles coming out from the
vacuum chamber. For a modern 200 t VD unit, a pumping capacity higher than 500 kg of air
per hour with 1 torr chamber pressure is required.
In industrial vacuum degassing, the treatment time should be short enough to match
logistically with converter steelmaking on the one hand and continuous casting on the other. To
achieve this, in addition to proper choice and design of the process, the principal variables are
as follows:
Pumping rate of the vacuum equipment (also known as exhausting rate)
Rate of injection of argon below the melt.
380 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
1
2
7
1. Vacuum temperature and
8
sampling lance
2. Telescopic tubes for vacuum-tight
electrode sealing
3. Water-cooled high-current system
4. Electrode clamping mechanism
9 5. Vacuum lock for alloying agents
10 6. Guide mast for electrode control
7. Sight glass with rotor
11 8. Heat shield
12 9. Vacuum connection
10. Vacuum treatment vessel
11. Steel casting ladle
12. Inert gas bubbling brick (porous
plug)
Increasing the argon flow rate increases the rate of degassing and gas evolution. This tends
to raise the chamber pressure and requires a higher exhausting rate. Hence, optimisation of the
two is required. Figure 20.13 presents some theoretically calculated curves with different values
of reaction rate constants (k) for a RH degasser (Soejima et al. 1987). It shows that there is no
advantage in increasing the pumping rate if the argon flow rate is not adequate. Also, there is
no advantage of having large argon flow rates until there is a certain minimum exhausting rate.
1.0
0.8
Exhausting rate constant, min1
k = 0.2
0.6
0.4
0.15
0.10
0.2
0.05
0
0 500 1000 1500 2000
3 1 3
Argon flow rate, Nm min 10
Figure 20.13 Influence of pumping rate and argon flow on decarburisation rate constant in a
RH degasser.
process was invented. The thermodynamic basis for these processes had already been known for
some time. However, AOD was not commercially viable till the price of argon became
reasonably low. These will be taken up further in Chapter 21 dealing with stainless steel
manufacture.
To meet the increasing demand for cold-rolled sheets with improved mechanical properties
and to cope with the changeover from batch to continuous annealing, the demand for ULC
(C < 20 ppm) is increasing. As stated in Section 20.4.3 that, in this connection, the RH process
was modified by oxygen blowing under vacuum. It is known as RH-OB and was first developed
by Nippon Steel Corp. in Japan for producing stainless steel in 1972 and subsequently, employed
for the production of ULC steels. The present thrust is to bring down the carbon content of the
melt from 300 ppm to 1020 ppm in 10 minutes. RH-OB was subsequently made more versatile
by incorporating provisions for chemical heating by aluminium addition. Oxidation of
aluminium generates heat rapidly and counters temperature drop during degassing. Powder
injection for desulphurisation, alloy additions, etc. were later incorporated. This versatile and
flexible process is known as the RH-injection process, and is shown in Figure 20.14.
382 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Vacuum vessel
OB
OB Flux
Recirculating
flow Ar
Injection lance
Molten steel
Molten steel ladle
EXAMPLE 20.3
(a) Consider argon purging of liquid steel in a ladle at 1600C through bottom tuyeres. The
gas bubbles coming out contain 10% CO, 5% N2, 5% H2, and rest Ar. Assuming the
gas to be at equilibrium with molten steel at the exit, calculate the hydrogen content
of steel. The steel contains 1% C, 2% Mn and 0.5% Si.
C
Given: eH = 0.06, eHMn = - 0.002, eH
Si
= 0.027, eHH = 0
(b) Calculate the rate of circulation of molten steel (R) through the vacuum chamber in RH
degassing to lower the hydrogen content of steel from 5 to 2 ppm in 15 minutes.
Assume that molten steel attains equilibrium with respect to hydrogen gas inside the
vacuum chamber.
Given: (i) Composition and temperature of steel same as in (a) above, (ii) pressure in
the vacuum chamber is 1 milli-atmosphere, (iii) weight of steel in the ladle (W) is
150 tonnes.
Solution:
1
(a) The reaction is: [H] = H2(g) (20.12)
2
1905
From Table 20.3, [hH] = K H p1/2
H2 ; log KH = - + 2.409, where the unit of h
T
is ppm. T = 1873 K, pH2 = 0.05 atm at the bubble exit at the top of the melt.
Solving with the above values, hH = 5.5 ppm = 5.5 104 in wt. % scale.
C
log hH = log fH + log WH = eH WC + eHMn WMn + eH
Si
WSi + eHH WH + log WH
Putting in values, and solving, the following can be obtained: WH = 4.69 10 4 wt. %
= 4.69 ppm
Secondary Steelmaking 383
(WS ) in slag
( aO2 - )
LS,e = = K39
[WS ]in metal
eq [WO ]eq (5.41)
where WS is wt. % sulphur and K39 is the equilibrium constant for the ionic exchange reaction:
[S] + (O2) = (S2) + [O] (5.39)
It was also mentioned that the reaction can be written in terms of compounds, and that CaO
is the most powerful desulphuriser, amongst the basic oxides present in iron and steelmaking
slags. Sulphur transfer from metal to slag is better if the value of LS,e is higher. For this, from
Eq. (5.41), it follows that the dissolved oxygen in metal, , should be as low as possible. This
requires the addition of deoxidising agents into the melt.
Secondary steelmaking slags consist of CaO, Al2O3 and SiO2 as the major constituents.
Amongst the common deoxidisers, aluminium is the most powerful (see Section 20.3.1). Low
oxygen levels can be achieved by deoxidation (referred to as killing, in popular terminology)
using Al, and these are known as aluminium-killed steels.
On the basis of the above, the overall reaction may be written as:
3(CaO) + 3[S] + 2[Al] = 3(CaS) + (Al2O3) (20.16)
for which the equilibrium constant is:
(aCaS )3 (aAl2 O3 )
K16 = (20.17)
(aCaO )3 [hS ]3 [hAl ]2
Assuming hS = WS, hAl = WAl, and (WS) in slag proportional to (aCaS), it is possible to write:
(W ) [WAl ]2/3
LS, e = S ( aCaO ) (20.18)
[WS ] eq ( aAl2O3 )1/3
Increasing wt. % of CaO increases aCaO and decreases aAl2O3, thereby increasing LS,e.
Figure 20.15 demonstrates this and shows that LS,e increases with increase in wt. % CaO in slag
and WAl in molten steel for CaOAl2O3 slags at 1500C and 1650C (Turkdogan 1983). K16 is
a function of temperature, and is given as:
48580
log K16 = - 16.997 (20.19)
T
where T is the temperature in kelvin. Hence, the lower temperature helps desulphurisation.
Suppose, the initial [WS] in steel is 0.01% and it is to be brought down to 0.002%. Let the
mass of steel be 150 tonne and that of slag be 2 tonnes. It means that the amount of sulphur to
be transferred to the slag would be 150 (0.01 0.002) 102 tonnes. Therefore, wt. % S in
150 0.008 10 -2 0.6
slag (WS) would be 10 2 = 0.6%. So, final LS = = 300. Since
2 0.002
equilibrium may not be attained in the process, LS,e should be larger than 300. Plant trials have
shown that it is possible to have effective desulphurisation, if LS,e is 1000 or above. Such a high
value is obtained when the slag is almost saturated with CaO.
Secondary Steelmaking 385
4000
2000 1500C
1650C
1000
600
400
200
LS,e
100 [WAL]
0.05
60
40
0.05
20 0.01
0.005
10 0.01
0.005
6
4
35 40 45 50 55 60
Slag CaO, wt. %
Figure 20.15 Equilibrium sulphur partition ratio between liquid iron with dissolved Al
and CaOAl2O3 slags.
where kS, emp is an empirical rate constant, and has the dimension of s1. Again, kS,emp = k a,
where k is specific rate constant per unit slagmetal interface area, and a is specific interfacial
interfacial area
area, i.e. a = .
volume of liquid metal
Neglecting the reverse reaction and integrating Eq. (20.20) from t = 0 to t = t, the following
can be obtained
[W ]
ln S O = kS, emp t = k a t (20.21)
[WS ]
where [WS]O is initial wt.% S in steel at t = 0 (i.e. at the start of desulphurisation).
The k a parameter is a function of the bottom argon flow rate Q. Figure 20.16 presents a
log-log plot of some k a vs. Q data for desulphurisation in a gas-stirred ladle of pilot plant size
(Asai et al. 1983). The data could be fitted properly with two inter-connected straight lines with
different slopes. In general, literature data indicate that the k a parameter lies between
(0.5 and 3) 103 s1 for low gas flow rates, and (3 and 15) 103 for high gas flow rates.
e*, W kg1 10 3
3 15 30 150 300
10
5
ka, s1 103
1
ka Q2.1
ka Q0.25
0.5
5 10 50 100 500
3 1 1 6
Q, Nm kg min 10
Figure 20.16 Effect of gas flow rate on ka parameter for desulphurisation reaction.
Secondary Steelmaking 387
EXAMPLE 20.4
Table 20.4 Important desulphurising agents for powder injection in secondary steelmaking
The addition of calcium metal into the melt in the form of Ca-Si alloy causes deep
deoxidation, deep desulphurisation and modification of inclusions to yield desirable properties.
The initiative came after extensive deposits of natural gas were discovered in cold Arctic regions,
like Alaska in North America. The line-pipe steel for transporting gas over long distances has
to withstand high pressure, corrosion from H2S in gas, and sub-zero temperatures without any
tendency towards brittle fracture. The steel for this purpose required treatment by calcium.
Calcium is a gas at steelmaking temperatures. The vapour pressure vs. temperature
relationship for pure calcium is:
0 8920
log pCa (in atm) = - - 1.39 log T + 9.569 (20.22)
T
0
At 1600C (1873 K), pCa = 1.81 atm. This is quite high and is likely to lead to instantaneous
violent vapour formation resulting in a very little Ca reacting with the melt.
In Ca-Si alloy,
0
pCa = pCa [aCa] (20.23)
In the composition of Ca Si alloy employed, aCa is approximately 0.1, thus making pCa < 1 atm
and eliminating the possibility of vapour formation. Even then, there is considerable loss of Ca
as vapour, since the solubility of Ca in steel is very low (0.025 wt. % at 1600C).
In powder injection processes, therefore, the powders should be injected as deep as possible
into the melt. In wire feeding, CaSi powder is encased in a hollow steel tube and swaged before
the tube plus powder is continuously fed into the melt by a machine. Powder injection gives
better desulphurisation owing to the increased surface area. However, wire feeding is particularly
suitable for inclusion modification. It is worth mentioning here that wire feeding is practised for
Secondary Steelmaking 389
other purposessuch as Al wire feeding for deoxidation and alloy powder feeding for precision
alloying. Many steel plants, therefore, have provision for both powder injection and cored wire
feeding.
20.6.1 Introduction
In general, non-metallic inclusions in steel have been found to be harmful for desirable
mechanical properties and corrosion resistance of steel. The inclusion particles are mostly oxides
and to some extent, sulphides. This is more so in the case of high-strength steels for critical
applications. As a result, there is a move to produce what is known as Clean Steel, i.e. steel free
from inclusions. However, no steel can be made totally free from inclusions and therefore,
cleanliness is a relative term. Which steel is clean and which is dirty can be decided only when
it is known what the intended application is and what are the consequent property requirements.
The sources of inclusions may be classified into the following.
1. Precipitation due to reaction with molten steel or during freezing because of reaction
between dissolved oxygen and the deoxidisers, with consequent formation of oxides
(also reaction with dissolved sulphur as well). These are known as endogenous
inclusions.
2. Mechanical and chemical erosion of the refractory lining
3. Entrapment of slag particles in steel
4. Oxygen pick up from the atmosphere, especially during teeming, and consequent oxide
formation.
Inclusions originating from contact with external sources as listed in items 2 to 4 above, are
called exogenous inclusions. These are formed during the entire process of secondary
steelmaking; therefore, it is necessary to make a summary as shown in Figure 20.17.
Technological measures for inclusion control are briefly outlined below.
Primary steelmaking
BOF/EAF
Tapping
Addition Al wire
feedings Ladle treatment Argon stirring
Vacuum
Additions Additions
Argon purging Ladle furnace Vacuum degassing Arc/chemical heating
Arc heating Argon injection
Teeming
Teeming
Continuous casting
3. Stirring of the melt in the ladle by argan flowing through bottom tuyeres is a must for
mixing and homogenisation, faster growth, and floatation of the deoxidation products.
However, very high gas flow rates are not desirable from the cleanliness point of view,
since it has the following adverse effects:
Re-entrainment of slag particles into molten steel.
Increased erosion of refractories and consequent generation of exogenous inclusions.
More ejection of metal droplets into the atmosphere with consequent oxide
formation.
400 ppm, depending on the nature of the stream. This leads to the formation of large inclusions,
rich in FeO and MnO. Moreover, it increases the dissolved oxygen content and causes further
generation of inclusions by reaction during solidification in the mould. Atmospheric oxidation
has been eliminated by the use of Submerged Entry Nozzles (SEN) in the continuous casting
route, where the nozzle tip is submerged into the melt. Additional protection can also be
provided by shrouding the stream further with a gentle flow of argon.
Section 20.3.5 has outlined the problem of slag carryover from primary steelmaking furnaces
into the ladle during tapping. Formation of a funnel-shaped cavity towards the end of tapping
causes the slag to flow out along with the metal. This phenomenon also leads to entrainment of
slag by metal during teeming from the ladle and tundish. This can be minimised by:
Not emptying the ladle completely.
Employing a refractory float on the funnel vortex.
Using an electromagnetic sensor around the nozzle that gives a signal when entrained
slag begins to flow out through the nozzle along with the metal.
For producing clean steels, the refractory used in the teeming nozzles is of considerable
importance, since there is a high probability that inclusions and impurities introduced at the stage
of teeming will not be eliminated. Here, both erosion and corrosion are severe owing to the high
flow velocity of liquid steel through the nozzle. Adequate thermal shock resistance of the lining
is also required to prevent its spalling. Nowadays, zirconia (ZrO2)-based linings are the most
preferredsuch as ZrO2graphite, ZrO2CaOC. Since ZrO2 is expensive, Al2O3-based material
(e.g. Al2O3CSiC) is employed as the back-up layer. One alternative to zirconia is Al2O3-based
linings.
so as to make them relatively harmless as far as the properties of steel are concerned. This is
done by injection metallurgy, and again, calcium is the most common reagent. Section 20.5.3
has already discussed this in connection with desulphurisation. These will not be repeated.
One of the defects in continuous casting is formation of subsurface pinholes owing to the
presence of dissolved gases. Therefore, the oxygen content of the melt should be kept very low
by use of aluminiun also as deoxidiser (Al-killed steel). A certain minimum level of dissolved
Al is required in the melt. This gives rise to the problem of nozzle clogging in continuous casting
owing to sticking of alumina inclusions to the inner wall of the casting nozzle. Calcium treatment
at the final stage in a ladle or a tundish has been found to eliminate this, because the deoxidation
product is a liquid consisting of CaO and Al2O3, occasionally with some amount of SiO2.
Calcium is a powerful desulphuriser as well, and therefore, reaction (20.16) resulting in the
formation of CaS also may occur. However, the liquid sulphide is generally not pure CaS, but
a solution of CaSMnS. The compounds 12CaO.7Al2O3 (C12A7) and 3CaO.Al2O3 (C3A) have
low melting points of 1455C and 1535C respectively, and therefore, are preferred.
Figure 20.18 shows thermodynamic predictions for equilibrium inclusion type for calcium-
treated steels as a function of its Al and S content at 1550C (1823 K), assuming CaS to be pure
(Fruehan 1985). Although originally Ca-treatment was started to overcome problems of nozzle-
clogging, the duplex inclusion of (C12A7) with a ring of CaSMnS is globular, soft and
deformable, and thus relatively harmless to mechanical properties.
0.05
0.04 CA
C12A7 CA2
0.03
[S], wt. %
0.02
CA + Liquid
0.01
Liquid
0
0 0.01 0.02 0.03 0.04 0.05
[Al], wt. %
Figure 20.18 Equilibrium inclusions predicted for calcium-treated Al-killed steels, as function of Al
and S content at 1823 K.
Rare earths (RE) consist of 14 elements having almost identical chemical properties.
Commercially it is available as Misch metal, which contains about 50% cerium. REs are both
strong deoxidisers and desulphurisers, like calcium. They can modify inclusions as well as act
as grain refiners. However, they are not as commonly used as calcium because of difficulties of
Secondary Steelmaking 393
process control. Tellurium (Te) or Selenium (Se) is also added as a reagent for inclusion
modification to improve the machinability of sulphur containing steels. Their basic effect is to
make the inclusions globular, thus leading to better deformation characteristics during hot
working as well.
1640
LF treatment
1600
Temperature, C
1550
Transport to CCM
Heating. Add. of
Carbon addition
Temperature tundish
Transport to LF
Preparation LF
Add. of fluxes
Heating alloy
Wire feeding
soft purging
and fluxes)
trimming
Casting
1500
Figure 20.19 Temperature changes in a steel melt from the furnace to the tundish via ladle furnace.
EXAMPLE 20.5
Calculate the change in temperature (DT) of 150 tonne of molten steel in a ladle at 1600C
following the addition of 70 kg of ferrosilicon having 50% Si. Assume that half of the silicon
reacts with dissolved oxygen of steel, and the rest remains dissolved in steel.
Solution: 70/2 = 35 kg Si = (35 103)/28 = 1.25 105 gmol of Si
Assuming steel to be pure iron,
150 tonnes of steel = (150 106)/56 = 2.68 106 gmol
From Chapter 15, Table 15.1,
[Si]wt. % + O2(g) = SiO2(s); DH 01 = 816.2 kJ/mol
The first column of Table 4.2 of Chapter 4 gives values of DH 0 approximately and, from that
O2(g) = 2[O]wt. %; DH 02 = 2 (117.15) kJ/mol
From the above reactions,
[Si]wt. % + 2[O]wt. %; DH 0 = DH 01 DH 02 = 581.9 kJ/mol (Ex. 20.8)
Again, from Table 4.2,
m
HSi owing to dissolution of silicon into the melt = 131.5 kJ/mol.
Secondary Steelmaking 395
Heat Balance:
Since the above processes are exothermic, they are the sources of heat input. Since, only half
of the silicon added reacts with dissolved oxygen,
Heat input = 1.25 103 {0.5 [581.9] + [131.5]} = 5.28 105 kJ
Assuming the process to be adiabatic,
Heat output = Heat required to raise the steel temperature by DT + Sensible heat required
to raise the temperature of ferrosilicon from 298 K to 1873 K
Noting that (H1873 H298) for Fe and Si are respectively 76.94 and 33.5 kJ per gmol, the
sensible heat of Fe-Si addition = 103 [1.25 33.5 + (0.5 70 76.94)/56] = 0.9 105 kJ
From Table 15.2, ignoring the T2 term, raising of steel temperature would require heat.
No. of gmol of steel 40.9 DT = 2.68 106 40.9 DT 103 = 1.10 105 DT kJ
So, heat output (in kJ) = 1.10 105 DT + 0.9 105
Equating heat input and output, DT = 4.0C
REFERENCES
Adachi, Y., in Proc. of the 6th Iron and Steel Cong., The Iron and Steel Inst. Japan, Vol. 3,
Nagoya (1990), p. 248.
Asai, S. et al., preprints Scaninject 111, MEFOS, Lulea, Sweden, Part 1 (1983), Paper 12.
Choudhary, S.K., S. Chandra and A. Ghosh, Metallurgical and Materials Trans. B, Vol. 36B
(2005), pp. 5966.
Fruehan, R.J., Ladle Metallurgy, ISS-AIME (1985), Chs. 2 and 7.
Fruehan, R.J., Vacuum Degassing of Steel, Iron & steel Soc., USA (1990).
Ghosh, Ahindra, Secondary SteelmakingPrinciples and Applications, CRC Press, Boca
Raton, Florida (2001).
Harada, T. and D. Janke, Steel Research, Vol. 60 (1989), p. 337.
Mazumdar, D. and R.I.L. Guthrie, ISIJ International, Vol. 35 (1995), p. 1.
Mellinghoff, H., in Int. Symp on Quality Steelmaking, Ind. Inst. of Metals, Ranchi (1991),
p. 144.
Mietz, J. and F. Oeters, Steel Research, Vol. 59 (1988), p. 52.
Pehlke, R.D. and J.F. Elliott, Trans. AIME, Vol. 227 (1963), p. 844.
Plockinger, E. and M. Wahlster, Stahl Eisen, Vol. 80 (1960), p. 659.
Shankanarayanan, R. and R.I.L. Guthrie, Steelmaking Proc., Iron and Steel Soc., USA (1992),
p. 655.
Soejima, T. et al., Trans. ISIJ, Vol. 27 (1987), B146.
Suzuki, K. et al., Ironmaking and Steelmaking (1982), p. 33.
Turkdogan, E.T., Arch. Eisenhuttenwesen, Vol. 54 (1983), p. 4.
21
Stainless Steelmaking
21.1 INTRODUCTION
Amongst high alloy steels, stainless steels (SS) are the most important. The world production of
SS is about 20 Mtpa. Therefore, stainless steels production is being dealt with in this separate
chapter.
Stainless steels contain 10 to 30% chromium. Varying amounts of nickel, molybdenum,
copper, sulphur, titanium, niobium, nitrogen, etc. may be added to obtain the desired properties.
SS is used wherever superior resistance to corrosion is desired. Stainless steels are primarily
classified as austenitic, ferritic, martensitic, duplex or precipitation hardening grades. Most
grades contain 1718% chromium. Addition of nickel enhances the corrosion resistance further
and tends to stabilise the austenitic structurethe most popular SS is the 18% Cr and 8% Ni
variety.
In terms of tonnage production, ferritic SS is next. Production of ferritic SS requires the
removal of carbon and nitrogen in steel to very low levels. Nickel, which is an integral part of
stainless steels is expensive and efforts have been made from the 1950s to replace it, partially
or completely, by other elements, such as manganese, which tend to stabilise the austenite phase.
However, this can be achieved more easily, if the steel contains high percentages of nitrogen
(0.060.08%); high nitrogen SS grades are being produced today.
Before 1970, the majority of stainless steels were made in electric arc furnaces. In Chapter
19, the application of EAF steelmaking for producing carbon steel grades has been covered along
with the modern developments. Availability of relatively cheap tonnage oxygen led to the
practice of oxygen lancing for faster decarburisation and the consequent generation of a foamy
slag. This development changed the entire picture.
Owing to rapid growth in SS production from about 1970 onwards, the generation/supply
of SS scrap could not meet the demand and other charge materials had to be used. The quantities
of various charge materials that are now used are as follows (based on 2001 figures):
Carbon steel scrap 7.0 Mt
Stainless steel scrap 4.5 Mt
Ferrochrome 4.0 Mt
Primary nickel 0.7 Mt
397
398 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
O2
O2, N2, Ar
N2/Ar LPG
Duplex route
Ar
Triplex route
Ar
In the situation where stainless steel scrap/ferrochrome is either very expensive or is not
available, alternative process routes have been developed that use chromium ore and hot metal
from blast furnaces or some other ironmaking unit. These processes typically consist of a
smelting unit (often a converter) to reduce the ore, followed by decarburisation in another
converter, sometimes followed by vacuum processing.
For further reading, the readers may consult (Hilty and Kaveney, 1985) and (Paul et al.
1999).
21.2.1 Melting
As already stated, the primary melting unit used for producing stainless steel is the electric arc
furnace. Melting in induction furnaces is popular in the case of smaller scale operation and in
foundries. Chapter 19 has dealt with EAF steelmaking for plain carbon steels including the
recent developments, many of which have been employed for stainless steels as well. However,
there are some salient differences.
1. Oxidation of chromium and transfer of the oxide to slag is not desirable, as it represents
a loss of chromium. This sets a limit to the extent of oxygen blowing.
2. Carbon injection and foamy slag practices are rarely employed for SS. This is because
the foam sustained by CO evolution is moderate and not vigorous during stainless steel
melting.
3. Before tapping, ferrosilicon is often added to recover the oxidised chromium from the
slag.
Stainless steel melting in some plants is also carried out in a converter. It requires the
injection of carbon and oxygen and post-combustion of CO to CO2 inside the converter to
generate heat.
through the side tuyeres also contains a high percentage of oxygen. However, as decarburisation
proceeds, oxygen blowing from the top is reduced in stages and argon blowing increased. As
stated earlier, some stainless steel grades contain nitrogen as a part of the specifications, in which
case, nitrogen is employed in place of argon in the final stages.
Use of a supersonic top lance as in the case of BOFs allows post-combustion of the evolved
CO gas with consequent minimisation of toxic carbon monoxide in the exit gas as well as
utilisation of the fuel value of CO to raise the bath temperature. Towards the end of the blow,
when the carbon content is very low and is close to the final specification, only argon is blown
to effect mixing and promote slagmetal reaction. At this stage, ferrosilicon and other additions
are made. Silicon reduces chromium oxide from the slag. If extra-low sulphur is required, the
first slag is removed and a fresh reducing slag is made along with argon stirring. The purpose
of the other additions is to perform both alloying as well as cooling of the bath, since the bath
temperature goes beyond 1700C following the oxidation reactions.
Figure 21.3 shows this relationship at one atmosphere pressure of CO (Hilty and Kaveney,
1985). It demonstrates that a very high temperature is required if it is required to obtain less than
0.04% C at above 15% Cr. Lowering of pCO allows the same to be achieved at a much lower
temperature. This is shown in Figure 21.4 (Hilty and Kaveney, 1985).
1925
C C
% %
05
C
06
C
0. 0.
3%
%
1900
4
0 .0 C
0.0
0 7%
0. C
1875 %
.08
0
C
%
1850 .09 C
0
Temperature, C
%
10
0.
1825 C
2%
0.1
1800 C
5%
0.1
1775
1750
1725
1700
5 10 15 19
Chromium, wt. %
Since nickel dissolved in liquid iron has a small but significant influence on the
thermodynamic activities of carbon and oxygen, Eq. (21.5) was modified as:
W 13800
log Cr =- + 8.76 - 0.925 pCO (21.6)
WC T + 4.21WNi
For the reduction of chromium oxide from slag by ferrosilicon during the last stages of
VOD/AOD operation, Hilty et al. assumed the following reaction:
(Cr3O4) + 2Si = 3Cr + 2(SiO2) (21.7)
[ hCr ]3 (aSiO2 ) 2
K7 = (21.8)
[ hSi ]2 ( aCr3O4 )
Stainless Steelmaking 403
1900
1700
1600
5 10 15
Chromium, wt. %
Figure 21.4 Influence of pressure and temperature on the retention of chromium by oxygen-
saturated steel melts at 0.05% C.
Noting that aSiO2, aCr3O4 in slag are functions of slag basicity, an equilibrium relation was
arrived at from Eq. (21.8). However, for practical purposes, statistically fitted empirical
coefficients are recommended, such as:
log (WCr)slag = 1.283 log [WCr] 0.748 log [WSi] 1.709 log V 0.923 (21.9)
where V = slag basicity = (CaO + MgO)/SiO2.
SR-KCB
O2
Ar
Prevention of chromium Lower cost refining for
oxidation by using mixed gas high-grade steel
DC-KCB VOD
Figure 21.5 The KSC process of direct stainless steelmaking.
Stainless Steelmaking 405
The molten steel from the SR-KCB reactor containing chromium and 56% C is charged
into a K-BOP converter (Kawasakis version of bottom-blown oxygen converter), where
decarburisation is completed followed by final refining in a VOD unit.
REFERENCES
Choulet, R.J. and I.E. Masson, Iron & Steelmaker, Vol. 20, May 1993.
Hilty, D.C. and T.F. Kaveney, in Electric Furnace Steelmaking, C.R. Taylor (Ed.), Iron & Steel
Soc., USA (1985), Chapter 13.
Paul, B.V., A.H. Chan and R.J. Choulet, in Making Shaping and Treating of Steel,
Vol. 2, R.J. Fruehan (Ed.), Iron & Steel Soc., USA (1999), Chapter 12.
Part E
Casting of Liquid Steel
Ingot Casting of Steel
Continuous Casting of Steel
22
Ingot Casting of Steel
22.1 INTRODUCTION
At present, continuous casting is by far the most predominant method of casting molten steel.
Bulk of the liquid steel after continuous casting is shaped by rolling either into flat products, i.e.
plates and sheets, or, into long products, such as rods, angles, rails, etc. Ingot casting is still in
vogue, in very small volumes, particularly for casting special steel products. For example, for
forgings of special shapes, ingot casting is the route. Some very small capacity steel plants still
exist in several parts of the world, including India, where ordinary carbon steels, and special or
alloy steels in small quantities are ingot cast.
Even though ingot casting of steel is now not extensively practised, this separate chapter is
being included in this book for some important reasons. Except for steel cast in foundries, ingot
casting was the only method of casting steel for more than 100 years, till the advent of
continuous casting. Therefore, extensive investigations and studies have been made on the
science and technology of solidification processing, with major emphasis on ingot casting of
steel as well as other metals and alloys. This has without doubt contributed significantly towards
the present day understanding of the physicochemical phenomena during freezing of liquids, and
has laid the foundation for the growth of the continuous casting process. Therefore, some
coverage of ingot casting is required, without which knowledge of casting will be incomplete.
Ingot moulds are made of cast iron, having various cross sections such as square, round,
polygonal, etc. depending on the end-use of the product. There are various mould designs,
such as:
Narrow-end-up, or wide-end-up
Open bottom, closed bottom, or plugged bottom
With, or without hot top.
In most practices, pouring of liquid steel is done from the top. Bottom pouring, i.e. feeding the
mould through a bottom opening, is practised only in special cases where ultra pure cast products
are required.
Figure 22.1 depicts three common types of ingot moulds, viz. narrow-end-up, wide-end-up,
and wide-end-up with hot top. An important issue is the stripping of the solidified ingot from
409
410 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Bottom Bottom
plate plate
(a) (b)
Refractory
bricks
Layer of
fire clay
Mould
(c)
Figure 22.1 Types of ingot moulds: (a) narrow-end-up, (b) wide-end-up, and (c) wide-end-up with
hot top.
the mould. Cast iron moulds have an advantage since the coefficient of thermal expansion of cast
iron is different from that of steel. Upon cooling, steel contracts more than the cast iron mould,
which assists detachment. The conical shape of the moulds facilitates pulling-out of only the
mould by a stripping crane, thus separating the mould from the solidified ingot. In this context,
the narrow-end-up mould is the most convenient. In addition, the inner walls of the mould are
coated with tar, pitch or similar materials at a temperature of about 150250C. When the tar
or pitch decomposes at high temperature, fine carbon is formed on the mould surface, which
prevents sticking of the solidified ingot with the mould. In case the mould is cold, pre-heating
is required.
Molten steel from the furnace is tapped into a refractory-lined teeming ladle which has a
steel shell. Ladles of the type shown in Figure 22.2 were in use earlier. The teeming nozzle at
the bottom of the ladle is eccentric and is closed by a refractory-lined steel stopper rod. During
teeming, the rod gets lifted up by a mechanical device after the ladle is centred above the mould
set by an overhead crane. Teeming can then start.
Ladles of more modern design are in use now in all large steel plants as well as in mini steel
plants. These are fitted with slide gate valves instead of stopper rods, and have provision for
argon injection from the bottom. Chapter 20, Figure 20.7 has presented a sketch of a ladle
furnace, which shows the ladle design. The top cover with the electrodes, etc. is a part of the
ladle furnace station, the ladle with liquid steel moves on a rail track and is brought to the LF
station. Once treatment is completed, the ladle is taken to the teeming bay by an overhead crane.
Ingot Casting of Steel 411
Stopper rod
Spout assembly
Lifting
lug
Bracings
Nozzle
Figure 22.2 Teeming ladle for steel (earlier design with stopper rod).
function of time. For a wide variety of solidification processing (viz. sand casting, ingot casting,
etc.), the following empirical relationship has been established:
X = kt1/2 b (22.2)
For ingot casting of steel, the value of k has been found to lie approximately between 2.5 and
3.5 103 ms1/2, and b between 2.5 and 5 103 m.
Figure 22.3 shows the temperature versus distance profile normal to the mould wall.
Because of thermal expansion of the mould and solidification shrinkage of the metal, an air gap
is formed sometime after the beginning of solidification. Since the air gap is of insulating nature,
it slows down the rate of heat flow and solidification. In between the liquid and the solidified
steel, there is a mushy zone, which is a mixture of solid and liquid. The mechanism of heat
transfer for the various zones from the melt to outside air is also indicated in Figure 22.3.
T Air gap
(conduction
+ radiation)
Mushy zone
(conduction)
Figure 22.3 Temperature versus distance profile normal to the mould surface during ingot
solidification.
Segregation fundamentals
During solidification of liquid metals and alloys, crystal formation takes place. The resulting
morphology has certain characteristics peculiar to cast structures in terms of both macrostructure
and microstructure. Furthermore, segregation of solutes also occurs during solidification of
alloys. Segregation results in non-uniformity of chemical composition in the cast alloy. The
segregation pattern and morphology are inter-related phenomena and hence, for actual castings
they cannot be considered in an isolated manner. Therefore, to cover the fundamentals of
segregation, the simplest morphology is being assumed, viz.:
The solidification front is plane
The solid alloy is single-phase.
The basic cause of segregation is rejection of solutes by the liquid during freezing owing
to the lower solubility of the solutes in the solid. In Figure 22.4, at the temperature T, the solute
Ingot Casting of Steel 413
C0
TL Liquid
Liquidus
T
CS CL
T
Solidus
TS
Solid + Liquid
Solid
0 Composition (C)
This equation is called the Scheils Equation, and is regularly used for simple analysis of
solidification processes.
414 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Element Kd /L K g /L
C 0.19 0.34
Si 0.77 0.52
Mn 0.77 0.785
Al 0.6 0.6
O 0.03 0.03
P 0.23 0.13
S 0.05 0.035
Ca 0.02 0.02
Mg 0.02 0.02
Cr 0.95 0.86
Ni 0.83 0.95
Cu 0.53 0.88
Mo 0.80 0.585
Ti 0.38 0.33
V 0.93 0.63
Nb 0.40 0.22
W 0.85 0.45
N 0.25 0.48
TLiquidus
Temperature
Temperature
Constitutionally
supercooled liquid
In Figure 22.5(a), Tactual is greater than Tliquidus. Hence, there is no freezing of the liquid
adjacent to the interface and the solidification front is plane. In the situation illustrated in
Figure 22.5(b) on the other hand, Tactual is less than Tliquidus in the region adjacent to the solid
liquid interface. In this case, the liquid is supercooled. This supercooling occurs because of
segregation, and hence, is called constitutional supercooling. This leads to the formation of cells
at the interface. At high rates of solidification, rapid growth takes place normal to the interface
along some crystallographic directions [such as along <100> in cubic metals]. These are known
as primary dendrites. After some time, lateral growth of the primary dendrites leads to the
formation of secondary and tertiary dendrites, giving a tree-like appearance. A mixture of solid
dendrites and interdendritic liquid constitutes the mushy zone.
Figure 22.6(a) is a sketch of the macrostructure of the cross section of an ingot. The chill
zone adjacent to the mould wall consists of fine grains arising out of the initial rapid freezing.
Growth of dendrites normal to the mould wall after some time gives rise to the columnar zone.
The central zone also consists of dendrites, but these are randomly oriented. This is known as
the equiaxed zone. Figure 22.6(b) is a schematic presentation of the vertical section of an ingot.
It may be noted that the interdendritic liquid is less pure than the bulk liquid owing to rejection
of solutes by the growing dendrites. The reason why these are referred to as the structure of
killed steel ingots, will be explained in the next section.
For further details, the readers may consult Flemings (1974) and Ghosh (1990).
Chill layer
(Fine equiaxed crystals)
Unaltered liquid
Less pure
Central coarse
equiaxed grains
Central line of mould
Mould wall
Mould
Columnal
crystals
wall
(2) Equiaxed
zone
Mould bottom
(a) (b)
Figure 22.6 Structure of killed steel ingots showing three zones: (a) cross section, and
(b) longitudinal section.
416 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
2.0
%C = 0.1
%Mn = 1.0
%Si = 0.1
%O = 0.0045
%N = 0.016
1.5 H = 7 ppm
PT
Pressure, atm
1.0
0.5 pCO
Figure 22.7 Variation of pCO, pH2, pN2 and PT with increasing solidification for semi-killed steel ingots.
Ingot Casting of Steel 417
The total thermodynamic pressure (PT) is related to equilibrium partial pressures of CO, N2
and H2 as:
PT = pCO + pN2 + pH2 (22.6)
When PT > Pa + Ph (22.7)
gas bubbles form. Pa is the atmospheric pressure and Ph is the ferrostatic pressure of liquid steel.
Blow holes
Pipe
Figure 22.8 Typical macro-structures of steel ingots: (a) killed, (b) semi-killed, and (c) rimming.
(a) In well-deoxidised steels in which strong deoxidiser(s) such as aluminium is added, [O]
and hence pCO is very low. Therefore, PT is always less than (Pa + Ph), and gas bubbles
do not form. This results in killed steel ingots, whose macrostructure has been shown
in Figure 22.6. Because of solidification shrinkage and consequent volume contraction,
a hollow cavity (known as pipe) is formed at the top of the ingots.
(b) For semi-killed ingots, deoxidation is carried out by Mn and some Si, and hence, the
extent of deoxidation is weaker. The [O] content in molten steel after deoxidation and
before freezing, typically ranges between 50 and 100 ppm. In this situation, gas bubbles
can form only after about 70 to 80% solidification is completed. At this stage, the top
of the ingot is already frozen because of the extra heat losses from the top. As a result,
the gas bubbles remain entrapped in the solid ingot leading to the formation of gas
holes (known as blow-holes).
(c) In rimming steels, very little deoxidation is carried out in the ladle. Consequently, the
initial oxygen content of the melt is above 200 ppm. As soon as the steel is poured into
the mould, on account of the high pCO, copious evolution of gas begins almost
immediately. The bubbling action and gas evolution cause ejection of droplets of
molten steel into the atmosphere and these droplets get oxidised by atmospheric
418 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
oxygen. Some, or most of these droplets return to the ingot. This phenomenon, shown
in Figure 22.9, leads to continuous absorption of oxygen by the melt, which helps in
sustaining the rimming action. The typical pattern of blow-hole distribution in rimming
steel ingots is shown in Figure 22.8(c).
Solid skin
Flow direction
of molten steel
Solidliquid
interface Mould
Figure 22.9 Illustration of the rimming action in the mould during solidification.
It may be noted that each type of ingot has specific applications. For example, a rimming
steel ingot is relatively free from inclusions and has good surface quality. It was principally used
to produce high-quality sheets before continuous casting took over.
EXAMPLE 22.1
Consider solidification of liquid steel isothermally at 1500C. Calculate the total thermodynamic
pressure owing to gases in steel (i.e. PT) at 50% solidification. Ignore deoxidation reactions.
Ignore solutesolute interactions. Take the initial composition of liquid steel as in Figure 22.7.
Solution: Values of equilibrium partition coefficients for solidification of liquid iron into
-iron are given in Table 22.1.
Assume equilibrium segregation for carbon, hydrogen and nitrogen, since these are of small
atomic sizes and diffusion is fast. Then, combining Eqs. (22.3) and (22.4), i.e. CS/CL = Ke, and
CS fS + CLCL = C0, and with the relation: fS + fL = 1, the following equation can be obtained:
C0
CL = (Ex. 22.1)
1 + fS ( K e - 1)
Noting that fS = 0.5, and Ke = 0.25, 0.32 and 0.19 respectively for N, H, and C, the
concentrations after 50% solidification are: WN = 0.026%, ppm H = 10.6, WC = 0.168%.
Assume validity of Scheils equation, i.e. Eq. (22.5) for O,
Thermodynamic calculations on the basis of Table 20.3 give the thermodynamic pressures
of H2, N2 and CO, at equilibrium with H, N, C and O dissolved in liquid steel, at
50 per cent solidification as 0.24, 0.32 and 0.71 atm. respectively.
Hence, PT = pCO + pN2 + pH2 = 0.24 + 0.35 + 0.67 = 1.26 atm.
22.4.1 Pipe
Pipe represents the shrinkage cavity at the top of killed steel ingots, as shown in Figure 22.8(a).
Since the pipe is exposed to the atmosphere with consequent formation of oxide scales on its
surface, it does not get welded during subsequent hot rolling. Therefore, this portion has to be
rejected, leading to loss of yield. The remedy is to use a hot top, as shown in Figure 22.1(c).
The hot top is an insulated refractory lining inserted at the top of the mould into which some
insulating powder or exothermic compounds are added when molten steel is teemed into the
mould. Therefore, the metal in the hot top region remains molten till the end, and thus feeds the
shrinkage cavity. As a result, only a small fraction of metal which solidifies in the hot top portion
is rejected.
22.4.2 Blow-hole
The mechanism of formation of blow-holes has been discussed in the previous section. Blow
holes are found in semi-killed and rimming ingots, as shown in Figure 22.8. Blow-holes are
structural defects, but they are not necessarily harmful. Blow-holes counter shrinkage and
eliminate the shrinkage cavity. Deep-seated interior blow-holes get welded during subsequent
hot working. Blow-holes are harmful only if they are present near the surface of the ingot, since
they get exposed during hot working and form surface defects. Excessive blow-hole formation
causes swelling of the ingot top (referred to as spongy top) and some loss of yield. The remedy
is to control the deoxidation practice so as to avoid these harmful effects.
420 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
22.4.4 Segregation
The fundamentals of segregation were briefly presented in Section 22.2.2. These fundamental
principles are applicable to micro-segregation, i.e. segregation in small microscopic regions,
such as in interdendritic liquids during dendrite growth. Micro-segregation gets eliminated by
homogenisation through solid state diffusion during subsequent hot working and heat treatment.
Movement of the micro-segregated regions over macroscopic distances owing to the motion
of the liquid and the free crystals gives rise to macro-segregation. The motion of impure
interdendritic liquid causes regions of positive macro-segregation; whereas, the movement of
purer solid crystals yields negative macro-segregation. The flow of interdendritic liquid is
primarily because of natural (or free) convection arising out of density gradients in the liquid.
Such density gradients arise from non-uniform temperature and composition in the solidifying
liquid. Some forced convection also occurs owing to gas evolution and/or suction by shrinkage
cavities.
Macro-segregation constitutes a defect, since it cannot be eliminated during subsequent hot
working and heat treatment. Large fractions of columnar zone mean more impure inter-dendritic
liquid. As shown schematically in the vertical section of a killed steel ingot, the upward flow
of this liquid leads to the formation of a distinct pattern of positive (+) segregation zone. The
zone of negative segregation arises out of settling of free crystals, which are purer and denser
than the liquid, as shown in Figure 22.10.
Macro-segregation is a complex phenomenon. The patterns of segregation are different in
killed, semi-killed and rimming steel ingots and there is no simple prescription for remedial
measures. Hence, it is not discussed any further here though it will again be briefly dealt with
in connection with continuous casting in Chapter 23.
Ingot Casting of Steel 421
Zone of
positive segregation
C-type
A-type
Zone of
negative segregation
Hairline cracks are caused by undesirably high hydrogen content of steel. Hydrogen has
negligible solubility in solid steel and its solubility decreases even further during cooling of the
solidified metal. Hydrogen has a high diffusion coefficient owing to its low atomic mass, and
hence, keeps getting desorbed continuously during handling and storage of the ingots. Such
desorption causes high pressure of hydrogen gas in the internal faults leading to the formation
of fine internal cracks. The remedy is to lower the hydrogen content of molten steel by vacuum
degassing, wherever required.
Internal fractures get welded during subsequent hot working. However, hairline cracks tend
to propagate up to the surface because of the high pressure of hydrogen. This leads to the
rejection of ingots.
REFERENCES
Deo, B., A.K. Bagaria and A. Ghosh, Trans. Ind. Inst. Metals, Vol. 36 (1985), p. 49.
Flemings, M.C., Solidification Processing, McGraw-Hill, New York, 1974.
Ghosh, A., Principles of Secondary Processing and Casting of Liquid Steel, Oxford & IBH
Publishing, New Delhi, 1990.
Trubin, K.G. and G.N. Qiks, SteelmakingOpen Hearth and Combined Processes, MIR
Publishers, Moscow (1974), Ch. 24.
Ueshima, Y., S. Mizoguchi, T. Matsumiya and H. Kajioka, Metall. Trans B, Vol. 17B (1986),
pp. 845859.
Won, Y.M. and B.G. Thomas, Metall. and Mater. Trans. A, Vol. 32A (2001), pp. 17551767.
Yamada, W., T. Matsumiya and A. Ito, Proc. 6th Int. Iron and Steel congress, ISIJ, Nagoya
(1990), pp. 618625.
23
Continuous Casting of Steel
23.1 INTRODUCTION
Chapter 3 has already described the basic process of continuous casting of steel. It is the most
dominant method of casting of liquid steel in integrated steel plants as well as in modern mini
steel plants.
The advantages of continuous casting (over ingot casting) are:
It is directly possible to cast blooms, slabs and billets*, thus eliminating blooming,
slabbing mills completely, and billet mills to a large extent.
Better quality of the cast product.
Higher crude-to-finished steel yield (about 10 to 20% more than ingot casting).
Higher extent of automation and process control.
Better consistency in the quality of the cast products and higher productivity are other
advantages of continuous casting over ingot casting. All these advantages have contributed to
substantial savings of capital and operating costs per tonne of steel. The capital cost is lower
since less equipment is involved and the cast product is closer to the final product; the operating
cost savings arise out of lower manpower and energy as well as higher yield.
Henry Bessemer first propagated the concept of continuous casting of steel in 1846.
However, it took more than hundred years to make continuous casting a reality. It was initially
successful in casting non-ferrous metals in the 1930s. However, it was more difficult to apply
it to steel because of the higher melting temperature and lower thermal conductivity. The first
pilot plant for continuous casting of steel was installed in Germany in 1943. By 1970, a large
number of machines were in use throughout the world. In 1980, about 30% of world steel was
cast by this route, which increased to 65% by 1990, and is at present above 95%. The widespread
adoption of continuous casting has been particularly noticeable in major steel producing
countries, for example, it accounted for 94% of the total steel production in South Korea, 93%
in Japan and 88% in the European Economic Community in 1990.
* Slabs have a flat rectangular cross section, typically 800 1300 mm width and 150 300 mm thickness, billets
are typically of square cross section (in some cases, rounds) of a maximum section size of 150 150 mm
approximately, and blooms are square or rectangular in cross section of larger sizes than billets.
423
424 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Continuous casting started in India with the commissioning of a billet caster at Mukand Iron
and Steel Works and at the Canara Works in 1965. Amongst integrated steel plants of India, Tata
Steel, Bhilai Steel Plant as well as the Vizag Steel Plant started continuous casting in the decade
of 1980. In 1990, the share of continuous casting in India was about 25% of the total steel
production, which is about 90% at present, with machines available in most integrated steel
plants and virtually all the modern mini steel plants. Over the last 40 years, extensive research
and development efforts have been made throughout the world and huge amount of literature is
available.
The commercial processes of continuous casting can be classified into: slab casting, bloom
casting and billet casting. The biggest breakthrough in recent years in the area of steel have been
the advent of thin slab casting and the very recent strip casting of molten steel. These
developments are generically grouped as Near-Net Shape Casting. Since such casters are
continuously being installed and the process is still maturing, the discussions in the following
sections will be focused mainly on the commercial continuous casting of slabs, blooms and
billets. Near-net shape casting will be separately taken up at the end of this chapter.
Pouring
Cooling water
Liquid
Hollow copper pool
mould Z
Water spray
Solid
steel
Rolls
Nagoya, NSC
Chiba, Kawasaki Steel
Kashima, Sumitomo Metals
3.5 Oita, NSC
Kakogawa, Kobe Steel
Fukuyama, NKK
3
Casting speed, m/min
2.5
1.5
1
1980 1985 1990 1995 2000 2005
Fiscal year
Figure 23.2 Increase in casting speed in recent years in the main slab casters in Japan.
Water cooling
& Liquid steel
(convection)
radiation) (convection)
1000
Solid steel
(conduction)
500 Mould
(conduction)
0
0 20 40 60 80 100
Distance, mm
The local heat flux (q) in the mould varies from the top meniscus level to the bottom of the
mould. Ingot casting is a batch process; therefore, in Eq. (22.2), time (t) means the time from
the beginning of solidification till the solidification of the entire ingot. In continuous casting, a
horizontal section of metal moves downwards during solidification. Hence, its residence time in
the mould increases downwards, from zero at the meniscus, and this becomes the variable t in
Eq. (22.2).
Figure 23.4 shows the variation in heat flux with residence time (t) in a slab caster mould
at low casting speed (Paul et al. 2000). For high speed casting, the maximum value of t is around
30 seconds and the heat flux would be 3 to 4 times that in Figure 23.4. The reasons for the
decrease in q with t are:
Air-gap formation
Increase in the thickness of the solid shell.
1200
q = 5312.2t 0.6148
1000 R2 = 0.8432
Heat flux, kW/m2
800
600
400
200
0
0 50 100 150 200 250 300
Residence time, s
Figure 23.4 Variation of local heat flux with residence time in a slab caster mould.
428 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
For practical purposes, the average heat flux (qav) in the mould is of interest. The higher the
value of qav, the higher will be the casting speed. qav depends on several variables, such as:
Composition of steel
Type of the mouldstraight or curved
Mould taper
Type of lubricant used
Casting speed.
As already stated, increase in casting speed increases qav. In order to lower the extent of air-
gap formation, the mould has to be so designed that its inner cross-section gradually decreases
from the top to the bottom to counter solidification shrinkage. This is known as mould taper.
Obviously the more the taper, the higher will be the heat flux.
The purpose of lubrication is to decrease the friction between the ingot and the mould,
thereby making the withdrawal of the ingot easier. During the early years of continuous casting,
only billet casting was practiced. Oil was employed as the lubricant. In some old billet casters,
this practice still exists. However, the universal practice for slabs, blooms and in some billets is
to employ a mould powder (flux) as the lubricant. The powder penetrates into the air-gap, and
increases the effective thermal conductivity thereby enhancing the heat flux. The mould powder
flux performs several other functions as well. Considerable research and development has been
carried in the development of mould powdersit will now be discussed separately.
Slag nose
Mould
Powder layer
Glassy slag layer Sintered layer
Liquid layer
Crystalline slag layer
Liquid steel
Solidified steel shell
Motion of layers
Figure 23.5 Different layers of solid and molten casting powder in the mould (schematic).
Many commercial casting powders have been developed and marketed to suit the overall
range of continuous casting requirement. They are essentially mixtures of SiO2, CaO, Al2O3,
Na2O and CaF2 with minor additions of MgO, MnO, FeO and K2O. As stated earlier, some
carbon powder is always a constituent. An adverse effect of the molten slag formed by casting
powder is the possibility of it attacking the refractory lining of the submerged entry nozzle
(SEN).
h W n (23.4)
where n ranges between 0.5 and 1.
A major problem is that h is non-uniform over the entire surfaceit is high where the water
jet impinges, but much less at distances away from the impingement zone. This causes non-
uniformity in surface temperature, and consequent generation of stresses on the surface and
tendency for surface cracking. A major development has been air-water spray cooling, also
430 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
known as air mist cooling. Here, high pressure air sprays water on to the metal surface in the
form of very fine droplets. The advantages of air-mist cooling are:
More uniform cooling
Less water requirement
Less cracking of the surface.
EXAMPLE 23.1
Calculate the thickness of the solidified shell at the mould exit in a continuous casting unit.
Given: Temperature of liquid steel at the point of entry into the mould (Tl) = 1560C, length
of the mould (L) = 0.7 m, casting speed (vc) = 0.05 ms1.
Solution: From Eq. (22.1), Chapter 22,
Q = qA = mass rate of solidification heat given up per unit mass
dx
= Ars ( DH f + C DTs )
dt
If z denotes the coordinate along the length of the mould, then dt = dz/vc.
Note that rs = 7.8 103 kg/m3, Cs = 788 J/kg/K, DHf = 15.5 kJ/mol = 278 103 J/kg,
DT = 1560 melting point of iron = 1560 1536 = 24C. Again, q is given by Eq. (23.3) as
follows.
heat flux (q)
h= (23.3)
Tsurface - Twater
The average value of q in the mould (qm) = hm (1560 40), assuming cooling water temperature
as 40C, where hm = mean value of h in the mould.
From literature sources, hm = 1.7 103 16.2tm (Ex. 23.1)
where, tm = residence time of steel in mould = L/vc = 0.7/0.05 = 14 s.
Substitution of all these values in Eq. (22.1) gives dx/dt = 9.67 104.
dx dx dt dx 1
= = = 0.0193
dz dt dz dt vc
0.7
or, x = solidified thickness upon emergence from mould = 0.0193 dz = 0.0134 m.
0
Ingots
Thixocasting/rheocasting
104
Dendrite arm spacing, micron
Continuous casting
2
10
ESR
1 Splat cooling
Powder
102
103 1 103 106 109
Cooling rate, C/s
Figure 23.6 Dendrite arm spacing versus cooling rate for different types of solidification.
Inlet stream
Molten steel
Weir
Stopper
Slot
The inlet stream of molten steel from the ladle creates turbulence, which enhances refractory
erosion and reaction with the atmosphere, and is hence not desirable. Refractory weirs and
bottom friction pads assist in confining and dampening turbulence. Dams direct the flow
upwards and help in inclusion floatation. Slotted dams have become popular now. Very gentle
argon purging from the bottom at selected locations is beneficial, since it assists in inclusion
floatation.
Use of ceramic filters in tundishes for absorbing inclusions has not yet been commercially
successful for casting of steel, although considerable research and development efforts have been
made. Ceramic filters are in use for low melting non-ferrous metals where the filter life is longer
owing to lower temperatures than what is encountered with steel.
Ladle
Ladle Cast position
stand
Aluminium wire feeder
Slide Mould level control
gate
Pendant control panel
Tundish
Multi-stage mould
Tundish car Mould oscillation system
Cast platform
Slag launder Cooling chamber
1100 1100 1100 1100 1100
emergency Roller apron
Ladle 6m Withdrawal unit Length I II III IV V VI
R= Crop end Pendulum measure Dummy bar storage
pinch roll shear device First disappear stop
Inter disappear stop
Fixed end stop
600 pass line
Figure 23.8 Diagram of the curved mould continuous billet caster of Tata Steel.
of alloying elements are added. To protect the inner surface, chromium plating is also practiced.
As stated in Section 23.2.2, in order to lower the extent of air-gap formation, the inner cross-
section of the mould is tapered, the bottom section being smaller than the top. A typical value
of taper is about 1% per metre length. For a section size of 100 mm 100 mm, the taper is about
1 mm for a 1 m. long mould. The mould is expected to extract about 10% of the total heat
content in the metal and its length ranges from 75 to 140 cm, the length being more for larger
sections.
For easy withdrawal of the ingot, the mould is oscillated up and down. This is known as
Junghans principle, according to the name of the inventor. It is a very important feature of any
CC machine strand. If it is not done in a proper manner, surface defects such as oscillation marks
will be present in the ingot. The oscillation frequency can be varied, for example, for Tata Steels
slab caster the frequency can be varied between 0 and 250 cycles/min and the stroke length from
0 to12 mm.
The latest development in this field is what is known as the Resonance Mould, where the
device for executing mould oscillation is not like the earlier devices. It has been installed in
several casters around the world. The drive is servo-hydraulic and has several advantages:
Better guiding accuracy
Drastic reduction of the oscillating mass
Much lower frictional force between the ingot and the mould.
It has been established that the incidence of surface defects is much less with resonance moulds
compared with conventional moulds.
436 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Accurate control of the level of the top liquid metal surface (i.e. the meniscus) is important
for smooth caster operation. For this purpose, feedback control is necessary. A sensor is
employed to monitor changes in the meniscus level and this is converted into an electrical signal,
which controls:
Either, the withdrawal speed of the ingot
Or, the slide gate valve which regulates the rate of teeming from the tundish to the
mould.
The following sensing devices are employed nowadays.
(a) Sensors using radiation from a radioactive source (generally, gamma rays)
(b) Electromagnetic sensors
(c) Eddy current mould level controllers.
Each has its advantages and disadvantages; eddy current sensors are the most precise.
It has been mentioned in Chapter 20, Section. 20.6.3, that the falling teeming stream of
liquid metal absorbs oxygen and other gases from the atmosphere. Oxygen absorption gives rise
to the formation of harmful inclusions. It has already been mentioned that the ingress of
atmospheric oxidation can be eliminated/minimised by the use of refractory-lined submerged
entry nozzles (SEN), where the nozzle tip is submerged into the melt in the mould. SEN is a
standard feature in all slab and bloom casters, and even many large size billet casting units have
adopted it.
The AC machines impart the stirring action by electromagnetic induction. This is the most
commonly used variety. In DC machines, a current is passed through the strand and this, along
with the imposed magnetic field imparts motion in the melt.
The EMS modifies the liquid flow pattern in a complex way. The design and operation also
vary considerably. The way they help in improvement of quality will be taken up in the next
section. Not all continuous casting machines make use of EMS.
Centre
0.8
Carbon content, pct.
0.7
0.6
0.5
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160 180 200 220 240 260
Distance from lower side, mm
Figure 23.9 A typical concentration profile along the cross section of a continuously cast slab
(earlier situation).
Dendrite growth
Growth instability
Formation of bridging
Formation of pipe
Actual macrostructure
It has been established that bulging of the solid shell owing to pressure at the withdrawal
rolls aggravates centreline segregation. Since the shell bulges outwards, a cavity is created in the
central liquid region, thus enhancing suction. Heat transfer calculations have revealed that in the
lower areas of the secondary cooling zone, the centreline temperature decreases more rapidly
Continuous Casting of Steel 439
than the surface temperature. This causes relatively higher thermal contraction in the central
region than at the surface, thus causing more suction.
The principal remedy is early formation of equiaxed crystals and a large equiaxed zone
around the centreline. This tends to evenly distribute the micro-segregated regions, and thus
makes the zone refining action less predominant. The presence of equiaxed crystals also prevents
bridging by the columnar crystals and mini-ingotism. As already stated in Chapter 22, an
equiaxed structure is preferred over a columnar structure since it gives other advantages, such
as easier mechanical working, prevention of centreline cracks and porosity.
Hence, a major objective in continuous casting of steel is to obtain as large an equiaxed zone
as possible, and this is facilitated by:
Low superheat
Electromagnetic stirring
Large section size
Medium carbon steel.
The accepted mechanism is that the growth of the columnar zone stops when the equiaxed
zone starts forming. There are always innumerable tiny crystals (seed crystals) floating in the
melt. When the superheat is dissipated, these crystals start growing, thus forming the equiaxed
zone. Therefore, the superheat should be low. Electromagnetic stirring speeds-up the dissipation
of heat from the liquid, and is thus beneficial. If the section size is large, the temperature gradient
in the central region is low, allowing a large equiaxed zone. The equiaxed zone has been found
to be the largest in medium carbon steels.
Technology has also been developed for minimisation of suction by bulging by:
Adjustment of roll gap taper
Soft reduction in the cross-section of the ingot during final solidification
Controlled plane reduction.
As a result of all these measures, the incidence of centreline segregation and porosity has been
almost eliminated in modern practices.
23.6.2 Cracks
Cracks may be broadly classified as internal cracks and surface cracks. Surface cracks get
oxidised following contact with air and do not get welded during subsequent rolling. They have
to be removed by scarfing (i.e. surface grinding) and are, therefore, a major quality problem.
Internal cracks are less harmful since they get welded during subsequent rolling.
Surface cracks get initiated in the mould region of the caster. They subsequently develop in
the secondary cooling zone or even later, such as during reheating. Internal cracks get initiated
in the secondary cooling zone. Cracks are formed because of:
(i) Mechanical stresses
(ii) Thermal stresses
(iii) Material factors.
440 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Frictional resistance offered by the mould in connection with the withdrawal of the ingot is
the principal source of mechanical stress. Improper alignment, jerky withdrawal and other
operating snags contribute further towards mechanical stress. Another source of mechanical
stress is the ferrostatic pressure of the liquid metal. Thermal stresses on the surface are caused
by non-uniform surface temperature. The surface cooling is fast, especially in the secondary
cooling zone. Any unevenness in the cooling pattern is expected to lead to a non-uniform
temperature distribution.
Some examples of material factors are as follows.
(a) Longitudinal mid-face surface cracking in slabs has been found to be aggravated by
d g solid state transformation and consequent volume changes.
(b) Higher sulphur content and lower Mn/S ratio increase the tendency for mid-face
longitudinal cracks.
(c) Often surface cracks have been found to be associated with the presence of inclusions.
Brimacombe and co-workers carried out extensive investigations on crack formation during
continuous casting of steel. Figure 23.11 shows the classification of cracks proposed by them
(Brimacombe and Sorimachi, 1977). Since surface cracks are a major quality problem in
continuous casting of steel, extensive investigations have been carried out. These include
mathematical modelling for computation of stress distributions on the surface and prediction of
failure criteria, besides plant data. A variety of remedial measures have already been
incorporated in modern practices, as a result of which incidence of cracking has been
considerably lowered.
9
11 10
7 Internal cracks Surface cracks
8 1. Midway 7. Longitudinal (Mid-face)
1,5,6 2. Triple point 8. Longitudinal (corner)
4
2 3 3. Centreline 9. Transverse (Mid-face)
2 4. Diagonal 10. Transverse (corner)
4 1,5,6 5. Straightening/Bending 11. Star
6. Pinch roll
Figure 23.11 Schematic diagram of a cast section showing different types of cracks.
Qualitatively speaking, mechanical stresses have been reduced by improved mould practices,
such as by choosing the appropriate casting powder, controlling the feed rate of the powder,
smoother withdrawal by employment of resonance moulds, more accurate strand guidance,
automation, etc. Thermal stresses in the secondary cooling zone have been reduced by air-mist
cooling by making the heat flux and surface temperature distribution more uniform. Steel
cleanliness and desirable distribution of inclusions have received considerable emphasis as well.
Continuous Casting of Steel 441
Rhomboidity
It is also known as off-squareness, and is a common quality problem in casting of billets having
a square cross-section. In a square, the lengths of the two diagonals are equal, whereas, in a
rhomboid, they are not equal. Hence, the ratio of the lengths of the diagonals is a measure of
rhomboidity. This defect is basically related to the asymmetry in the cooling characteristics in
the mould and gets aggravated in the secondary cooling zone. It cannot be completely
eliminated, but has been made less severe by proper mould design.
Oscillation marks
As already stated in Section 23.5.2, the mould is oscillated at a certain frequency for easy
withdrawal of the ingot. This causes surface unevenness in the ingot in the form of horizontal
ridges and troughs at intervals. These are known as oscillation marks and constitute a quality
problem. Oscillation marks cannot be totally eliminated. If the depths of these are abnormally
high, scarfing of the surface is required to remove them before reheating and rolling. Therefore,
the strategy is to render the marks shallow and relatively harmless so that scarfing is not
required. This has been achieved by improvements in technology by adopting the same measures
which have helped in decreasing mechanical stresses on the surface for the prevention of cracks.
Inclusions
It has already been mentioned in Section 23.3, that the inclusions get less time to float up in
continuous casting moulds, and therefore, pose a more serious problem than in ingot casting. The
problem tends to become more acute because of the necessity of employing a tundish for flow
control, and consequently a higher temperature in the ladle. Hotter steel causes more lining
erosion. The molten metal stream has to flow through nozzles twice (ladle-to-tundish and
tundish-to-mould) and also has to flow over an open tundish. Hence, atmospheric oxidation is
more severe compared with ingot casting.
To overcome these problems, better cleanliness of steel in terms of less number of inclusions
is the first remedial step. Chapter 20 has presented discussions on clean steel technology during
secondary steelmaking. The use of submerged entry nozzles has eliminated the problem of
atmospheric oxidation during teeming. Section 23.4 has elaborated the modern tundish practice
whereby inclusion control has received considerable emphasis. As far as the mould practice in
continuous casting is concerned, a brief discussion is presented below.
Inclusions in the mould arise from the following sources:
Formation of inclusions by reactions in the mould during freezing
Inclusions coming with incoming molten steel
Entrapment of mould powder below the surface, which causes several kinds of internal
and surface defects in steel products, e.g. slivers and scabs on steel sheets.
442 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Causes for the formation of inclusions during freezing have been mentioned earlier. To
prevent the formation of oxide inclusions, the strategy is to keep the dissolved oxygen content
in steel very low, by employing aluminium and, if required, calcium-based deoxidisers. Like the
tundish, here also, the level of residual inclusions in the cast product is governed by the dynamic
balance between the rates of inclusion formation and inclusion removal. The casting powder
melts when added to the mould, and then floats on the top of the steel melt. The resulting slag
prevents oxygen pick-up from the atmosphere. Furthermore, it absorbs inclusions that float-up.
Therefore, the choice of the casting powder requires considerable attention in terms of its
efficacy in mould lubrication and its chemical stability.
During freezing in the mould, the solidified metal entraps some inclusions, which impedes
the free floating-up of other inclusions. The fluid flow pattern in liquid steel in the mould also
has a marked influence on inclusion distribution in the cast product. In continuous casting,
upward flow in the liquid pool in the mould is primarily a result of the impingement of the
teeming stream. Appropriate design of the SEN outlets has a governing influence; SEN design
is therefore important. The flow should have an upward component for facilitating inclusion
floatation. At the same time, any horizontal outward flow component is undesirable, since that
will tend to push the inclusions towards the surface. In some designs, provision is made for slow
injection of argon into the melt so that the rising bubbles help the inclusions to move up.
Equiaxed grains allow better floatation than horizontal columnar grains. Electromagnetic stirring,
if properly tuned, can have beneficial effects. Entrapment of the mould powder can also only be
reduced by proper fluid flow management in the mould region.
Pinholes
Continuously cast products are either killed or semi-killed steels. Grades which are fully killed,
either by aluminium alone, or aluminium and calcium, have very low oxygen contents and
therefore, there is no possibility of the formation of blow-holes. For semi-killed steels,
sometimes, tiny blow-holes, known as pinholes, form just below the surface.
The tendency for blow-hole formation becomes more pronounced as solidification proceeds,
as has been briefly discussed already in connection with ingot casting, where blow-holes in semi-
killed ingots are deep seated. However, in continuous casting, the last portion of the liquid
freezes in the secondary cooling zone, where the ferrostatic pressure is of the order of a few
atmospheres. Therefore, deep-seated blow-holes do not form. Sub-surface blow-holes are likely
to form only if the dissolved hydrogen, nitrogen and oxygen contents are undesirably high. The
only remedy for this is to control the amount of dissolved gases in liquid steel.
when continuously cast blooms/billets are made. The rotary stirring action of EMS enlarges the
central equiaxed zone, thereby reducing the centreline defects considerably. The other
precautions normally taken for billet/bloom casting, of course, have to be followed as well.
However, in many steel plants, it is uneconomical to install a CC machine solely for
producing rounds, because of the limited volume. This has given rise to the development of
combination casters, which are designed to produce both blooms (round sections) as well as
slabs (square or rectangular cross-section) in the same machine. Of course, changeover from one
to another requires changing of moulds, roller apron, cooling sprays, withdrawal rolls, etc. There
are quite a few combi-casters producing slabs-cum-blooms in plants throughout the world.
3000
2500
2000
1500
1000
500
0
0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5
Casting speed, m/min
Figure 23.12 Mould heat flux versus casting speed for several casters.
444 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
(b) Break-outs
The phenomenon of rupture of the solidified steel shell and break-out after emergence from the
mould is a serious operation-cum-quality issue in continuous casting. Section 23.6.2 has
elucidated the formation of surface cracks and its causes. Break-out is an extreme situation of
the same. For its prevention, the fracture strength of the solidified shell at the exit of the mould
should be higher than the stress between the ingot surface and the mould, arising out of frictional
forces. Theoretical calculations and experimental investigations have predicted that if the heat
flux is uniform, then, it is theoretically possible to attain a casting speed of more than 4 m/min
in slab casters.
Ladle
Conventional
slab caster Thin slab caster Strip caster
Tundish
Ingot Coil
making Coil
Hot
direct
rolling
Finishing Picking & Cold
Reheating Slabbing Reheating Roughing
strands of heat rolling
furnace mill furnace mill Customer
HSM treatment mill
Another development that has helped in resolving this issue is liquid core reduction (LCR),
in which the solid ingot with a liquid core is subjected to on-line rolling. This allows some
reduction in thickness, say from 8090 mm to 6570 mm, which helps in improving the slab
surface and decreases the size of the inclusions. Though thin slabs are cast at casting speeds of
4.55.5 m/min, the total production in a TSC is lower than that in any conventional slab caster.
This can become a limitation in large capacity plants with large-scale ironmaking and
steelmaking facilities, such as in an integrated steel plant. To resolve this issue, two stand TSC
machines capable of processing up to 250 t ladles are now available. Depending on the exact
width and thickness, the output of a TSC unit can be 2.02.4 Mtpa. It is important to note that
whilst the entire processing in thin slab casting is completed in the hot condition, the strips
produced are suitable both for hot rolled strip as well for some low-end cold rolled strip
applications because of the close dimensional tolerance and surface quality of TSC strips.
Furthermore, it needs to be noted that unlike in the early stages of the development of this
technology, at present, most of the grades processed in conventional hot strip mills can be cast
by TSC.
Thin slab casting has made it possible for EAF-based steel producing units to get into the
production of strips. In view of 30 40% saving in capital cost and 1520 $ lower processing
cost, thin slab casting has been widely adopted in integrated steel plants as well. It is a
technology that will become even more widespread in the years ahead, since high-quality strips
with lesser segregation, finer grain size and higher strength can be produced.
beams used for building heavy structures in the construction and infrastructure sectors. In the
conventional method, extensive hot rolling of slabs has to be carried out to reduce the section
thickness required for producing beams. This calls for several steps of processing including
intermediate heating. Beam blank casters now cast thicknesses, which are close to the final
section size and, hence, much less hot rolling is required. The advantages and problems are akin
to those for thin slab casting.
REFERENCES
Brimacombe, J.K. and K. Soramachi, Met. Trans. B, Vol. 8B (1977), p. 489.
Chatterjee, A. and S. Govindarajan, Continuous Casting at Tata Steel, Jamshedpur (1991),
p. 9.
Chow, C. et al., Ironmaking and Steelmaking, Vol. 29 (2002), p. 65.
Paul, A. et al., Scand. J. Met., Vol. 29 (2000), p. 143.
Suzuki, M. et al., ISIJ International, Vol. 41 (2001), p. 672.
Part F
Miscellaneous
Ironmaking and Steelmaking in India
Appendix IList of Major Iron and Steel Plants in India
Appendix IISupersonic Jet(s): Relevance to BOF Steelmaking
24
Ironmaking and Steelmaking
in India
24.1 INTRODUCTION
Steel is amongst the most widely used engineering materials. What is perhaps the most
significant in todays ecology conscious world is that, steel can be recycled over and over again,
almost ad infinitum. In fact, every new steel product contains some amount of previously
discarded steel products that find their way back into steelmaking furnaces in the form of scrap.
Indias association with iron and steel dates back more than three millennia, as briefly
mentioned in Chapter 1. Steel has a glorious heritage in India, one of the best examples of which
is the Delhi Iron Pillar (Figure 24.1)about 1500 years old and still with no trace of rust.
108 mm
Decorated
108
portion
f32.2 f30 cm
f35.6
518 cm
720
f36.9
518
5m
f38.2
4m
3m
2m
f41.1
f42 cm
1m
(a) (b)
Year Change
18731948 +100 Mt in 75 years
19481973 +400 Mt in 25 years
19731983 +/ 0 in 10 years
19831993 +115 Mt in 10 years
19932003 +230 Mt in 10 years
20032006 +275 Mt in 3 years
The Indian steel industry had a modest beginning when The Bengal Iron and Steel Co. was
set up at Barakar in 1875. The real fillip to this industry was given when Jamsetji Nusserwanji
Tata began The Tata Iron and Steel Company (now Tata Steel Limited) at Jamshedpur in 1907.
Very early, Tata Steel made steel rails to British specifications. In World War II, British tanks
were called Tatanagars, since the steel was made in Tatanagar (then the name for Jamshedpur).
The steel for the famous Howrah bridge was provided by Tata Steel in the early 1940s.
Chapter 1, Section 1.5 has presented a brief outline of the subsequent developments of the Indian
steel industry.
The decade of the 1980s (and even early 1990s) saw the Indian steel industry at crossroads.
In the early 1980s, spurt in domestic demand coupled with the South East Asian boom prompted
a number of companies to go in for new steel plants, accompanied by existing steel producers
expanding their capacity. The net result was that there was quick addition to capacity.
Unfortunately, this culminated in a serious over-capacity situation soon thereafter. To make
matters worse, it coincided with a downward turn in local demand as well as a downturn in
economy in South East Asia, accompanied by the collapse of some financial institutions of India.
As a result, many of the new ventures faced extremely difficult times very early; so much so
that fresh investment in the Indian steel industry began to be regarded as being far too risky.
Fortunately, this gloomy scenario is now a thing of the past. The liberalisation of the Indian
economy in the early 1990s was accompanied by concerted efforts made by the Indian
Government to rejuvenate steel. This provided impetus not only to public investment, but also
encouraged many private players to get into steel. Consequently, over the last few years, the
Indian steel industry has been witnessing unprecedented growth, that is expected to continue in
the foreseeable future.
The industrial recovery in India was first noticed in 2002 03. It was consolidated during
2003 04 and gathered momentum during 200405. India as a country has been is scaling new
heights since then. The significant decline in interest rates and turnaround in public investment
through the infrastructure development programmes have been two crucial drivers. The low
Ironmaking and Steelmaking in India 453
interest rates have fuelled the housing, automobile and consumer durable booms, which have
augured well for steel. While just four years back, steel companies across the globe, including
those in India were in trouble, over the last few years, the situation has been totally transformed.
The steel industry (particularly in Asia) is upbeat about the present and buoyant about the future.
This dramatic turn around has largely been driven by the sharp rise in Chinese demand.
Appendix I contains a list of the major integrated steel plants and mini steel plants in India
along with their crude steel production capacities. Steel plants under the Steel Authority of India
Ltd. (i.e. SAIL) and the Rashtriya Ispat Nigam Ltd. (RINL) are in the public sector, and the rest
in the private sector.
1000
Per capita consumption,
800 S. Korea
Japan
USA
600
kg/tcs
400 Germany
China
200
0 India
1950 1960 1970 1980 1990 2004
Year
Figure 24.2 Per capita consumption of crude steel in some selected countries.
On this basis, it is generally agreed that the future of the Indian steel industry is promising.
This appears logical since India is amongst the few countries in the world that has the dual
advantage of fast growing domestic demand coupled with access to raw materials. Further, the
axis of global steel production/consumption is shifting towards Asiaa trend that is already
clearly discernible. With their large populations, China and India already account for 45% of the
total world steel productionmore than double that of Europe. Asia is expected to outpace the
other regions of the world to an even greater extent in the coming years.
454 IRONMAKING AND STEELMAKING: Theory and Practice
Table 24.2 Major steel producing countries between 2003 and 2006
There are three large gas-based units, namely Essar Steel, Ispat Industries and Vikram Ispat
with capacities of 3.60, 1.60, and 0.9 Mtpa respectively, in western India, close to natural gas
from Bombay High. A large number of coal-based plants with capacities ranging from
30400 ktpa (in the later case, using multiple units) are operating, predominantly in the states
of Orissa, Chattisgarh, Jharkhand and West Bengal, where high-grade lump ore (mandatory for
DRI production) is available along with non-coking coal. India is expected to consolidate its
position further as the world leader in sponge iron in the next five years, as indicated in
Table 24.4 (Muthuraman and Chatterjee, 2006).
In India, sponge iron is used primarily by the secondary sector in mini steel plants. It has
also been intermittently used by integrated plants, particularly at times whenever ironmaking
capacity became a bottleneck. The use of DRI in electric induction furnaces (IFs), particularly
DRI fines below 3 mm without any agglomeration, has been a major innovation that was made
in India. The use of fines below 3 mm directly in EAFs is normally not possible, because it tends
to get lost as dust. Following the success of the innovation made in the secondary sector, IFs
Ironmaking and Steelmaking in India 457
Table 24.4 Projection of installed capacity and production of sponge iron in india
have proliferated all over India. In fact, today India is the only country in the world where IFs
are used extensively for steel production in limited quantities. In this connection, it needs to be
noted that unlike in most other countries, EAFs in India are not very suitable for using large
quantities of even-sized DRI, because they are of relatively old design, are of smaller capacity
(525 t) and have low transformer power ratings (1030 MW). These furnaces are also not
equipped with facilities for continuous charging of DRI through the roof. For all these reasons,
EAFs in India have found it difficult to use DRI, even at times of scrap shortage. The fact that
they also depend on purchased power from the state electricity boards, makes EAF steel quite
expensive. Consequently, many mini-mills in India have been forced to shutdown their EAFs,
and have since installed IFs of 2 to 10 t capacity, at relatively low investment. Though these IFs
also use expensive electricity, their power demand is not very high, and they are able to use more
readily-available feedstock. All these factors have resulted in the proliferation of IFs in
preference to EAFs in the secondary sectorcurrently, 719 IFs are operating in India compared
with 38 EAFs.
Since the secondary producers are located in all parts of India and are able to cater to
specialised demands of regional markets, their share in Indias total steel production has been
rising, reaching almost 50% in 200405 (Table 24.5) (Muthuraman and Chatterjee, 2006). In
this context, it needs to be emphasised that though the secondary sector is not basically economic
in terms of the process route employed, scale of operation, efficiency, etc., the fact that they are
in a position to make steel to order for small volume regional markets outweighs the drawbacks.
REFERENCES
Chatterjee, Amit, Millennium Steel, 2006.
Muthuraman, B. and Amit Chatterjee, The Hindu Survey of Annual Industry 2006, March 2006.
Appendix I
LIST OF MAJOR IRON AND STEEL PLANTS IN INDIA
Sl. No. Name of the plant Capacity, Process Location Product mix
Mtpa route
1. Bhilai Steel Plant (SAIL) 5.0 BFBOF Bhilai, Rails, heavy structurals, heavy plates,
Chhattisgarh wire rods
2. Durgapur Steel Plant 1.8 BFBOF Durgapur, West Forging blooms, billets, merchant
(SAIL) Bengal products, skelp, wheels, axles, sleepers,
fishplates, etc.
3. Rourkela Steel Plant 1.9 BFBOF Rourkela, Orissa Plates, hot-rolled strips, cold-rolled
(SAIL) strips, galvanised plain and corrugated
sheets, tin plate, electrical steel sheets,
ERW pipes, spiral welded pipes
4. Bokaro Steel Ltd. (SAIL) 4.5 BFBOF Bokaro, Jharkhand Hot-rolled strips, cold-rolled strips,
galvanised plain and corrugated sheets
5. IISCO (SAIL) 1.0 BFOH Burnpur, Billets, rails, structurals, merchant
West Bengal products, bars, hot-rolled sheets,
galvanised sheets
6. Alloy Steels Plant (SAIL) 0.25 (incl. EAF Durgapur, Bar products, sheet products, forged
0.09 SS) West Bengal products.
7. Salem Steel Plant (SAIL) 0.22 Salem, Tamil Nadu Cold-rolled stainless steel sheets
8. Visvesvaraya Iron and 0.077 BFBOF Bhadravati, Forged items, bars
Steel Limited (SAIL) Karnataka
9. Rastriya Ispat Nigam Ltd. 3.5 BFBOF Visakhapatanam, Light/medium merchant products, wire
Andhra Pradesh rods, universal beam mill products,
billets
10. Tata Steel Limited 5.0 BFBOF Jamshedpur, Rods, plates, hot and cold strips,
Jharkhand galvanised sheets, bearings, ferro-alloys,
agricultural equipment, etc.
11. Essar Steel Ltd. 3.6 DRI/HBI Hazira, Gujarat Iron ore pellets, HBI, cold- and hot-
EAF rolled products, galvanised sheets
(Contd.)
461
462 Appendix I
This results in a large proportion of the kinetic energy of the jet getting dissipated close to the
nozzle exit. This pressure equalising mechanism gives rise to disturbances within the jet, which
are generally referred to as shock waves.
Therefore, strictly speaking, any supersonic nozzle is correctly designed only for one
particular flow rate. However, in practice, it is possible to operate the nozzle under slightly off-
design conditions, without producing detectable changes in the jet characteristics. At appreciable
off-design conditions, however (greater than 20% from the design conditions), the changes
become noticeable. This can lead to major disturbances. For example, if the flow rate of oxygen
through the nozzle is too high, the pressure at the nozzle exit will also be high, and uncontrolled
expansion followed by compression would then occur outside the nozzle. These normal shock
waves will continue downstream until the velocity of the jet becomes subsonic. A jet of this type
is referred to as an under expanded jet. When the flow rate through a nozzle is substantially
lower than the theoretical design rating, the jet will be over expanded, and oblique shock waves
will be produced at the nozzle exit.
V G 2
= exp - l
VO x
VO
VO VO
Potential
core
Transition
region Fully developed flow
Figure AII.1 Schematic representation of a subsonic jet showing the relative positions of the
component areas.
Potential
core
Figure AII.2 Shock-free supersonic jet showing the relative positions of the supersonic and
subsonic regions.
subsonic jet, where the velocity, of course, is less than the speed of sound. In the region beyond
the potential core, the axial velocity of the jet gradually decreases but, until a certain position
downstream is reached, the axial velocity remains above the velocity of sound. The entire region
over which the centreline velocity of the jet remains higher than the speed of sound, is referred
to as the supersonic core region, which includes the potential core. Beyond the supersonic core,
the subsonic portion of the jet begins which is similar to the region of fully developed flow in
subsonic jets.
The length of the potential core in supersonic jets (and therefore also the supersonic core),
increases almost proportionally with an increase in the Mach Number of the jet. The Mach
Number affects the ratio of the density of the gas in the jet as a proportion of the density of the
ambient medium. At a given Mach Number, this density ratio can also increase, if the gas jet
is exhausted into a hotter medium. This is exactly what happens in BOFs when oxygen at room
temperature comes in contact with the hot gases present in the converter atmosphere.
The entrainment close to the nozzle in a shock-free supersonic jet is much lower than in a
subsonic jet. For example, in the supersonic portion of a Mach 1.8 jet, the entrainment rate is
around 0.46 m3/m length of the jet, and the spreading angle is 10; while in the subsonic portion
of the same jet, the corresponding figures are 1.2 m3/m and 23 respectively.
Multi-hole Lances
Large capacity BOFs requires huge amounts of oxygen. To supply such large volumes of oxygen
within the restricted blowing period (the blowing period in BOFs is virtually independent of
vessel capacity), lances equipped with multi-hole nozzles at the tip are employed. The main
advantage of increasing the number of outlets on the lance tip is to allow the total oxygen
throughput to be increased, without simultaneously increasing the pressure exerted by the jets
impinging on the bath surface. It is important to remember that it is this pressure (to be more
exact jet momentum), which determines the depth of the depression(s) formed in the bath and,
consequently, the amount of liquid splashed from the bath surface. By increasing the number of
nozzle openings and thereby distributing the total energy of the jet over a larger surface area of
the bath, it is possible to increase the rate of oxygen supply without simultaneously decreasing
the metal yield (owing to spitting), or increasing the risk of burning the converter bottom because
of too deep a penetration. The limitation in increasing in the number of openings often lies in
466 Appendix II
guaranteeing adequate mechanical strength of the nozzle, the desired amount of cooling as well
as the difficulty of accommodating a large number of holes within the restricted space available
at the lance tip, without having to decrease either the nozzle size or the inclination angle of each
opening. The inclination angle is defined as the angle subtended between the central axis of each
opening and the vertical or the lance axis. Any decrease in the inclination angle automatically
leads to severe lowering of nozzle life, because of the accompanying problems of maintaining
an adequate supply of water at the appropriate temperature around each opening. At the same
time, the lesser the inclination angle, the more vertical is the trajectory of the metal and slag
droplets splashed. Therefore, the number of droplets impinging on the converter lining decreases,
and correspondingly, the amount of splash directed towards the lance increases. The relationship
among these three parametersinclination angle, nozzle life and lining lifeshows that the
lance life decreases when the inclination angle is decreased, while the lining life increases. The
actual values of the lining life and lance life vary widely from plant to plant.
Other Issues
Another consideration that is often not given due weightage is the extent of coalescence of jets
from multi-hole nozzles (i.e. the extent of interaction between the individual jets by the time they
reach the bath surface). Substantial loss in velocity, totally different peripheral flow
characteristics, inadequate flow at the nozzle tip axis, etc. are some important areas that need to
be taken note of when using multi-hole nozzles in LD converters.
Bibliography
Ironmaking
Biswas, A.K., Principles of Blast Furnace Ironmaking, 1st Indian ed., SBA Publications,
Kolkata, 1984.
Chatterjee, Amit, R. Singh and B. Pandey, Metallics for SteelmakingProduction and Use,
Allied Publishers Ltd., New Delhi, 2001.
Gupta, S.S. and Amit Chatterjee (Eds.), Blast Furnace Ironmaking, Tata Steel, Jamshedpur,
1993.
Chatterjee, Amit, Beyond the Blast Furnace, CRC Press, Boca Raton, Florida, USA, 1992.
Peacy, J.G., and W.G. Davenport, The Iron Blast FurnaceTheory and Practice, Pergamon
Press, Oxford, 1979.
Tupkary, R.H. and V.R. Tupkary, An Introduction to Modern Iron Making, 3rd ed., Khanna
Publishers, Delhi, 1998.
Wakelin, D.H. (Ed.), Ironmaking Volume, The Making, Shaping and Treating of Steel,
11th ed., AISE Steel Foundation, USA, 1998.
Walker, R.D., Modern Ironmaking Methods, The Institute of Metals, London, 1986.
Ghosh, A., Secondary SteelmakingPrinciples and Applications, CRC Press, Boca Raton,
Florida, USA, 2001.
Ghosh, A., Principles of Secondary Processing and Casting of Liquid Steel, Oxford & IBH
Publishing Co., New Delhi, 1990.
Tupkary, R.H. and V.R. Tupkary, An Introduction to Modern Steel Making, 6th ed., Khanna
Publishers, Delhi, 1998.
Turkdogan, E.T., Fundamentals of Steelmaking, The Institute of Materials, London, 1996.
Others
Ward, R.G., An Introduction to The Physical Chemistry of Iron & Steel Making, Edward Arnold
Publishers, London, 1962.
Index
AHINDRA GHOSH, holder of a Doctorate of Science (Sc.D) degree in Metallurgical Engineering from Massachusetts Institute
of Technology, USA, is one of India's most renowned academicians in the area of Process Metallurgy. He had been engaged
in teaching thermodynamics, kinetics and transport phenomena, with specific research emphasis on application of these
areas to ironmaking and steelmaking, for almost four decades at the Indian Institute of Technology Kanpur. He also interacted
with steel plants extensively, and is continuing to do so even after retirement.
Professor Ghosh during his academic career guided many research students and scholars. He has to his credit four books and
ninety original research publications in reviewed journals.
AMIT CHATTERJEE was awarded the Doctorate of Science (Engg.) degree by the London University in 1988 for his
outstanding work an coal-based direct reduction and oxygen steelmaking. He obtained his Ph.D. in Process Metallurgy from
the Imperial College of Science and Technology, London, of which he is also a Fellow.
Dr. Chatterjee is a renowned figure in the area of oxygen steelmaking and direct reduction. He has spent 35 years in
Tata Steel applying the fundamental understanding of iron and steelmaking processes to actual steel plant conditions. He
has over 500 publications to his credit, has authored several books and is a recipient of several awards from India and
overseas.
ISBN:978-81-203-3289-8
9 788120 332898
www.phindia.com